Quarterlytics / Industrials / Construction Materials / Travis Perkins

Travis Perkins

tpk · LSE Industrials
Claim this profile
Ticker tpk
Exchange LSE
Sector Industrials
Industry Construction Materials
Employees 10,000+
← All annual reports
FY2024 Annual Report · Travis Perkins
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
Annual Report  
and Accounts
24

Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
INTRODUCTION
Welcome to the 2024 Annual Report 
for Travis Perkins plc, the UK’s largest 
distributor of building materials
The breadth, reach and scale of the business means it’s in a unique position to supply 
the entire UK construction industry and provide customers with the materials and tools 
they need for their building projects, when and where they need it.
The Group has a strong heritage and employs over 17,000 colleagues across five 
leading businesses which are all number #1 or #2 in their markets.
What’s inside…
Overview
At a glance
Chair’s statement
Market overview
Business model
Strategy
Sustainability
The Group’s breadth, 
reach and scale to supply 
the entire UK construction 
industry
Travis Perkins plc is the 
largest distributor of 
building materials in 
the UK
Geoff Drabble on creating 
a simpler, more efficient, 
customer-centric business
The Group serves a 
UK construction  
materials market of 
£65bn
Providing customers with 
the building materials 
they need, when and 
where they need it
Growing market-leading 
businesses by offering 
customers excellent 
service
Sourcing responsibly, 
operating sustainably 
and developing the 
next generation
P 4–5
P 6–7
P 8–9
P 10
P 11
P 12–13
P 26–58

Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
01
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
CONTENTS
Strategic report
2	
2024 Highlights
4	
Overview
6	
At a glance
8	
Chair’s statement
10	
Market overview
11	
Business model
12	
Our strategy
14	
Key performance indicators (KPIs)
16	
Business performance and priorities
22	
Financial review
26	
Sustainability report
59	
Statement of principal risks  
and uncertainties
70	
Non-financial and sustainability
	
information statement.
Financial statements
123	 Independent Auditor’s report
131	
Consolidated income statement
132	 Consolidated statement of 
comprehensive income
133	 Consolidated balance sheet
134	 Consolidated statement of  
changes in equity
135	 Consolidated cash flow statement
136	 Notes to the consolidated  
financial statements
172	 Company balance sheet
173	 Company statement of  
changes in equity
174	
Notes to the Company’s 
financial statements
181	
Five-year summary
Subject guide
Governance
72	
Board of Directors
74	
Corporate governance report
78	
Section 172 statement
81	
Nominations Committee report
84	
Audit Committee report
90	
Directors’ remuneration report
118	
Directors’ report
121	
Directors’ statement of 
responsibilities
Other information
185	 ESG data report (including SASB data)
188	 Other shareholder information
Progress
Sustainability
Quote
Customers and colleagues
Focus
For more and the latest information 
please visit the Group’s website at: 
www.travisperkinsplc.co.uk

02
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
2024 FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
A challenging trading year with good 
progress in Toolstation and a strong  
focus on cash generation
Revenue
£4,607m
2023: £4,837m
Adjusted operating profit
£152m
2023: £198m
Net debt/adjusted EBITDA
2.5x
2023: 2.6x
Return on capital employed
5.4%
2023: 6.9%
Dividend per share
14.5p
2023: 18.0p
Loss after tax
£77m
2023: profit after tax of £38m
Graduated apprentices
427
2023: 414
Carbon emissions (kt of CO₂e)
6,530
2023: 7,012

03
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
2024 OPERATIONAL HIGHLIGHTS
A challenging trading year
•	 Group revenue down (4.7)% driven by price 
deflation, continued decline in market volumes 
and underperformance in the Merchanting 
segment.
•	 Significantly improved cost discipline but lower 
trading volumes and price deflation resulted in 
full year adjusted operating profit of £152m 
(2023: £198m).
•	 Operating profit of £2m (2023: £161m) reflects 
trading performance and adjusting items of 
£139m (of which around £20m are cash items) 
related to impairments in Staircraft and certain 
Merchanting branches and restructuring actions.
Good progress in Toolstation
•	 Toolstation UK adjusted operating profit up 48% 
driven by robust sales growth, improved gross 
margins and supply chain and overhead 
efficiencies.
•	 Toolstation France closed and Toolstation 
Benelux on accelerated path to profitability.
Strong focus on cash generation and 
strengthening the balance sheet
•	 Net debt before leases reduced by £123m 
driven by £64m benefit from improved stock 
management and disciplined approach to 
capital expenditure.
•	 £125m raised from investment grade US private 
placement notes in March 2025.

04
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
OVERVIEW
Focused on providing customers with 
everything they need for their building 
projects, when and where they need it
Well positioned
The breadth, reach and scale of the Group puts it in a unique position to supply the entire UK construction 
industry and be customers’ first choice for building materials and tools.
Strategic opportunities
The Group’s market-leading businesses serve customer needs from well-located 
branches, where operations are underpinned by safety and sustainability and 
where customers are offered excellent service with a wide range, high availability, 
delivery options, finance solutions and value-added services.

05
GOVERNANCE
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
OTHER INFORMATION
MEETING CUSTOMER NEEDS
LEVERAGING SCALE
	• Five leading businesses serving specific 
construction markets
	• Local empowerment to serve small  
tradesmen and the general builder
	• Specialist propositions for larger contractors
	• Technical capability
	• Value-added services
	• Nationwide network
	• Purchasing power
	• Range and availability
	• Digital capability
	• Main contractor and developer relationships
	• Value creation from property portfolio
	• Long-term consolidation options
UNDERPINNED BY:
An efficient and sustainable 
operating model
•	 Leading the market in a responsible 
manner
•	 The best people in the industry
•	 Technical, sustainable solutions fit  
for purpose
•	 Focused capital deployment
The Group’s values: 
•	 We care
•	 We give our best to be the best
•	 We’re better together
Doing the right thing
•	 Safety and wellbeing
•	 Colleague voice
•	 Diversity, equity and inclusion
•	 Reward
•	 Charity and community
•	 Legal compliance 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OUR STRATEGY FRAMEWORK

06
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
06
AT A GLANCE
Travis Perkins plc is the largest distributor of 
building materials in the UK
Merchanting
Toolstation
Travis Perkins plc is a trade-focused group, serving 
generalist and specialist trades with products and 
services that are designed to help customers grow 
their businesses in new and established markets.
The Group’s goal is to deliver exceptional customer 
service from advantaged businesses operating from 
well-positioned networks on a national scale.
The Group offers a range of high-quality products 
and gives customers the choice of a range of 
channels, fulfilment options and ways to pay.
Toolstation is #2 in its market in the 
UK and offers customers an innovative 
lightside proposition from 587 branches 
across the UK and 110 in Benelux. With 
a wide range of products available 
in branch and for next-day delivery, 
offering long opening hours, a strong 
digital offering and a committed 
customer service ethos, Toolstation is 
changing the purchasing experience of 
trade and DIY customers. 
The UK’s market-leading general builders 
merchant, offering a destination for heavyside 
products complemented by lightside 
convenience. Serving general trades and 
specialist contractors with the building 
materials they need when and where they 
need them from 577 national locations. 
Contains a comprehensive tool hire offer, 
innovative Managed Services solutions and 
a kitchen design and supply offer, branded 
as Benchmarx.
Market-leading supplier of commercial and 
industrial heating and cooling solutions, 
supplying specialist contractors with a 
wide variety of products from 69 branches 
and two distribution centres. BSS offers 
customers a tailored tool hire service and 
includes TF Solutions, a specialist provider 
of air-conditioning products and heat pumps.
A civils specialist, Keyline is #1 in its market and 
supports housebuilders, groundworkers and 
infrastructure contractors to build and redevelop 
facilities which are vital to the nation. Delivering 
heavy products from 41 branches in a safe and 
accurate manner, Keyline works as a partner to 
its specialist customers and is developing new 
areas of expertise in roads and highways.
CCF distributes insulation and interior building 
products from 37 branches to contractors 
throughout Great Britain. #2 in its market, CCF 
supports the construction and renovation of 
both domestic and commercial buildings with 
service and specialist knowledge.

Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Branches
c.1,400
Employees
c.17,000
Serving the construction industry
200+ years
07
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Geographic split
Payment mix
Cash
28%
  South-East
30%
  Midlands
25%
  North and Scotland
23%
  Wales and South-West
20%
  Europe
2%
Our market footprint, the quality 
of our people and the strength 
of our relationships, puts us in a 
strong position to be our trade 
customers’ first choice.
Geoff Drabble
Chair
Credit
72%
Channel
40%
Product mix
60%
  Heavyside
47%
  Lightside
22%
  Plumbing & Heating
20%
  Timber
11%
Collect
Deliver

08
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CHAIR’S STATEMENT
Leveraging excellence to benefit customers
It was a real privilege to be appointed to 
the Board of Travis Perkins plc last year, as 
I see this as a business with many inherent 
strengths and great potential. However, it 
is also a business that has been through a 
period of significant change.
The immediate task is to align all parts of the 
business to a clear and achievable strategy 
that prioritises customer service. The key 
to this will be our people, and I would like to 
take this opportunity to thank them for their 
continued contribution during what has clearly 
been an unsettling period. 
Our objective is to leverage excellence in all 
parts of the business and work towards a 
vision where we create flexible, responsive 
and entrepreneurial local businesses 
supported by world class central functions 
that differentiate us from our competitors, and 
where we provide value added services to our 
customers.
There have been some short-term tactical 
missteps in the past, but the fundamental 
building blocks that attracted me to the 
business remain in place. We have great 
brands, capable people, a unique portfolio 
of businesses and the best locations in the 
industry.
I was sorry to see Pete Redfern’s brief but 
promising tenure as CEO being brought to a 
premature conclusion due to ill health, and he 
left with our best wishes for the future. On a 
personal level, and on behalf of the Board, I 
recognise the contribution he made to  
re-energise the business. 
Work by the Nominations Committee to 
search for a successor CEO is underway. 
In the meantime I am fully committed to 
working closely with the executive and 
leadership teams to ensure the stability and 
continuity of the business, and that we remain 
focused on progressing the actions that are in 
flight to improve performance and enhance 
profitability.
Uncertainty remains regarding the 
strength and timing of a recovery in UK 
construction activity. Irrespective of this, we 
have the opportunity and ability to make 
improvements in a number of areas that 
are within our control. We have a strong 
balance sheet that will provide security for the 
changes that we need to make; changes that 
will make our businesses more responsive 
and bring them closer to our customers. This, 
combined with the breadth, reach and scale of 
our Group, puts us in a strong position to be 
our trade customers’ first choice.
I am really excited at the prospect of working 
with the Board and the leaders in this 
business to achieve this, and by rediscovering 
our competitive strengths, I am confident 
that we will create a pathway to improving 
profitability and providing attractive returns 
for shareholders in the medium and  
long-term. 
Finally, on behalf of the Board, I would like 
to say a big thank you to our Non-executive 
Director, Jez Maiden, for his service as Interim 
Chair in 2024. During a year of several Board 
leadership changes, Jez provided business 
continuity and great support during the 
recruitment process. Special thanks also 
go to our customers and suppliers, and I 
look forward to strengthening our trading 
relationships with them as we move the 
business forward.
Geoff Drabble
Chair
31 March 2025
By rediscovering our competitive strengths, 
I am confident that we will improve 
profitability and provide attractive returns 
for shareholders in the medium term.
Geoff Drabble
Chair

09
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024

10
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
MARKET OVERVIEW
The market for building materials in the UK coming through 
distribution channels is £65bn*
*	
Source - BUILDERS MERCHANTS MARKET REPORT UK 2024-2028, September 2024.
Private domestic and new build
Commercial and industrial
Growth drivers:
•	 Government housing targets
•	 A shortage of housing in the UK
•	 Growth in the population
•	 Continued desirability of house ownership
•	 Upcoming building regulation change
Growth drivers:
•	 Refurbishment of existing commercial buildings as tenants move 
to smaller, Grade A office spaces
•	 Greater demand for energy efficient buildings
•	 Cladding remediation on commercial buildings
•	 Increase in large projects such as gigafactories and data centres
19% 
Market mix
15% 
Group revenue mix
26% 
Market mix
24% 
Group revenue mix
Private domestic repair, maintenance and improvement (“RMI”)
Public sector
Growth drivers:
•	 Government policy
•	 Building and refurbishment of the public sector estate
•	 Retrofit opportunities for energy efficiency
•	 Demand for social housing
Growth drivers:
•	 The age and quality of UK housing stock
•	 Government schemes to boost energy efficiency
•	 Energy efficiency retrofit trends
17% 
Market mix
35% 
Group revenue mix
38% 
Market mix
26% 
Group revenue mix
The market mix and market size figures are based on 2024 data. The Group mix is based on internal estimates.

11
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
BUSINESS MODEL
People are at the heart of the business model
The Group’s businesses bring together customers, suppliers and colleagues into mutually-beneficial relationships which can last  
many years. The Group invests time and resources with all of its stakeholders and is mindful of the impact it has on the environment.
Inputs
Competitively-advantaged resources and relationships.
Processes
Converting the inputs, demands and requirements of 
stakeholders to generate valued outputs.
Outputs
Value for all.
Customers
•	 Strong customer relationships
•	 Local empowerment to serve small trade and the general builder
•	 Specialist propositions for larger contractors
•	 Technical capability and value-added services
Resources
•	 A 200-year heritage and businesses that are #1 or #2 in their market
•	 A national branch and supply chain network
•	 Digital platforms to improve the customer experience
•	 17,000 colleagues with technical knowhow and industry experience
Suppliers
•	 Partnership relationships with suppliers, which work for the 
success of all
Underpinned by
Responsible and sustainable approach (See page 26)    Sound corporate governance (See page 71)    Robust risk management (See page 59)
Stakeholders
•	 Fulfilled customers
•	 Satisfied shareholders
•	 Engaged colleagues
•	 Valued suppliers
The Group
•	 Collaborate, specify and quote
•	 Negotiate, convert and sell
•	 Range and source
•	 Procure
•	 Fulfil, collect and deliver
•	 Provide and manage credit

12
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
OUR STRATEGY
The strategy of the Group is to grow the share of its 
market-leading businesses by offering customers 
attractive propositions and excellent service
Proposition
Priorities and initiatives
Customers
Large
Large to small
Small
Strategic priorities
Price
Variable and 
framework
Variable
Fixed
Range
Variable
Part-mandated
Mandated
Strategic initiatives
Delivered
88%
58%
10% 
•	 Technical development
•	 Data-led sales approach
•	 Operational efficiency
•	 Network investment
•	 Customer, colleague and 
supplier propositions
•	 Being the distributor of choice
•	 TF Solutions growth
•	 Leading on infrastructure
•	 Hire
•	 Managed service
•	 Benchmarx
•	 General builder proposition
•	 Network roll-out
•	 Ongoing digital development

13
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024

14
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATORS (KPIs)
Operational
Adjusted operating profit
£353m
£295m
2022
2021
£128m
£198m
£152m
2020
2023
2024
Definition (note 2b)
Profit before tax, financing charges and 
income, amortisation of acquired  
intangibles and adjusting items.
Reason
Adjusted operating profit excludes adjusting 
items and the amortisation of intangible 
assets arising on the acquisition of a 
business, so management can monitor the 
Group’s underlying performance.
Sales growth
(10.8)%
(3.2)%
8.9%
2021
24.0%
2022
2020
2023
2024
(4.7)%
Definition (note 1b)
Total revenue growth.
Reason
Sales growth helps management monitor 
the performance trend of the business and 
gives a good indication of its overall health 
compared to its competitors. Total sales 
growth is not distorted by actions such as the 
consolidation of branches.
Financial
Leverage ratio
1.2x
1.8x
2022
2021
2.0x
2.6x
2.5x
2020
2023
2024
Definition (note 25)
The ratio of net debt to earnings before 
tax, interest, depreciation, amortisation and 
adjusting items (“Adjusted EBITDA”). 
Reason
The leverage ratio is an indicator by 
management and lenders of the Group’s 
ability to support its debt. The Group has 
a target of 1.5x–2.0x.
Free cash flow
£65m
£95m
2022
2021
£241m
£62m
£109m
2020
2023
2024
Definition (note 24)
Net cash flow before dividends, freehold 
property purchases and disposals, pension 
deficit repair contributions, adjusting and 
discontinued cash flows and the issuance 
and repayment of debt.
Reason
The Group needs to generate strong free  
cash flows to enable it to invest, expand 
its operations and pay dividends to 
shareholders. Freehold investments are 
financed by property disposals and enable the 
Group to access the best property locations.
Return on capital employed
14.1%
10.8%
2022
2021
5.3%
6.9%
5.4%
2020
2023
2024
Definition (note 26)
Adjusted operating profit divided by the combined value of 
balance sheet debt and equity excluding pension assets. 
Reason
This ratio allows management to measure how effectively 
capital is used in the business to generate returns for 
shareholders.

15
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Non-financial
Accident frequency rate
5.6
4.7
2022
2021
5.4
3.9
3.6
2020
2023
2024
Definition
The number of lost-time incidents  
(“LTIs”) per million hours worked.
Reason
Keeping people safe is the Group’s first 
priority. This ratio allows management  
to measure progress in ensuring a  
safe workforce.
Carbon emissions
9,111
8,294
2022
2021
8,546
7,012
6,530
2020
2023
2024
Definition
Total Scope 1, 2 and 3 carbon emissions 
(kilotonnes of CO₂e). 
Reason
The Group has a responsibility to take action 
to prevent the worst impacts of climate 
change. This measure allows management 
to measure progress in the decarbonisation 
of the business. This includes Scope 3 
in addition to Scope 1 and 2, as Scope 3 
represents over 99% of the Group’s carbon 
footprint and the Group has set a target 
of reducing Scope 3 emissions by 63% by 
2035 from a 2020 baseline. 
Carbon emissions and accident frequency 
rate are two key sustainability metrics 
See page 26 for more information

16
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
BUSINESS PERFORMANCE AND PRIORITIES
2024 performance
2024 was a challenging year for the Group with 
revenue of £4,607m down (4.7)% year-on-year, 
driven by the Merchanting segment through a 
combination of price deflation, reduced demand 
across the UK construction market and increased 
competitive intensity. Toolstation continued to 
make good progress with robust revenue growth 
in both the UK and Benelux reflecting ongoing 
maturity benefits.
Adjusted operating profit excluding property profits 
of £141m was £(42)m, or (23)%, lower than prior 
year. Around £(39)m of the profit decline resulted 
from lower sales volumes whilst approximately 
£(56)m was attributable to lower gross 
margins, driven by price deflation and increased 
competitive intensity.
Against this backdrop management took actions 
to reduce total overheads by £53m compared to 
prior year. Restructuring actions taken at the end of 
2023 reduced overheads by £35m with a further 
£36m of savings on discretionary spend and £9m 
savings from the strategic review actions taken in 
Toolstation Benelux. Offset against this was around 
£(27)m of overhead inflation, primarily on payroll 
and property costs.
Building on the Group’s inherent strengths
The Group has strong fundamentals built up over 
decades as the largest UK building materials 
distributor, namely:
•	 A comprehensive UK network backed by freehold 
ownership of key trading sites.
•	 Experienced and high-quality teams across 
the business.
•	 Long-established customer and supplier 
relationships
•	 A unique portfolio of brands.
•	 Significant earnings growth potential from 
Toolstation as the business matures.
Attractive long-term structural drivers
The Group operates in a market with attractive long-
term structural drivers – in particular a shortage of 
UK housing, an ageing UK housing stock and a need 
to decarbonise the UK’s built environment. These 
structural drivers have taken greater prominence in 
the key priorities and policy setting of the new Labour 
Government, which has set ambitious housebuilding 
targets and see construction-led activity as a major 
pillar to kickstarting economic growth.
£m (unless otherwise stated)
Note 
2024
2023  
(re-presented1)
Change
Revenue
1
4,607
4,837
(4.7)%
Adjusted operating profit excluding 
property profits¹
2a
141
183
(23.0)%
Adjusted operating profit¹
2a
152
198
(23.2)%
Adjusted earnings per share¹
20b
36.6p
54.4p
(32.7)%
Return on capital employed¹
26
5.4%
6.9%
(1.5)ppt
Net debt / adjusted EBITDA¹
25
2.5x
2.6x
0.1x
Ordinary dividend per share
21
14.5p
18.0p
(19.4)%
Operating profit
2
161
(98.8)%
Profit / (loss) after tax
(77)
38
(302.6)%
Basic earnings / (loss) per share
20a
(36.6)p
18.1p
(302.2)%
1	
For continuing businesses only. The Toolstation France business is treated as a discontinued operation.

17
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
However, the Group has become distracted 
in a challenging market
The Group’s key end markets have seen a progressive 
deterioration in demand over the past three years 
driven by high inflation, rising interest rates and 
weak consumer confidence. During this period, the 
Group’s approach to capital allocation and overhead 
management has diluted returns, exacerbated profit 
decline and resulted in leverage increasing beyond 
the Group’s target range. During this period, the 
business has seen significant personnel change at 
all levels of the business, particularly in some key 
customer-facing roles.
Building an entrepreneurial, customer-centric 
business
Over recent years, the Group has become too 
centralised which has increased costs and complexity. 
Work is now underway to transform the operating 
model to create a business based around empowered 
local branches, backed by high quality support 
functions providing insight and driving the benefits 
of national scale. This cultural shift will bring the 
business closer to its customers and enhance 
service levels.
Balance sheet
The Group has made good progress on actions to 
strengthen the balance sheet during the year, with 
overall net debt reducing by £77m and net debt 
before leases reducing by £123m. Accordingly, 
despite the further reduction in adjusted operating 
profit, net debt / adjusted EBITDA has also reduced 
to 2.5x. Management remain focused on returning 
leverage to the Group’s target range of 1.5 - 2.0x as 
soon as is practically possible.
Dividend
The Board is recommending a final dividend of 
9.0 pence per share (2023: 5.5 pence per share) 
to give a full-year dividend of 14.5 pence per 
share (2023: 18.0 pence per share), in line with 
the Group’s policy to pay a dividend of 30-40% 
of adjusted earnings. The dividend will be paid on 
29 May 2025 to shareholders on the register as at 
close of business on 22 April 2025.
Current trading and outlook
The Group has experienced a mixed start to 2025. 
Trading conditions have continued to be challenging 
in our Merchanting businesses with pricing 
now stabilised but volumes in modest decline. 
By contrast, Toolstation has started the year more 
positively and continues to deliver good growth.
It is encouraging to see a more robust demand 
backdrop for some elements of the construction 
market. However, the pace and rate of an overall 
recovery in construction activity levels remains 
uncertain and will likely need further cuts to interest 
rates and an uplift to consumer confidence levels to 
stimulate a meaningful increase in demand.
In recognition of this backdrop and the operational 
turnaround challenges the Group currently faces, 
the Board expect FY25 adjusted operating profit, 
excluding property profits, to be broadly in line  
with FY24.
The Board remains confident in the inherent 
strengths of the Group and its market-leading 
position in the building materials sector. By investing 
in its core competitive advantages with a clear 
focus on its customers’ needs, the Group will start 
to deliver an improved financial performance and 
create attractive returns for shareholders over the 
medium-term.
Technical guidance
The Group’s technical guidance for 2025 is as follows:
•	 Expected ETR of around 30% on UK generated 
profits.
•	 Base capital expenditure of around £80m.
•	 Property profits of around £3m.
Implementation of new Oracle finance system
On 1 July 2024, the Group implemented a new 
Oracle Financial ERP system which represented 
a significant step forward for the Group in 
modernising its core technology platform. Oracle 
has strengthened financial controls, enabled new 
standardised processes and enhanced stock 
visibility and reporting, all of which will deliver 
long-term benefits for the Group.
With this being the first major systems upgrade 
for several decades, the Group has inevitably 
experienced some challenges with the adoption 
of new processes. This has translated into some 
limited customer facing challenges in branch and 
disruption associated with some supplier payments 
and collection of customer debt, which in turn has 
had an impact on trading operations. It has also 
resulted in a working capital outflow during the year, 
estimated to be around £50m. 
The Group is confident that as these processes 
become familiar and are readily adopted that this 
disruption will ease and the working capital position 
will normalise throughout 2025.
Adjusting items
£m 
2024
2023
(re-presented1) 
Branch impairment
63
–
Staircraft impairment
33
–
Supply chain 
consolidation
26
6
Group restructuring
11
11
Benchmarx closures
6
10
Total
139
27
 
The 2024 branch-level impairment review 
identified 209 branches where the carrying value 
of the branch’s assets was below the value of 
the discounted future cash flows generated from 
those assets. The total impairment recognised in 
relation to these branches is £63m. In the majority 
of cases the branches are expected to deliver a 
positive contribution in 2025 with the vast majority 
delivering a positive contribution in the future, 
based on cautious financial planning assumptions. 
Management’s view is that this reflects the under-
utilisation of these assets during the period under 
review as a result of cyclically depressed market 
volumes and that these branches will remain 
an important part of the Group’s future network 
strategy. An impairment of £33m has been 
recognised following the annual impairment review 
of the Staircraft business as a result of challenging 
trading conditions in its markets.
The supply chain consolidation charge relates to 
the closure of a number of distribution centres 
in Toolstation, Benchmarx and the Group timber 
supply chain. The costs relate primarily to stock 
write-downs, dilapidations and other property-
related costs. Restructuring charges relate to actions 
taken to reduce central and regional headcount.
The Benchmarx closures charge reflects the costs, 
primarily redundancy, of closing 39 standalone 
branches in February 2024. The prior year charge 
reflected fixed asset impairments associated with 
those sites.
Property
The Group generated property profits of £11m in the 
year, with £62m of cash proceeds.
1	
For continuing businesses only. The Toolstation France business 
is treated as a discontinued operation.

18
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
BUSINESS PERFORMANCE AND PRIORITIES CONTINUED
Merchanting
2025 priorities
•	 Focused leadership in all businesses
•	 Reinvestment in branch resources
•	 Remove barriers to delivering excellent customer service
•	 Support functions focused on providing insight and driving the benefits 
of national scale
Revenue
£3,786m
2023: £4,036m
Adjusted operating profit
£149m
2023: £212m
The Group’s Merchanting businesses saw revenue 
fall by (6.2)% in the year as a result of price deflation 
and declining volumes, arising from the depressed 
levels of UK construction activity and an intensely 
competitive backdrop. Adjusted operating profit 
reduced by (29.7)% to £149m, reflecting the high 
operational gearing of these businesses. Operating 
profit declined to £20m from £199m due to these 
factors and adjusting items of £133m relating to 
impairments in Staircraft and certain Merchanting 
branches and restructuring actions.
Price deflation, a significant factor in H1 due to 
the rollover of prior year timber price reductions 
in particular, eased in H2. However, volumes 
worsened as the year progressed, in part driven by 
project postponements caused by general election 
uncertainty and the delayed government budget.
The private domestic RMI market, the Merchanting 
segment’s largest end market which is primarily 
serviced by the Group’s General Merchant business, 
remained depressed throughout the year. The 
private domestic new-build market, primarily 
serviced by Keyline and CCF working with national 
and regional housebuilders, also saw another 
notable drop in activity.
The Merchanting segment’s other end markets 
– commercial, industrial and public sector – 
saw mixed levels of demand with uncertainty 
surrounding government departmental budgets 
persisting until after the late October budget 
announcement. This created hesitancy to invest and 
impacted demand in the second half of the year, 
particularly in BSS which serves these markets.
Six new Merchant branches were opened during 
the year as the Group continues to selectively add 
new branches to its network. Five of the sites were 
new General Merchant branches, serving major 
conurbations including Leeds, Edinburgh, Derby and 
Coventry, with a new CCF branch also opened in 
Norwich.
51 Merchant branches were closed during the year 
with the majority being 42 Benchmarx standalone 
branches. The Benchmarx decision continues 
the Group’s strategy of offering an integrated 
proposition within destination General Merchant 
branches. The remaining nine branches closed 
comprised eight General Merchant branches and 
Keyline Kirby with these sites deemed to be poorly 
located or requiring significant investment and 
where trade could be transferred to an alternative 
nearby branch.
2024
2023
Change
Revenue
£3,786m
£4,036m
(6.2)%
Adjusted 
operating 
profit
£149m
£212m
(29.7)%
Adjusted 
operating 
margin
3.9%
5.3%
(140)bps
ROCE 
7%
9%
(2)ppt
Branch 
network
724
769
(45)

Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
19
Travis Perkins 
Norwich was one  
of 6 new Merchant 
branches opened 
during the year.

20
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
BUSINESS PERFORMANCE AND PRIORITIES CONTINUED
Toolstation
2025 priorities
•	 Continued Toolstation UK gross margin progress with focus on 
increasing own brand penetration
•	 Further Toolstation UK supply chain efficiencies
•	 Continued expansion of Toolstation UK with c.20 new branches
•	 Drive Toolstation Benelux strategic plan actions to narrow losses further
Revenue
£821m
2023: 801m
Branch network
697
2023: 689
2024
2023
(re-presented1)
Change
Revenue
£821m
£801m
2.5%
Life-for-like 
growth
1.9%
3.4%
Adjusted 
operating  
profit - UK
£34m
£23m
47.8%
Adjusted 
operating  
profit - Europe £(13)m
£(20m)
35.0%
Adjusted 
operating  
profit - Total
£21m
£3m
600.0%
Adjusted 
operating 
margin
2.6%
0.4%
220bps
ROCE 
4%
1%
3ppt
Store network 
(UK)
587
570
17
Store network 
(Europe)
110
119
(9)
UK
Toolstation UK continued to make good progress 
during the year with revenue increasing by 2%, 
reflecting continued maturity benefits and a modest 
pricing uplift. A net 17 stores were added during 
the year with 19 new stores, three relocations and 
two closures. A similar number of store additions is 
expected for 2025.
Adjusted operating profit increased by £11m 
(47.8%) year-on-year driven by a combination of 
sales growth, gross margin benefits from improved 
purchasing and product mix and supply chain 
efficiencies.
Benelux
Like-for-like sales in Benelux increased by 11% as 
the business continues to mature. However, due to 
rapid growth over recent years, the business has 
not been effective in converting strong sales growth 
into improved profitability and hence management 
conducted a full strategic review of the business 
during the first half of the year.
The review concluded that the business had good 
long-term prospects but needed to take near-term 
actions to accelerate the path to profitability. These 
actions included the closure of 11 underperforming 
branches, a 15% reduction in central headcount, 
improving procurement capability and optimising 
supply chain capacity. As a result of these actions, 
adjusted operating losses reduced to £(13)m and are 
expected to narrow significantly again in 2025.
France
Following a strategic review early in the year, 
management concluded that Toolstation France 
did not have a credible pathway to becoming 
a profitable standalone business. The capital 
requirements to reach the necessary scale in 
the French market, given the operation’s relative 
immaturity, and the differing customer behaviours 
to Benelux and the UK, led management to pursue 
divestment options with established domestic 
partners in the French market. When it became 
clear that there was no overall buyer, management 
took the difficult decision to close the French 
business. That process is now complete with 8 
stores having been sold to Quincaillerie Angles 
as a going concern and the 43 remaining stores, 
alongside supply chain and head office functions, 
closed by the end of 2024.
1	
For continuing businesses only. The Toolstation France business 
is treated as a discontinued operation and excluded from the 
re-presented 2023 figures.

21
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024

22
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL REVIEW
Volume, price and mix analysis
Merchanting
Toolstation
Group
Price and mix
(2.3)%
1.4%
(1.7)%
Like-for-like volume
(4.5)%
0.5%
(3.6)%
Like-for-like revenue growth
(6.8)%
1.9%
(5.3)%
Network changes
(0.6)%
0.3%
(0.5)%
Trading days
1.2%
0.3%
1.1%
Total revenue growth
(6.2)%
2.5%
(4.7)%
Quarterly revenue analysis
Total revenue*
Like-for-like revenue
2024
2023
2024
2023
Merchanting
Q1
(6.0)%
(3.2)%
(4.2)%
(4.2)%
Q2
(5.7)%
(5.6)%
(7.9)%
(5.2)%
H1
(5.8)%
(4.5)%
(6.1)%
(4.8)%
Q3
(7.1)%
(3.4)%
(8.2)%
(2.9)%
Q4
(5.8)%
(5.1)%
(6.8)%
(5.2)%
H2
(6.5)%
(4.2)%
(7.6)%
(4.1)%
FY
(6.2)%
(4.4)%
(6.8)%
(4.4)%
Toolstation
Q1
0.9%
7.6%
(1.2)%
3.5%
Q2
3.6%
9.0%
2.4%
6.4%
H1
2.3%
8.3%
0.6%
5.0%
Q3
3.0%
7.2%
2.2%
4.1%
Q4
2.2%
0.8%
4.3%
(0.3)%
H2
2.6%
3.8%
3.3%
1.8%
FY
2.5%
6.0%
1.9%
3.4%
Total Group
Q1
(4.9)%
(1.7)%
(3.5)%
(3.3)%
Q2
(4.2)%
(3.5)%
(6.2)%
(3.5)%
H1
(4.5)%
(2.6)%
(4.9)%
(3.4)%
Q3
(5.5)%
(1.9)%
(6.6)%
(2.0)%
Q4
(4.3)%
(4.1)%
(4.8)%
(4.4)%
H2
(5.0)%
(3.0)%
(5.8)%
(3.1)%
FY
(4.7)%
(2.8)%
(5.3)%
(3.2)%
*	
Trading day adjusted
Revenue analysis
The Merchanting businesses saw a continuation of 
challenging trading conditions across the year, with 
the rollover of commodity price deflation – notably 
timber – leading to pricing being down (3.6)% in 
the first half. In the second half, pricing pressures 
eased as commodity prices stabilised. However, 
volumes deteriorated as uncertainty created by the 
general election and subsequently delayed inaugural 
government budget led to project postponements. 
The Merchanting businesses also faced increased 
competitive intensity in the second half of the year.
Toolstation continued to gain market share across 
the year in both the UK and Benelux with volume 
growth, despite a declining market, and robust 
pricing. Maturity benefits from the investment in the 
store network and customer proposition continue to 
come through.

23
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Operating profit
£m
2024
2023 
(re-presented1) 
Change
Merchanting
149
212
(29.7)%
Toolstation
21
3
600.0%
Unallocated costs
(29)
(32)
9.4%
Adjusted operating profit 
excluding property profits
141
183
(23.0)%
Property profits
11
15
(26.7)%
Adjusted operating profit 
152
198
(23.2)%
Amortisation of acquired 
intangible assets 
(11)
(10)
Adjusting items
(139)
(27)
Operating profit
2
161
Finance charge
Net finance charges were in line with prior year at £41m (see note 6 
for details).
Taxation
The tax charge before adjusting items was £34m (2023: £44m) giving 
an adjusted effective tax rate (adjusted ‘ETR’) of 30.4% (standard rate: 
25.0%, 2023 actual: 31.5%). The adjusted ETR rate is substantially 
higher than the standard rate due to the effect of expenses not 
deductible for tax purposes and unutilised overseas losses.
The statutory tax charge for 2024 was £2m (2023: £32m) giving 
an effective tax rate of (5.7)% (2023: 26.3%). This is lower than the 
adjusted ETR as a result of the tax effect of the impairment of goodwill.
Earnings per share
The Group reported a total loss after tax of £(77)m (2023: profit 
of £38m) resulting in basic loss per share of (36.6) pence (2023: 
earnings per share of 18.1 pence). Diluted loss per share was (36.6) 
pence (2023: earnings per share of 17.8 pence).
Adjusted profit after tax was £77m (2023: £115m) resulting in adjusted 
earnings per share of 36.6 pence (2023: 54.4 pence). 
Cash flow and balance sheet
Free cash flow
£m
2024
2023  
(re-presented1)
Change
Adjusted operating profit  
excluding property profits
141
183
(42)
Depreciation of PPE and other 
non-cash movements
96
99
(3)
Change in working capital
6
(23)
29
Net interest paid  
(excluding lease interest)
(20)
(25)
5
Interest on lease liabilities
(30)
(26)
(4)
Tax paid
(21)
(41)
20
Adjusted operating cash flow
172
167
5
Capital investments
Capex excluding freehold 
transactions
(64)
(107)
43
Proceeds from disposals  
excluding freehold transactions
1
2
(1)
Free cash flow
109
62
47
The Group made strong progress on cash generation with free  
cash flow £47m higher than the prior year despite a reduction of  
£(42)m in adjusted operating profit excluding property profits. Key to 
this improvement was a disciplined approach to capital expenditure 
and a comprehensive review of stock management practices which 
resulted in a £64m reduction in stock holding. This was offset by a 
£(58)m working capital outflow related to debtors and creditors, the 
majority of which resulted from the temporary impact of process 
changes following the Oracle finance system implementation.
Capital investment
£m
2024
2023  
(re-presented1)
Strategic
21
49
Maintenance
39
52
IT
4
6
Base capital expenditure
64
107
Freehold property
12
33
Gross capital expenditure
76
140
Disposals
(63)
(68)
Net capital expenditure
13
72
Base capital expenditure was reduced by £43m during the year as 
a result of a more disciplined approach, predominantly on strategic 
investment. As part of the Group’s prioritisation of reducing leverage, 
freehold development and acquisitions were £51m lower than 
the proceeds of freehold disposals, which were primarily sale and 
leaseback transactions.
Uses of free cash flow
£m
2024
2023
Change
Free cash flow
109
62
47
Investments in freehold property
(12)
(33)
21
Disposal proceeds from freehold 
transactions
62
67
(5)
Dividends paid
(23)
(82)
59
Cash payments on adjusting items
(20)
(11)
(9)
Drawdown of borrowings
–
100
(100)
Repayment of bonds
–
(180)
180
Other
(16)
(15)
(1)
Change in cash and cash 
equivalents
100
(92)
Note: Cashflows related to Toolstation France are classified above as “Other”.
Cash and cash equivalents increased by £100m driven by strong free 
cash flow, a planned reduction in freehold property investment and 
adherence to the Group’s policy on dividend distribution.
In the prior year, the balance of the 2023 bond (£180m) was repaid 
and largely replaced with £100m of US private placement notes.
1	
For continuing businesses only. The Toolstation France business is treated as a discontinued operation and excluded from the re-presented 2023 figures.

24
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL REVIEW CONTINUED
Net debt and funding
£m
31 Dec  
2024
31 Dec  
2023
Change
Covenant
Net debt
£845m
£922m
£77m
Net debt/adjusted EBITDA
2.5x
2.6x
0.1x
<4.0x
Net debt before leases
£191m
£314m
£123m
Net debt before leases/  
adjusted EBITDA
0.6x
0.9x
0.3x
Note:	All covenant metrics measured post IFRS16. In accordance with the Group’s debt covenant 
definitions, the comparative year has not been re-presented to exclude the result of the Toolstation 
France business.
Net debt before leases reduced by £123m driven primarily by 
improvements in stock management, a disciplined approach to capital 
expenditure and a reduction in the dividend. Additionally, a legacy 
pension SPV has been unwound, reducing net debt by £25m, as part 
of a clear roadmap to transferring the fully funded closed defined 
benefit schemes to insurers.
Overall net debt reduced by £77m as lease liabilities increased by 
£46m, a result of recent sale-and-leaseback transactions and also the 
move to transfer the Group’s forklift truck fleet to be fully electric, with 
all new forklifts being leased.
Funding
As at 31 December 2024, the Group’s committed funding of £800m 
comprised:
•	 £250m guaranteed notes due February 2026, listed on the London
Stock Exchange.
•	 £75m bilateral bank loan due August 2027.
•	 A revolving credit facility of £375m maturing in November 2028.
•	 £100m of US private placement notes, maturing in equal tranches in
August 2029, August 2030 and August 2031.
As at 31 December 2024, the Group had undrawn committed facilities 
of £390m (2023: £390m) and deposited cash of £200m (2023: 
£102m), giving overall liquidity headroom of £590m (2023: £492m).
As part of the refinancing of the £250m February 2026 sterling bond, 
on 13 March 2025 the Group issued £125m of US private placement 
notes to a group of six investors with maturities between 2028 and 
2035 at investment grade yields.
Financial risk management
The overall aim of the Group’s financial risk management policies is to 
minimise potential adverse effects on financial performance and net 
assets. The Group manages the principal financial and treasury risks 
within a framework of policies and operating parameters reviewed and 
approved annually by the Board of Directors. The Group does not enter 
into speculative transactions.
The Group has a revolving credit facility with a syndicate of eight banks 
with a total value of £375m (2023: £375m). The facility has a 2028 
maturity date with an option to extend the maturity date to 2030.
The Group has £425m of committed funding from the issuance of 
bonds and loans: £250m guaranteed notes due February 2026, 
listed on the London Stock Exchange; £75m bilateral bank loan due 
August 2027; £100m of US private placement notes, maturing in equal 
tranches in August 2029, August 2030 and August 2031.
In March 2025 the Group issued £125m of senior unsecured notes to 
a syndicate of six investors. The proceeds of the issuance will be used 
to refinance a portion of the Group’s £250m public bond maturing in 
February 2026.
The Group’s policy is to enter into derivative contracts only with 
members of its bank facility syndicate, provided such counterparties 
meet the minimum rating set out in the Board-approved derivative 
policy. At the year-end the Group had a £75m interest rate swap 
outstanding and its borrowings were fixed on 100% of the Group’s 
cleared gross debt (before cash and cash equivalents).
The Group settles its currency denominated purchases using a 
combination of currency purchased at spot rates and currency bought 
in advance on forward contracts. It purchases forward contracts for 
approximately 90% of its committed requirements six months forward 
based on the firm placement of forward stock purchases. At 31 
December 2024 the nominal value of currency forward contracts was 
US$24m (2023: US$22m and €6m).
The Group is a substantial provider of credit to a large portfolio of 
small and medium-size businesses throughout the UK together with 
some of the country’s largest construction companies. It manages 
its exposure to credit risk through a strong credit control function 
that works closely with the business and its customers to ensure the 
Group offers credit sufficient for the needs of those customers without 
exposing the Group to excessive risk. The bad debt charge in 2024 was 
approximately 0.4% (2023: 0.3%) of credit sales.
In summary, the key aspects of the Group’s financial risk management 
strategy are to:
•	 Run the business to investment-grade credit parameters.
•	 Reduce reliance on the bank market for funding by having a diverse
mix of funding sources with a spread of maturities.
•	 Seek to maintain a strong balance sheet.
•	 Place a high priority on effective cash and working capital management.
•	 Maintain liquidity headroom of over £200m and build and maintain
good relationships with the Group’s banking syndicate.
•	 Manage counterparty risk by raising funds from a syndicate of lenders,
the members of which maintain investment grade credit ratings.
•	 Operate banking covenants attached to the Group’s revolving credit
facilities and term loan within comfortable margins.
•	 Maintain the ratio of reported net debt to adjusted EBITDA in the
range of 1.5x to 2.0x. It was 2.5x (2023 (restated): 2.6x) at the 
year-end.
•	 Have a conservative hedging policy that reduces the Group’s exposure
to currency fluctuations.

25
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
The financial ratios are calculated under IFRS as adopted by the EU as 
it was immediately before the adoption of IFRS 16 – Leases, except for 
the August 2022 loan agreement which has economically equivalent 
tests that incorporate the impact of IFRS 16 – Leases. Tax strategy and 
tax risk management
The Group’s objectives in managing and controlling its tax affairs and 
related tax risks are as follows:
•	 Ensuring compliance with all applicable rules, legislation and 
regulations under which it operates.
•	 Maintaining an open and cooperative relationship with the UK tax 
authorities and with the tax authorities that the Group’s overseas 
businesses operate under, to reduce the Group’s risk profile.
•	 Paying the correct amount of tax as it falls due.
Tax policies and risks are assessed as part of the formal governance 
process and are reviewed by the Chief Financial Officer and reported 
to the Audit Committee on a regular basis. Significant tax risks, 
implications arising from these risks and potential mitigating actions 
are considered by the Board when strategic decisions are taken. In 
particular the tax risks of proposed transactions or new areas of 
business are fully considered before proceeding. The Group employs 
professional tax specialists in the UK to manage tax risks and takes 
appropriate tax advice from professional firms where it is considered to 
be necessary for both its UK and overseas operations. The Group’s tax 
strategy is published on its website.
Total tax contribution
The table below provides a reconciliation of the income taxes paid by 
the Group in the financial year compared to the tax charge shown in 
the Group’s Financial Statements. Details of the total tax contribution 
made by the Group in 2024 and tax collected on behalf of tax 
authorities is also detailed below.
Reconciliation of tax paid to tax charge:
£m
Total tax charge per accounts
2.2
Deferred tax credit*
33.3
True up of prior periods tax liability
(0.6)
Tax deductions in reserves
–
Current tax payable on 2024 profits
34.9
Tax paid in 2024 to be refunded in 2025
(3.0)
Tax refunds received in 2024 relating to years prior to 2024
(11.0)
Total net current taxes paid in 2024
20.9
Other taxes paid in 2024:
Business rates
38.9
National Insurance contributions
48.9
Other taxes and duties
16.2
Total tax contribution for 2024
124.9
Tax collected in 2024:
PAYE
77.2
Employee's NI
31.6
VAT
192.1
Total tax collected and paid for 2024
425.8
*	
Certain profits and costs recognised in the Financial Statements do not result in a cash tax 
effect until a future date. When this happens an accounting entry, called deferred tax, is made 
to recognise the expected future tax cost or benefit.
Viability assessment
In accordance with Provision 31 of the UK Corporate Governance Code, 
published by the Financial Reporting Council in 2018, the Board of 
Directors has undertaken an assessment of the viability of the Group.
As part of its deliberations the Board undertook a robust review of 
the Emerging and Principal Risks and Uncertainties facing the Group, 
how they are managed and the actions that could be taken to mitigate 
their effect or avoid them altogether. The resulting disclosures, which 
include those risks that could threaten the Group’s business model, 
performance, solvency and liquidity are shown on pages 59 to 69 of 
the Annual Report. The Board believes the Group is well-placed to 
manage those risks successfully.
The Board has decided that it is appropriate to assess the performance 
of the Group over a three-year period from 28 February 2025, the 
month-end date closest to the approval of the 2024 annual results.
Three years has been chosen because this is the period that it is 
reasonably possible to forecast forward with a degree of accuracy. 
This is because the Group is subject to the vagaries of the economic 
cycle and property market which cannot reasonably be forecast with 
certainty further than three years forward. Whilst the Board has no 
reason to believe the Group will not remain viable over a longer period, 
the inherent uncertainty involved means three years is the appropriate 
period over which to give users of the Annual Report a reasonable 
degree of confidence.
The Corporate Plan, which is prepared annually on a rolling basis, 
considers the Group’s future profitability, cash flows, liquidity headroom, 
availability of funds and covenant compliance. For the purposes of 
the viability review, the Board has performed a robust sensitivity 
analysis to stress test the downside scenario principally based upon 
the 2008/2009 financial crisis and the mitigating actions that would 
be taken to protect the Group’s viability. These actions include reducing 
costs, capital spend, revenue investment and payments to shareholders, 
as well as restricting credit to customers. In undertaking this analysis, 
the Board considered the impact on the wider economy and property 
market from the current interest rate environment and cost-price 
inflation in building materials and energy prices, as well as general price 
levels. Given the Group’s trading experience in the Covid-19 pandemic 
and the nature of the near-term risks to the economy, the use of the 
2008–2009 financial crisis as a model for a prolonged downturn in the 
housing market remains appropriate.
Based upon the assessment undertaken, the Directors confirm that 
they have a reasonable expectation that the Group will be able to 
continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due over the 
three-year period of their assessment.

26
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT
Building for Better
As the UK’s largest distributor of building materials, Travis 
Perkins plc is committed to driving meaningful Environmental, 
Social and Governance (“ESG”) change in the construction 
industry. This commitment to customers, colleagues and 
communities covers every aspect of the business. Besides 
a focus on improving the performance of its own business, 
the Group works proactively with suppliers and customers 
and recognises the important role it plays as a convener 
and influencer in the development of more sustainable 
communities.
Building on the progress made since the Group launched 
its first Building for Better framework and targets in 2020, 
this latest status report provides an update on performance 
in the focus areas where the Group carries the most risk or 
opportunity, as shown in the framework.
BUILDING FOR BETTER
SUSTAINABILITY PRIORITY
Decarbonising the industry
Modernising 
construction
Provide sustainable 
products and services 
to support Modern 
Methods of Construction, 
retrofit, energy efficiency, 
decarbonisation, climate 
resilience, biodiversity, 
nature, water and waste.
Sourcing 
responsibly
Ensure safe and quality 
products from ethical, 
traceable and resilient 
supply chains. Support the 
golden thread 
of data.
Operating 
sustainably
Lead by example within 
the Group’s operations. 
Deliver net-zero  
carbon and reduce 
operational waste.
Developing the 
next generation
Upskill the Group’s 
colleagues and the 
wider industry in green 
and future skills to 
help facilitate sector 
improvements.
DOING THE RIGHT THING
Safety & Wellbeing  |  Diversity, Equity & Inclusion  |  Colleague Voice  |  Reward 
Charity & Community  |  Modern Slavery & Human Rights  |  Legal Compliance

27
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
The Double Materiality Map illustrates the Group’s key priorities based on double materiality, taking into 
account impacts on the Group and the Group’s impacts on the environment, society and the market.
The Group will continue to review the material focus areas to ensure that the most important topics for 
the business and for its stakeholders are in scope.
DECARBONISING THE INDUSTRY
DOING THE RIGHT THING
MODERNISING 
CONSTRUCTION
SOURCING
RESPONSIBLY
DEVELOPING THE 
NEXT GENERATION
OPERATING 
SUSTAINABLY
Employee safety 
and wellbeing
Culture  
and purpose
Responsible and 
transparent business
Responsible 
marketing  
and selling
Access to sustainable 
and resilience-
improving solutions
Biodiversity, nature 
and forestry
Responsible sourcing 
and relationships 
with suppliers
Human rights and 
modern slavery
Developing skills 
and knowledge in 
the community
Skills, apprenticeships 
and training
Carbon emissions
Operational waste 
management
Identified as a top ten priority for inwards impact. An 
issue that can materially impact Travis Perkins plc.
Pay and  
reward
Employee 
engagement 
and relations
Diversity, equity 
and inclusion
Business 
and operations 
community impacts 
Identified as a top ten priority for outwards impact. An 
issue that Travis Perkins plc has a material impact on.
Water use
Product packaging 
and circularity
Data use and 
responsibility
Product safety 
and quality
Air quality
Collaborative partnership
In 2024 the Group further developed the 
sustainable products, data and services it offers, in 
response to increasing requests from customers for 
support on decarbonisation and other sustainability 
issues. The Group is an active member of a number 
of industry working groups to better understand 
industry challenges, share best practices and 
influence and develop shared approaches where 
this brings efficiencies:
1.	 National Retrofit Hub
2.	 Future Homes Hub
3.	 Builders Merchant Federation
4.	 Logistics UK 
This external participation reflects the Group’s 
biggest sustainability risks or opportunities and 
allows the Group to evolve its approach as needed, 
remaining relevant for customers and other 
stakeholders.
2024 performance summary
Despite a tough economic climate, sustainability 
requirements from the Group’s largest customers 
continue to increase. The focus in 2024 has been 
on prioritised in-year initiatives as well as the 
development of the product ranges and data needed 
to drive sustainable and commercial success in the 
medium to long term. The Group’s position in the 
supply chain between thousands of customers and 
suppliers means it is able to collaborate with the 
supply chain to co-create solutions and influence 
the changes the industry needs. 
The Group has three sustainability targets relating 
to carbon and skills and in-year objectives for all 
other focus areas. The two carbon targets are SBTi-
approved as in line with a 1.5˚ warming pathway (see 
page 44), and the skills target is to achieve 10,000 
graduated apprentices by 2030 through the Group’s 
LEAP apprenticeship provider.
These targets will be reviewed in 2025, taking into 
account delays in government policy, funding and 
infrastructure improvements, all of which are critical 
to the Group’s ability to meet these targets.
The Group made progress towards its carbon 
reduction targets in 2024 with specific actions 
including the completion of the electric forklift 
roll-out, Hydrotreated Vegetable Oil (“HVO”) use 
for 210 HGVs and LED installations, as well as 
data improvements for Scope 3. However, it is 
recognised that absolute carbon reductions are in 
part due to market volume declines. In addition, the 
previously reported relative carbon performance 
per £m revenue has been impacted by inflation. 
As such, a new relative performance measure has 
been introduced from 2024; carbon per tonne of 
product sold. This indicates a potential future risk 
of deterioration in the Group’s Scope 3 carbon 
performance once sales volumes pick up. Work is 
underway to influence Scope 3 improvements in the 
value chain. Absolute performance from 2023 to 
2024 is -13% for Scope 1&2 and -7% for Scope 3. 
Performance relative to tonnes of product sold from 
2023 to 2024 is -10% for Scope 1&2 and -3% for 
Scope 3. It is important to consider carbon intensity 
in a period of sales decline to gain a more balanced 
view of performance. Further carbon performance 
data can be seen on pages 57-58.
A total of 427 colleagues and industry partners 
graduated in apprenticeships facilitated by LEAP, the 
Group’s Early Careers and Apprenticeship Provider in 
2024. This contributes to the Group’s upskilling target.
Work in all other focus areas has moved forward 
and progress is reported on the following pages.
Double materiality and stakeholder engagement
The Group continued to engage with its stakeholders 
on ESG during 2024. These interactions 
demonstrated that the material focus areas for the 
Group remain unchanged from those that were 
determined in the 2022 in-depth ESG double 
materiality assessment. Ongoing engagement with 
all stakeholder groups ensures that the Group’s 
strategic choices and reporting remain focused on 
the most important issues. The Double Materiality 
Map below illustrates key priorities for the Group 
and these will be reassessed in 2025.
The Group actively engages with stakeholders to 
share progress, inform plans, listen to feedback and 
seek views. The key stakeholder groups, their ESG 
concerns and the Group’s engagements with them 
in 2024 are detailed in the Section 172 statement on 
pages 78-80.

28
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Delivering 
social value
The Group delivers value to its communities in many ways. 
Below are some of the highlights from 2024.
SKILLS DEVELOPMENT
OPERATIONAL IMPACT
COMMUNITY INVESTMENT
Governance of sustainability
The Board has overall responsibility for 
sustainability. The Group Sustainability 
Director supports the Group in 
developing, governing and delivering 
against its sustainability strategy. 
Each of the material focus areas has 
a Group lead supported by nominated 
leads and leadership sponsors in each 
business. Progress is reported to the 
Group Leadership Team and the Board 
to monitor and improve performance. 
The Stay Safe Committee of the Board 
oversees performance in health and 
safety. Policies and objectives are in place 
for each material focus area. The Group’s 
ESG policies can be found on the Group’s 
website.
Climate-related financial risks and 
opportunities
Since 2010, the Group has submitted 
an annual climate disclosure to the 
Carbon Disclosure Project (“CDP”) 
This includes a financial assessment of 
climate-related risks and opportunities. 
The Group has prepared its fourth full 
disclosure against the Task Force for 
Climate-related Financial Disclosure 
(“TCFD”) recommendations on pages 
43-58. During 2024 the Group further 
enhanced its climate risk and opportunity 
assessment through desktop analysis 
of the published TCFD reports of large 
suppliers and customers.
Corporate Sustainability Reporting 
Directive (“CSRD”) compliance
Toolstation Europe will report in line 
with CSRD at such time as it becomes 
applicable to their business.
Alignment to UN Sustainable 
Development Goals
Through the Building for Better ESG 
agenda, the Group directly supports 
delivery of a number of the 17 UN 
Sustainable Development Goals 
(“SDGs”). The most relevant six goals are 
detailed in the table on page 29. With 
the Group’s sustainability priority being 
to decarbonise the industry, Goal 13 on 
Climate Action is taken into account 
across all ESG focus areas and influences 
decision-making.
Graduated apprentices
427
378 for Group colleagues, 49 for the industry
Transport carbon reduction
11.5%
Amount raised for charity
£1m
Revenue from products with Environmental 
Product Declarations or Life Cycle Analyses
14%
Number of social value projects 
supported
295
Enrolled apprentices
1,019
841 for Group colleagues, 178 for the industry
Female apprentices
29%
Spend on goods-for-resale with SMEs
26%
Total social value project value
£2.1m
Apprentices under 25 years old
34%
Employed colleagues (FTE)
17,464
Apprentices from ethnic minorities
8%
Investment in colleague total reward 
packages
£599m
Hours of ESG training completed 
in-house or through the Supply Chain 
Sustainability School
85,394
Total tax contribution
£426m
£125m taxes borne, £301m taxes collected

29
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Material focus areas
Commitment
2024 planned actions 
Progress
2025 planned actions
 Supporting the Group’s strategy
SDGs
MODERNISING CONSTRUCTION
Sustainable products and services  
to support Modern Methods of 
Construction, retrofit, energy efficiency, 
decarbonisation, climate resilience, 
biodiversity, nature, water and waste.
63% reduction in 
Scope 3 carbon 
by 2035
Develop a definition of sustainable products based on robust 
criteria and launch within at least one Group business.
Increase the percentage of sales backed by Environmental 
Product Declarations from 10.7% (2023).
Good
Launch data set to help customers to identify products with 
sustainable attributes across at least two of the Group’s 
businesses. 
Continue to increase the coverage and quality of product-
level carbon data across the Group and support customers 
with carbon-reporting tools.
By providing sustainable products 
and value-add services to customers, 
the Group can earn a greater share of 
spend and become a key partner.
 
SOURCING RESPONSIBLY
Safe and quality products from ethical, 
traceable and resilient  
supply chains, supporting the  
golden thread of data.
Develop the Group’s due diligence approach, with a target of 
the supplier assessment programme covering 90% of Group 
spend on products-for-resale by the end of 2024.
Good
Expand the share of Group spend which is covered by 
supplier assessments across both GNFR and GFR suppliers.
Customer relationships are 
underpinned by trust in the Group to 
source responsibly and meet changing 
data transparency requirements.
 
OPERATING SUSTAINABLY
Net-zero carbon and reduced operational 
waste. Leading by example in the Group’s 
operations. 
Net-zero for 
Scope 1 and 2 
carbon by 2035, 
with at least 
80% reduction
Continue with carbon training to enable colleagues to drive 
energy and fuel reduction and better support customers by 
sharing best practice.
Good
Take stock of the Group’s estate and assets, considering 
the availability of current and emerging low-carbon 
technologies, to inform the continued development of the 
Group’s Fleet and Estate decarbonisation roadmaps for the 
years ahead.
All of the Group’s stakeholders expect 
credible action on operational carbon 
and waste. Performance can influence 
the outcome of customer tenders.
 
DEVELOPING THE NEXT GENERATION
Upskilling colleagues and the wider 
industry in green and future skills to help 
facilitate sector improvements.
10,000 
graduated 
apprentices  
by 2030
Introduce a flexible apprenticeship which will include 
placements with other businesses in the sector. Launch 
a suite of micro-qualifications: short, focused learning 
programmes for job-related skills and knowledge.
Good
Develop the Group’s Learning and Development (L&D) 
offering in line with the new Government’s “Growth and 
Skills” levy funds to support a wider range of training and 
development programmes, extending beyond traditional 
apprenticeships.
To best support customers in a changing 
market, green and future skills are 
critical. As a trusted and leading partner 
to the construction industry, customers 
value the Group’s expertise and advice.
 
DOING THE RIGHT THING
Safety and wellbeing: Getting everyone home safe and well, 
every single day.
Continue to embed the growing culture of “Calling it out”, 
taking time to “Stop, Step Back, Think. Then Act” by ensuring 
daily team briefings take place at all locations.
Good
Introduce a new second line of defence safety assurance 
programme, and continue focus on out-of-branch safety, 
including safe deliveries. 
Doing the Right Thing deepens 
relationships with customers as 
expectations around responsible 
business increase.
Diversity, equity and inclusion: Creating an environment 
where everyone can be themselves.
Target an engagement survey score for the statement “I feel 
a sense of belonging at this Company” above the provider’s 
global average by the end of 2025.
Some
The Group is targeting an engagement survey score for the 
statement “I feel a sense of belonging at this company” in 
excess of the provider’s global average by the end of 2025.
Colleague voice: Listening to colleagues to make better 
decisions and increase engagement.
Develop action plans to address the priorities and issues that 
have the biggest impact on engagement and therefore  
on overall business performance.
Some
Conduct analysis of the engagement survey, ensuring clear 
actions are identified, set and taken at a Group, Business and 
local level; leveraging engagement as a performance lever.
Charity and community: Taking pride in helping others and 
making positive change happen.
Grow colleague volunteer hours and build charity and 
community partnerships that deliver on the Group’s impact 
goals and use these partnerships deliver social value.
Some
Continue to use charity and community partnership and 
activity to create meaningful social change both nationally 
and locally; working with established and new partners.
Reward: Improving the financial health of colleagues.
Continue to explore ways to support colleague long-term 
financial resilience and wider wellbeing.
Some
Focus on incentive structures to drive engagement and 
performance. Provide further support to those approaching 
retirement to reflect the challenges of an ageing population.
Modern slavery and human rights: Eliminating modern 
slavery from the Group and its supply chains.
Extend in-person ID checks, currently conducted on higher-risk 
labour agency workers, to other third parties.
Some
Development and delivery of additional controls for labour 
agency workers employed at Group sites, including controls 
to address the risk of modern slavery.
Legal compliance: Complying with all relevant laws.
Develop the internal Doing the Right Thing portal to increase 
understanding of legal compliance policies and guidance.
Some
Development and delivery of further bespoke training to 
cover a number of key compliance areas, to complement 
existing training modules.
Sustainability priority: Decarbonising the industry

30
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Modernising construction
Providing sustainable products and services to support retrofit, Modern Methods of Construction, energy efficiency, 
decarbonisation, climate resilience, biodiversity, nature, water and waste.
Why it is important
The built environment is responsible for 25% of 
emissions in the UK along with a wide number of 
other sustainability challenges. Customer needs are 
changing and the Group needs to adapt to remain 
relevant, seize the opportunity and provide different 
products, data and services. With 99% of the 
Group’s carbon footprint in the supply chain, due to 
manufactured carbon and in-use product emissions, 
innovation is essential. Enabling sustainable 
construction and retrofit supports the needs of 
customers and the wider community, enabling 
healthier, more cost efficient and more sustainable 
buildings.
Progress in 2024
In 2024, the Group further developed its product, 
data and service proposition for customers, working 
alongside suppliers and other partners. The Group’s 
product offering has been enhanced with new 
product ranges, particularly across renewables 
and low-carbon heat, enabling the supply of a full 
retrofit basket of goods. This product expansion 
aligns with growing customer interest and demand 
for sustainability, led by either EPC requirements 
or their own sustainability goals, and the Group is 
strategically positioning itself to meet their evolving 
expectations. Progress was made against the 
Group’s two stated objectives: the introduction of 
definitions for sustainable attributes of products 
and increased coverage of sales by Environmental 
Product Declarations (“EPDs”).
The Group made further progress towards its 
science-based Scope 3 carbon target of 63% 
reduction by 2035 from a 2020 baseline, with a 
further 7% absolute reduction in 2024. However, 
tonnes of Scope 3 carbon per tonne of product sold 
only decreased by 3% during 2024 highlighting 
reduced sales as the primary driver of the decline, 
rather than product decarbonisation. 
Reduction can only meaningfully follow engagement 
(supplier target setting) and data accuracy (product-
level carbon data) and these two points have 
improved over the last few years, setting the Group 
up for future reduction opportunities. More detailed 
carbon data is shared on pages 57-58.
Working with suppliers, customers and the 
wider industry to enable change
99% of the Group’s emissions are in its supply 
chain and this is due primarily to the embodied 
carbon from manufacturing the products sold and 
the operational carbon of some of those products 
in use, such as gas boilers. The Group’s Scope 3 
hot spots typically mirror those of its customers; 
supporting customers to improve also drives 
performance against the Group’s own carbon 
targets. Recognising that Scope 3 emissions are 
not in the direct control of the Group, engagement 
with suppliers, customers and the wider industry is 
critical to influence and drive change. 
Tonnes of CO2e (Absolute) – Scope 3
2035* 1.4m
1.4m
0.3m
2024
3.3m
0.8m
2.3m
2023
2.6m
3.5m
0.9m
2020 Baseline
3.8m
3.9m
0.8m
0m
1.0m
2.0m
3.0m
4.0m
5.0m
6.0m
7.0m
8.0m
9.0m
Tonnes of CO2e (Absolute) – Scope 3
*	
Target year.
Category 1
Category 11
All other categories
 indicates that the data point has been assured. Please see page 35 for more information.
Carbon reduction (Absolute Scope 3, 2020 to 2024)
-23%
Carbon reduction (Absolute Scope 3, 2023 to 2024)
-7%

31
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Suppliers
The Group continues to work with manufacturers to 
encourage them to calculate and reduce their own 
emissions, develop new materials and products and provide 
product-level sustainability data, typically Environmental 
Product Declarations (“EPDs”).
•	 61% of the Group’s spend is now with suppliers who have 
calculated their carbon and set reduction targets (57%  
in 2023).
•	 14% of sales value was covered by high-quality emission 
factors (EPDs or LCAs) applied at a product level (11% at  
end of 2023). All other sales were covered by good-quality 
emissions factors at a product level (an additional 32%) or at 
product sub-category level (remaining 54%). Work continues 
to increase the use of product-level emissions factors.
•	 The Group’s renewables range has been expanded, with 
customers now offered a much wider range of renewables 
and a complete basket of retrofit products, across both 
systems and fabric.
Customers
The Group works with customers to help them to deliver 
net zero new builds and to retrofit the UK’s existing built 
estate, providing the products, data and services they 
need. The demand for sustainable products and solutions 
represents a growth opportunity for the Group and, with the 
breadth of products available across each of the businesses, 
the collective product offering affords opportunities for 
customers which few in the industry could match.
•	 A product-carbon reporting tool was developed for CCF 
customers, now rolling out with CCF and more widely 
across the Group.
•	 CCF launched an own-branded low-carbon steel framing 
alternative, Tradeline Lite.
•	 A dedicated renewables category team was established in 
order to meet growing demand.
•	 The first customer homes have been built using the 
WholeHouse® digital platform developed by the Group (see 
case study on the right).
Wider industry
The Group engages with its supply chain, industry bodies 
and government to enable the changes needed both for 
itself and its customers.
•	 The Group continued its partnership with the National 
Retrofit Hub, co-chairing the Supply Chain, Products and 
Solutions working group and helping to shape retrofit 
delivery for the UK. 
•	 The Group is represented in sustainability working groups 
with the Builders Merchant Federation, Future Homes Hub, 
Supply Chain Sustainability School and Sustainability in the 
Built Environment Working Group in order to learn from 
others, share best practices and remove duplication and 
complexity on shared challenges. 
•	 The Group sponsored a decarbonisation launch event at 
the decarbonisation hub Ty Gwyrddfai owned by one of its 
large social housing customers, Adra, in Penygroes. This 
provided an opportunity to showcase innovative products 
to a wide range of social housing and local authority 
customers across North Wales.
Helping customers through enriched data  
and information
In response to a growing demand for information on 
sustainable alternatives in product ranges, the Group has 
been developing new data points for products to highlight 
sustainable attributes with a clear set of definitions and 
rules. This is important to ensure that both customers and 
the wider market can trust the claims being made and to 
avoid the risk of greenwashing. This new data set is planned 
to launch in the first half of 2025 in one of the Group’s 
businesses, expanding to the rest of the Group thereafter. 
This will enable the Group to answer customer queries 
confidently and customers to trust the claims being made  
on products sold to them.
The design coordination and information 
available ahead of construction has been 
a real advantage, from the Pre-
Manufactured Utility Cupboard, allowing 
the air source heat pump to be installed 
more efficiently and effectively on-site, 
all the way down to every door being the 
same size to simplify both site practices 
and the wider supply chain.
Ray Jordan
Construction Director, Bowbridge Homes Ltd
First homes built using 
Travis Perkins WholeHouse
In 2024, the first home designed and 
built using the Group’s ground-breaking 
WholeHouse digital platform was completed 
in Leicestershire. The platform was used by 
Bowbridge Homes Ltd to develop a pair of 
semi-detached properties on its site near 
Melton Mowbray.
This significant milestone follows the launch 
of WholeHouse in 2023; a platform designed 
to revolutionise the way SME house builders 
plan, design and construct new homes. 
The platform is specifically designed for 
housebuilders building up to 250 units a year.
It means SME housebuilders can plan and 
design a bespoke digital model of a house 
before physically constructing it. It ensures 
detailed and accurate design, plans and 
material pricing of developments from the 
first day. From start to finish, the process can 
be completed in under an hour, saving weeks 
off the planning process and construction 
phase to the benefit of both builders and 
homeowners.
Using the WholeHouse platform, Bowbridge 
Homes were able to develop two of the 
existing properties on the site, enabling them 
to increase their thermal performance and 
try new renewable heating packages without 
having to spend months changing designs 
and checking compliance with the latest 
regulations.
The homes are the first of many to be 
developed using WholeHouse, with further  
site starts expected to begin later this year.
What’s next
•	 Launch data set to help customers to identify products 
with sustainable attributes across at least one of the 
Group’s businesses.
•	 Continue to increase the coverage and quality of 
product-level carbon data across the Group and  
support customers with carbon-reporting tools.
For more information visit: www.wholehouse.uk

32
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Delivered by
Operational Toolkit: 
Combatting Slavery in 
the Built Environment
Empowering site teams with 
actionable insights and resources 
to address labour exploitation
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Sourcing responsibly
Ensuring safe and quality products from ethical, traceable and sustainable supply chains.
Why it is important
The Group sources hundreds of thousands of 
product lines from thousands of suppliers and has a 
responsibility to understand and manage products 
and supply chains well. The way in which products 
and services are sourced has a material impact on 
environmental and social sustainability. By requiring 
and supporting suppliers to improve and report on 
their product quality, product data and operations, 
the Group can protect itself and its customers, who 
increasingly request evidence of this. Improved data, 
provision of product information and traceability of 
products will bring more accountability and effective 
decision-making to the construction sector.
Progress in 2024
The primary objective for 2024 was continued 
development of the Group’s due diligence approach, 
targeting 90% of Group spend on goods-for-resale 
to be within the supplier assessment programme.  
At the end of 2024, 90% of Group spend on goods-
for-resale was within the programme, an increase 
from 85% at the end of 2023.
Due diligence on product suppliers
The Online Risk Assessment (“ORA”) has been 
issued to the next phase of Group suppliers, taking a 
risk-based approach. ORAs were submitted by 392 
suppliers of products for resale in 2024 with 1,403 
suppliers now engaged in the ORA programme.
Own-brand product manufacturing sites are subject 
to in-person ethical and technical audits, with all 
ethical audits completed by a third-party auditor. In 
2024, 199 factory audit gradings were completed. 
Where issues were identified, time-bound corrective 
action plans were used to support suppliers to resolve 
these. Suppliers resolved 3,556 non-conformances 
through engagement with the supplier assessment 
programme.
A short version of the assessment has been 
implemented within the Group’s new finance system 
for onboarding lower spend suppliers and has been 
completed by 204 suppliers during 2024.
Assessment of Goods-Not-For-Resale 
(“GNFR”) suppliers
The Group’s GNFR ORA, alongside an internal 
assessment, was extended to additional suppliers 
on a risk-basis across all businesses and Group 
functions, covering 54% of the Group spend on 
GNFR by the end of 2024.
Maintaining safe and sustainable timber 
supply chains
90.1% of timber purchased by the Group in 2024 
was certified. The business continues to operate a 
robust timber chain of custody system in order to 
pass the “chain of custody” safely onto customers.
Collaboration across the industry
The Group Head of Responsible Sourcing, working 
within the Supply Chain Sustainability School’s Modern 
Slavery Working Group, contributed to the development 
and launch of a new modern slavery guidance 
document, “Operational Toolkit: Combatting Slavery  
in the Built Environment”.
This toolkit aims to empower individuals involved in 
site set up and management to effectively combat 
slavery and labour exploitation. It brings together 
insights and recommendations to help address these 
issues, including free resources such as posters, toolbox 
talks, and videos from leading modern slavery expert 
organisations to make it easier for businesses to find 
the support they need.
What’s next
Expand the share of Group 
spend which is covered by 
supplier assessments across 
both GNFR and GFR suppliers.
Certified timber purchased in 2024
90.1%

33
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Working to raise standards in construction 
product information
CCF successfully passed the Code for 
Construction Product Information (“CCPI”) 
assessment for Merchants and Distributors. This 
achievement underscores CCF’s commitment 
to providing accurate and reliable product 
information to its customers.
The CCPI is a stamp of approval to verify 
that suppliers’ information on their products 
and systems is clear, accurate, up-to-date, 
accessible and unambiguous. For distributors it’s 
a verification that their processes and training 
means that they accurately relay suppliers 
product information to their customers.

34
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
2035 Target
5,022
10,796
2024
6,200
39,739
2023
44,932
7,750
2024
2020
508
25,929
53,981
25,111
2023
0
20,000
40,000
60,000
80,000
1,075
27,376
2022
Tonnes of CO2e (Absolute) – Scopes 1 & 2
1,622
25,913
0
Transport
Buildings
10,000
20,000
30,000
Tonnes of Waste
Landfilled Waste
Recycled/Recovered Waste
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Operating sustainably
Securing long-term success and efficiencies for the Group by adapting operations to deliver net zero carbon, reduce 
operational waste and prevent pollution.
Why it is important
The Group takes responsibility for direct 
environmental impacts from its estate of over 1,400 
sites and fleet of 2,500 vehicles, because it’s the 
right thing to do and to drive operational efficiencies 
and meet growing expectations of customers and 
investors. The Group has committed to reducing 
Scope 1 and 2 carbon – relating to the Group’s 
fleet and estate – by 80% by 2035 and offset any 
remaining emissions. Whilst 99% of the Group’s 
footprint is in the supply chain, to have integrity 
in asking suppliers and customers to decarbonise 
the Group must address its own direct emissions. 
Besides carbon, the Group generates waste in 
its operations, primarily relating to packaging or 
obsolete products, and takes its role in preventing, 
reusing, recycling and recovering waste seriously in 
order to minimise the use of natural resources and 
protect the natural environment.
Progress in 2024
In 2024, the Group committed to continue carbon 
training for colleagues and to better support 
customers by sharing best practices. Sustainability 
training, including carbon training, was delivered 
to over 8,500 colleagues either through online 
training modules or bespoke training sessions. 
Representation from the Group continued in a 
number of industry forums (see page 80) to share 
best practices and support customers. Additional 
action was taken to decarbonise the Group’s estate 
and fleet.
Decarbonising the estate
The Group’s estate consists of a number of 
distribution centres and over 1,400 branches. In 
2024 the Group continued to use a renewable 
energy tariff, saving 13,657 tCO2e emissions. Work 
continued on the rollout of the Group’s LED lighting 
project, upgrading lighting in 38 locations, replacing 
obsolete fluorescent lighting with modern, efficient, 
LED lighting and PIR sensors. Investment in this 
project, whilst not delivering additional carbon 
savings while the Group is on a renewable tariff, 
lowers the Group’s energy demand and delivers 
operational cost benefits. The Group has also taken 
action to decarbonise eight new branch openings, 
installing air source heat pumps, solar panels and 
electric vehicle charging stations. See the Swindon 
West case study for an example of this in practice.
Decarbonising the fleet
In 2024 the Group completed one of the UK’s largest 
forklift electrification programmes. This multi-million 
pound investment enabled the transition of diesel 
powered forklift trucks to a fully electric alternative. 
The programme resulted in a root and branches 
review of mobile handling equipment needs, and saw 
the introduction of around 900 electric forklift trucks 
and associated charging infrastructure. The Group is 
already seeing improvement in operational efficiency 
and it is estimated that this programme will reduce 
Scope 1 emissions by around 5,000 tonnes CO2e per 
annum. The Group also continued to use HVO instead 
of diesel in 210 of its HGVs during the year.
Progress against carbon targets
During 2024, Scope 1&2 carbon reduced by 13%, 
taking performance from the 2020 baseline year 
to 2024 to -42%. The absolute reduction is partly 
influenced by volume-driven activity decline in a 
tough economic climate. Carbon performance per 
tonne of product sold is shared on page 58.
Reducing operational waste
The Group aims to reduce operational waste 
and contribute to a more circular economy. In 
doing so, the Group has continued its reverse 
logistics programme, backhauling timber 
pallets (6,360 tonnes), plastic packaging (239 
tonnes), paper and cardboard (3,128 tonnes) to 
its distribution centres, to be sorted and sent 
for recycling. During the year the Group also 
reviewed its waste management framework 
contract, appointing Veolia as its trusted waste 
management partner.
Tonnes of CO2e (Absolute) – Scopes 1 & 2
Waste
 indicates that the data point has been assured.  
Please see page 35 for more information.
Carbon reduction (absolute 
scope 1 & 2, 2020 to 2024)
-42%
Percentage of waste diverted 
from landfill in 2024
98%

35
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Environmental management
The Group has a robust Environmental Management 
System (“EMS”) in place to help manage the 
potential environmental impacts from its day-to-
day activities. The EMS is central to the Group’s 
ambition to operate sustainably and is certified to 
ISO 14001:2015 the environmental management 
standard.
In 2024 the Group recorded 20 environmental 
incidents with nine classed as reportable by its 
internal procedures. Of the nine reportable incidents, 
six were the result of third parties. The majority of 
incidents related to small-scale spillages such as the 
release of hydraulic oils.
Assurance
Specific data points in the Sustainability section, 
marked with the logo , have been assured against 
LRQA verification procedures which are based on 
AA1000AS (2008) and ISAE 3000. A copy of their 
verification statement is available on our corporate 
website.
Travis Perkins Flagship branch 
Swindon Westmead gains 
BREEAM* “Excellent” rating
This rating indicates that a new-build scheme 
has incorporated innovative strategies and 
techniques to reduce its environmental impact 
and is committed to long-term sustainability. 
Achieving an Excellent rating places the 
project in the top 10% of new  
non-domestic buildings.
The new-build development presented 
an opportunity to showcase enhanced 
new building design, ensuring the Group’s 
operations remain fit for the future. The 2.1 
acre all-electric site supports the Group’s 
commitment to decarbonising its estate and 
includes a modern, energy-efficient design 
that incorporates insulated wall and roof 
panels, a 68,000 kWh solar panel array, 
charging points for electric vehicles, large 
underground attenuation tanks to support 
sustainable urban drainage (“SUDs”) and 
landscaping and tree planting that, together 
with the installation of bat and swift boxes, 
supports biodiversity.
The new, sustainable building allows the branch 
to operate from a larger floorspace and yard 
and continue to provide customers with Travis 
Perkin’s great range of products and services.
Scan this QR code to 
see inside our new 
Swindon site.
What’s next
Take stock of the Group’s estate and assets, 
considering the availability of current and emerging 
low-carbon technologies, to inform the continued 
development of the Group’s Fleet and Estate 
decarbonisation roadmaps for the years ahead.

36
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Doing the Right Thing
People
Protecting against modern slavery and complying with all relevant laws.
Why it is important
Maintaining the Group’s Code of Conduct and legal compliance framework 
helps to ensure stakeholders can rely on the Group to continue to do the right 
thing and protects the Group from fines and business interruption. Whether 
managing key compliance topics such as anti-bribery and corruption, anti-
money laundering, data protection or anti-competition, or reducing the Group’s 
risks relating to modern slavery or human rights infringement, the Group 
underpins its work on the strategic sustainability focus areas with a responsible 
approach to business.
Progress in 2024 – modern slavery
Construction remains one of the industries most exposed to modern slavery and 
the Group works to ensure the fair treatment of all workers in its own businesses 
and supply chains.
The key objective for 2024 was to further develop in-person ID checks, currently 
conducted on higher-risk labour agency workers, to include other third parties 
working at the Group’s sites, based on risk. Following review of labour agency 
use, the Group undertook work to identify opportunities to improve its modern 
slavery controls.
Progress in 2024 – legal compliance
There was further development of the “Doing the Right Thing” and “Toolstation 
Together” internal webpages to enhance access to legal compliance policies 
and accompanying guidance. A risk-based approach was adopted to support 
the advanced understanding of certain audiences in key compliance areas of 
competition law and anti-bribery and corruption through the recompletion of 
advanced legal compliance modules. The foundational compliance modules 
listed below were completed in 2024 to improve understanding on key legal 
topics.
•	 Code of Conduct and whistleblowing line
•	 Anti-bribery and corruption
•	 Anti-money laundering
•	 Competition law
•	 Corporate criminal offences
•	 Market abuse and insider trading
•	 Sales of restricted products
We continue to be immensely proud 
of our apprentices and 2024 has 
been another great year with our 
achievement rates improving by nearly 
10%. In my role I am lucky enough to 
meet hundreds of colleagues who have 
gained a formal qualification alongside 
performing a busy job and their stories 
of perseverance and listening to them 
talk about the skills they have gained 
and their career progression is inspiring.
It is clear though that still more needs 
to be done if we are to address the 
skills crisis across construction and 
give colleagues the skills they need 
to operate in a fast-evolving industry. 
We are therefore looking forward to 
maximising the opportunities that 
will come from the government’s 
overhaul of the apprentice system and 
the introduction of the new Skills and 
Growth levy.
Andy Rayner
Director of Learning and Development
What’s next – modern slavery
Development and delivery of additional controls 
for labour agency workers employed at our 
Group’s sites including controls to address the risk 
of modern slavery.
The current economic climate increases the risk of 
forced labour, especially in our supply chain. We are 
committed to robust due diligence and ethical sourcing 
to combat this.
John Bullivant
Group Head of Responsible Sourcing
What’s next – legal compliance
Development and delivery of further bespoke 
training to cover a number of key compliance 
areas, to complement existing training modules.

37
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Developing the next generation
Upskilling colleagues and the wider industry in green and future skills to help facilitate sector improvements.
Why it is important
The sector is changing with new products and 
construction methods, increased digitalisation 
and new sustainability requirements. It needs to 
attract more people to be successful. The Group 
is committed to the development and deployment 
of talent and the next generation workforce. 
Development and apprenticeship programmes 
upskill colleagues in their current roles and introduce 
new colleagues to the business and the wider 
construction sector.
Progress in 2024
The Group’s focus has remained on the 
development of the next generation workforce, 
driving apprenticeships to attract new and diverse 
talent and upskilling existing colleagues.
Over 2,000 apprentices have graduated through 
training programmes run by Group, marking a 
significant milestone on the journey towards the 
Group’s target of 10,000 development graduates 
by 2030.
The key objective for 2024 was to introduce a 
“flexi-job” apprenticeship which includes placements 
with other businesses in the sector and also to 
launch a suite of micro qualifications – short, 
focused learning programmes that provide specific, 
job-related skills and knowledge. Development 
programmes launched during the year are as 
follows:
•	 Customer Sales Excellence: Upskilling customer-
facing colleagues and equipping them with better 
sales and service skills.
•	 Multi-Skilled Merchanting: Training colleagues to 
excel in all areas of a Travis Perkins branch 
including the branch counter, yard, Hire, Managed 
Services and Benchmarx.
•	 Fast Track Hire Management: Equipping colleagues 
with the skills and knowledge to manage a Hire 
business.
External recognition
The Group was ranked 38th in the Apprenticeships 
Top 100 Employers 2024 and 48th in the Rate My 
Apprenticeships Best 100 Employers in 2024.
Attracting new talent into the sector
The Group and its apprenticeship division, LEAP, 
worked closely with the Builders Merchants 
Federation (BMF) in 2024 alongside a wide number 
of industry peers to create the Building Materials 
Careers Campaign, “Materially Different”. The 
campaign showcases the breadth of opportunities in 
the sector, enabling new entrants to find employers, 
job and apprenticeship opportunities.
What’s next
Develop the Group’s Learning and 
Development offering in-line with the 
new Government’s “Growth and Skills” 
levy to support a range of training and 
development programmes that extend 
beyond traditional apprenticeships.
100% of the Group’s apprentices rated 
their experience as “excellent” for 
learning new skills or developing 
existing skills.
RateMyApprenticeship Data, 2024.

38
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Diversity, equity and inclusion
Creating an environment where everyone can be themselves.
Why it is important
With a changing industry and a fight for talent, focus 
on Diversity, Equity and Inclusion (“DE&I”) helps 
create diverse teams where everyone has the skills, 
confidence and ambition to be their best and which 
have the diversity of thought needed for the Group and 
the industry to innovate and change.
Progress in 2024
The key objective was to improve the Group’s 
engagement survey score for the statement “I feel 
a sense of belonging at this company” to above the 
provider’s global average. The score was negatively 
impacted in 2024 by tough trading conditions and 
difficult decisions made by the Group. Further attention 
will be given to this during 2025.
New Inclusive Leadership programme
The Group continued to build the skills, knowledge and 
behaviours of its leaders, helping them to create the 
conditions for a diverse and inclusive workplace.
The Group worked in partnership with Green Park, a 
pioneer in building diverse senior leadership teams 
and more equitable workplace cultures, to develop its 
Inclusive Leadership programme, which was delivered 
in 2024 to more than 80 leaders.
Diversity statistics
Gender diversity 2024 – by role type
Female
%
Male
%
Total
Director
2
25%
6
75%
8
Senior Manager
62
26%
176
74%
238
Colleague
4,254
25%
12,964
75%
17,218
Total
4,318
25%
13,146
75%
17,464
Gender diversity 2024 – by business segment
Female
%
Male
%
Total
Group and shared service
476
50%
475
50%
951
Toolstation
2,254
35%
4,180
65%
6,434
Merchanting
1,588
16%
8,491
84%
10,079
Total
4,318
25%
13,146
75%
17,464
Actively supporting the Construction Industry Coalition (“CIC”)
The Group is strategic partner to the CIC and in 2024 has shared information on initiatives taken 
to drive improved DE&I. Angela Rushforth, Managing Director of Toolstation and Chair of the CIC, 
spoke at the Coalition in Conversation conference in October 2024, setting out the objective of 
the coalition: “There are good people in the industry but there are so many more good people the 
industry could have. We want to be game changers and build a truly inclusive industry.”
What’s next 
The Group is targeting an engagement 
survey score for the statement  
“I feel a sense of belonging at this 
company” in excess of the provider’s 
global average in 2025.
For further diversity statistics please see page 186 ESG/SASB table at the back of the report.

39
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Hannah Stronach
Branch Operations Manager
From Branch Apprentice to Operations Manager
Hannah Stronach started her career at Travis Perkins Elgin three years 
ago, joining the business as a Branch Apprentice studying Level 2 Trade 
Supplier. Nearing the end of the programme, Hannah was promoted 
to Branch Operations Manager thanks to her skills and newly acquired 
expertise. After completing the programme, Hannah went straight on 
to the Level 3 Team Leader Apprenticeship where she says “Part of my 
new role in the branch was to make changes to the way the transport 
department was running and organised. Learning new management, 
organisation, and communication skills helped me massively to 
complete these changes and have the confidence to communicate  
the changes to the team.”
When asked about her favourite thing about being on an apprenticeship, 
Hannah explained that it is “being pushed out of my comfort zone 
to learn new things and having difficult conversations with staff and 
customers if needed. It pushes you to not just do your 9-5 job but to 
take the leap and find out about what is available to you and how you 
could progress through the business if you are interested.”
Hannah is among numerous colleagues benefiting from the Group’s 
award-winning apprenticeship programme, an important focus as the 
Group develops the next generation of talent.

40
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Safety and wellbeing
Getting everyone home safe and well, every single day.
Why it is important
Keeping people safe and well is the Group’s 
top priority.
Progress in 2024
The Group’s key objective for 2024 was to continue to 
create a culture of Calling it Out, taking time to Stop, 
Step Back, Think. Then Act by ensuring daily team 
briefings take place at all locations.
The Group’s top leaders visited branches more often, 
checking in with branch teams to better understand 
safety performance and trigger additional support 
where needed.
Supporting the business to operate safely 
through business change
The Group’s organisational structure changed in 
a number of ways during the year which required 
sharpened focus, new ways of working and increased 
communication and activity to keep up safety 
standards. The Group’s Lost Time Incident (“LTI”) 
Frequency Rate improved slightly, while the Severity 
Rate remained flat compared to the prior year.
Enhanced site reviews to drive safety 
culture change
The site review programme has been overhauled 
to better articulate the Group’s safety expectations, 
implement key safety culture change programmes 
and identify best practice and will make it easier for 
teams to see where improvement opportunities lie 
and provide more robust assurance. The updated 
programme will take effect from January 2025.
Senior leaders engaging 
more on safety
Senior leadership engagement is critical in 
driving a positive safety culture, so in 2024 
the Group’s top 100 leaders spent more  
time visiting branches and holding safety 
conversations, helping to demonstrate where 
safety sits on the Group’s priority list.
Lost time incident frequency rate
Severity rate
2024
3.6
2024
0.05
2023
3.9
2023
0.05
2022
4.7
2022
0.07
0.0
1.0
2.0
3.0
4.0
5.0
0.00
0.02
0.04
0.06
0.08
Lost workdays per thousand hours worked
LTIs per million hours worked
The figures reported do not include Toolstation Europe and agency colleagues
When I visit stores I get the team to 
educate me about the safety challenges 
they experience. I find it interesting to see 
first-hand how some of the decisions my 
commercial team make can impact 
stores, as well as how we can help them. 
The insight enables me to feed into the 
Senior Leadership Team’s strategic 
discussions in a different way. In fact,  
I’ve been so inspired that I’ve asked all  
of my direct reports to spend a day a 
month in Stores doing likewise.
Rupert Nichols
Customer, Commercial and Supply Chain Director
New charity partner to support wellbeing
Travis Perkins plc has partnered with The 
Lighthouse Charity to help its 17,000 colleagues 
better look after their own mental health and to help 
them signpost support for customers and others 
who work in the construction industry.
Lighthouse is dedicated to supporting construction 
workers and their families through tough times such as 
illness, injury, financial hardship, providing emotional 
support, financial aid, and even retraining programmes 
to help people get back on their feet. Colleagues tell 
us that it is important to them that charity partnerships 
benefit those who work within the Group and help 
strengthen relationships with customers and suppliers.
What’s next
•	 Introduce a new second line 
of defence safety assurance 
programme that assesses 
both achievement of 
minimum standards, cultural 
position and best practice.
•	 Continued focus on out-of-
branch safety including safe 
deliveries.

41
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Reward
Colleague voice
Listening to colleagues to improve engagement.
Improving the financial health of colleagues.
Why it is important
Listening to colleagues can improve engagement 
and create a more positive and productive work 
environment.
Progress in 2024 
Key actions undertaken during the year are detailed 
below: 
Three senior leader events were held in 2024 to 
enable discussion on business and functional plans 
and their alignment to the Group’s strategy and to 
help the businesses and functions to better support 
each other.
•	 Colleague engagement and development 
continued through At My Best conversations, to 
align colleague objectives to the Group’s priorities.
•	 Improved accountability and ownership through 
local line manager action plans.
•	 Continued embedding of the Group’s values.
•	 Business-level colleague forums and 
listening groups.
Engagement survey
•	 The Group’s annual engagement survey was 
carried out in Q4 2024 with participation of 80%.
•	 The engagement score fell from 73% to 69% due 
to poorly implemented restructuring and the 
uncertainty created by leadership change. 
•	 The successes identified in the survey were local 
line manager feedback, the safety culture and the 
ability for colleagues to be themselves. 
•	 The survey identified the need to give colleagues 
more clarity following significant change. 
Why it is important
Improving the financial, physical and emotional 
health and wellbeing of colleagues contributes 
towards stable communities and enriches the lives 
of colleagues and those around them.
Progress in 2024
The objective for 2024 was to continue to help 
colleagues build their financial resilience.
Building better financial resilience 
We offer fair pay and a comprehensive package of 
benefits and pensions. Depending on performance, 
there is also the opportunity for colleagues to earn a 
bonus and share in the Company’s success through 
share plans and savings programmes.
The Group’s colleagues have continued to use 
Wagestream, a financial management and wellbeing 
app that allows them to access a portion of earned 
salary each month before pay day and allows them 
to set up a savings fund directly from their pay. 
Colleagues have built short-term savings of almost 
£2.2m since the benefit was launched in 2022.
The Group launched a new benefit to encourage 
colleagues to save regularly, partnering with 
Commsave, one of the largest credit unions in the 
UK. Commsave is a not-for-profit financial co-
operative which provides easy access to savings  
and loans direct from pay.
There are now 2,700 colleagues across Wagestream 
and Commsave who are saving regularly via payroll 
each month. As well as providing a critical financial 
safety net in times of need, a savings habit builds 
financial resilience, reduces financial stress and 
contributes positively to overall wellbeing.
What’s next
We will be focusing on incentive structures to drive 
engagement and performance. Further support will 
also be provided to those approaching retirement 
to reflect the challenges of an ageing population.
What’s next
Conduct further analysis of the engagement 
survey, ensuring clear actions are taken.

42
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Charity and community
Taking pride in helping others and making positive changes happen.
Why it is important
Travis Perkins plc is at the heart of its communities. 
As a local employer that supports building projects 
across the UK, the Group contributes to local and 
national economies. Colleagues take great pride in 
being part of a business that supports its customers 
and where they can deliver a wide range of 
community projects that create positive change.
Progress in 2024
The focus in 2024 was to grow volunteering efforts 
and to continue to build charity and community 
partnerships that help to deliver on the Group’s 
strategy and provide social value for the Group’s 
customers and communities.
Volunteering
The Group continued its partnership with Volunteer 
it Yourself (“VIY”); a social enterprise that provides 
young people with trade skills whilst renovating 
community spaces. In addition to part-funding 
projects that included the renovation of a Scout 
hut and a boxing club for people with special 
educational needs and disabilities, colleagues 
supported projects with volunteering, providing skills 
workshops, mentoring and general support with 
gardening, decorating and other renovations works.
Charity partnerships
In 2024 the Travis Perkins business announced a 
new charity partnership with Alzheimer’s Society 
and Alzheimer Scotland. Over a three-year period, 
the business has committed to raising funds, 
awareness and understanding to support those 
living with Alzheimers.
The Group introduced its first Group-wide charity 
partner, The Lighthouse Charity, to support mental 
health for colleagues and the wider industry (for 
more information see page 40).
Colleagues across the Group also continued to 
drive meaningful change by supporting many other 
charities and community causes in creative ways.
Fundraising in 2024
What’s next
Continue to use charity and 
community partnership and 
activity as a way to create 
meaningful social change both 
nationally and locally, working 
with established and new 
partners and with a particular 
focus on improving wellbeing 
for colleagues and customers.
Charity and Social Enterprise partners
2024 contributions
Alzheimer's Society
£183k
Centrepoint
£11k
Construction Youth Trust
£10k
Cynthia Spencer
£9k
The Lighthouse Charity
£17k
Macmillan Cancer Support
£633k
Mind
£35k
Prostate Cancer UK
£24k
Scottish Action for Mental Health
£2k
Variety
£26k
Volunteer It Yourself
£60k
The Travis Perkins plc property team has 
been a supporter of children’s charity Variety 
since 2018 and in 2024 the team donated 
a Variety “Sunshine Coach” to Northgate 
School and Arts College in Northampton.
This school caters for students with special 
educational needs and is particularly 
focused on preparation for adulthood. 
The new Sunshine Coach will be used to 
regularly take pupils to and from their work 
experience and on educational trips.
Without the support of companies like Travis Perkins, working with Variety, 
the children’s charity, our young people would miss out on so much “out-
of-the-classroom” learning. A Sunshine Coach enables us to plan for a 
more hands-on, practical curriculum to improve learning opportunities.
Sheralee Webb, Executive Head Teacher, Northgate School Academy Trust

43
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
TCFD disclosure requirement
Location in Annual Report
Page(s)
Governance
Disclose the organisation’s 
governance around climate risks 
and opportunities
Describe the Board’s oversight of  
climate-related risks and opportunities
TCFD report – Board oversight and engagement
45
Principal risks report – Climate  
change and carbon reduction
65
Describe management’s role in assessing and managing 
climate-related risks and opportunities
TCFD report – Board oversight  
and engagement
45
Strategy
Disclose the actual and potential 
impacts of climate-related 
risks and opportunities on 
the organisation’s businesses, 
strategy, and financial planning 
where such information 
is material
Describe the climate-related risks and opportunities the 
organisation has identified over the short, medium and long 
term
TCFD report – Principal risks and opportunities
46
Principal risks report – Climate change and carbon 
reduction
65
Describe the impact of climate-related risks and opportunities 
on the organisations businesses, strategy and financial planning
TCFD report – Principal risks and opportunities
46
Describe the resilience of the organisation’s strategy, taking 
into consideration different climate-related scenarios 
including a 2°C or lower scenario
TCFD report – Scenario results
50
Risk management
Disclose how the organisation 
identifies, assesses and 
manages climate-related risks
Describe the organisation’s processes for identifying and 
assessing climate-related risks
TCFD report – Risk and opportunity management
48-56
Describe the organisation’s processes for managing climate-
related risks
TCFD report – Risk and opportunity management
48-56
Describe how processes for identifying, assessing and 
managing climate-related risks are integrated into the 
organisation’s overall risk management
TCFD report – Risk and opportunity management
48-56
Principal Risks report – Climate change  
and carbon reduction
65
Metrics and targets
Disclose the metrics and targets 
used to assess and manage 
relevant climate-related risks 
and opportunities where such 
information is material
Disclose the metrics used by the organisation to assess 
climate-related risks and opportunities in line with its 
strategy and risk management process
TCFD report – Metrics and targets
57-58
Sustainability report – Operating sustainably
34-35
Sustainability report – Modernising construction
30-31
Remuneration report
90-117
Disclose Scope 1, Scope 2 and, if appropriate, Scope 3 
greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions, and the related risks
TCFD report – Metrics and targets
57-58
Sustainability report – Operating sustainably
34-35
Sustainability report – Modernising construction
30-31
Describe the targets used by the organisation to manage 
climate-related risks and opportunities and performance 
against targets
TCFD report – Metrics and targets
57-58
Sustainability report – Operating sustainably
34-35
Sustainability report - Modernising construction
30-31
TCFD 
disclosure
Compliance statement
The following disclosure is consistent with the 
recommendations and recommended disclosures 
of the Taskforce for Climate-related Financial 
Disclosures (“TCFD”) as stated in the listing rule LR 
9.8.6(8)R. Similar content can be found in the Travis 
Perkins Group Carbon Disclosure Project (“CDP”) 
Climate disclosure which is available for public 
review. The disclosure covers the whole business 
and its supply chain and all climate-related risk and 
opportunity types, over three time periods, all of 
which is detailed in the pages that follow. This is the 
fourth year of disclosure under TCFD for the Group. 
Further improvements have been made and more 
are planned to enhance the disclosure, including 
more in-depth analysis by material type to have 
greater insight to physical climate risks and 
opportunities in the supply chain and to further 
assess transitional risks and opportunities. This 
will be shared in the 2025 Annual Report and 
TCFD Report. During 2024 a desktop review of 
material risks and opportunities for three more 
material types and also for two customer types was 
completed to enhance the Group’s understanding of 
supply chain risk.

44
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Governance
Scope and sphere of influence. 
The Group’s addressable market for construction 
materials is £65bn. The Group has a 7% share of 
this addressable market, serving generalist and 
specialist customers that range from the smallest 
jobbing builder to the largest national contractor 
or housebuilder. The Group operates over 1,400 
distribution sites and has a turnover of £4.6bn and a 
fleet of over 2,500 heavy and light goods vehicles. 
Committed to decarbonisation 
Decarbonisation of the Group’s businesses and 
supply chain remains the Group’s sustainability 
priority. For further information see page 26. The 
Group has commitments to reduce carbon in line 
with a 1.5°C pathway across the value chain. To 
monitor delivery of this commitment, the Group has 
two key long-term targets which have been verified 
by the Science-Based Target initiative (“SBTi”). For 
more information on the Group’s carbon agenda see 
pages 30 and 34. Pages 57-58 provide details of the 
metrics and measures used by the Group to assess 
progress.
The Group’s targets are SBTi approved as being 
in line with a 1.5°C pathway. By 2035 the Group 
targets reduction of Scope 1 and 2 greenhouse gas 
emissions (“GHG”) by 80% and Scope 3 emissions 
by 63% from a 2020 baseline.
BUILDING FOR BETTER
SUSTAINABILITY PRIORITY
Decarbonising the industry
Modernising 
construction
Sourcing 
responsibly
Operating 
sustainably
Developing the 
next generation
DOING THE RIGHT THING
Safety & Wellbeing | Diversity, Equity & Inclusion | Colleague Voice | Reward 
Charity & Community | Modern Slavery & Human Rights | Legal Compliance

45
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance continued
Collaborating to support change 
The Group is engaging with the sector to support the 
decarbonisation agenda. Sitting in the middle of the 
supply chain, the Group recognises the importance 
of collaboration, joining together with the industry 
to share best practices, collaborate and co-create 
solutions. 
During 2024 the Group continued its partnership 
with the National Retrofit Hub (“NRH”) and the 
Group Sustainability Director is co-Chair of NRH 
Working Group 2: Supply Chain, Products and 
Solutions, to help in showcasing solutions and 
encourage retrofit activity and the uptake of more 
sustainable and innovative products. The Group also 
has representation on sustainability working groups 
at the Builders Merchant Federation and the Supply 
Chain Sustainability School, to ensure that the voice 
of the merchant is well represented and solutions 
are created together. As 80% of the properties that 
will exist in 2050 exist today, action is needed to 
address the current housing and commercial stock 
and reduce in-use carbon, in particular moving 
away from gas boilers. For more information on 
stakeholder engagement see pages 78-80. 
The scenario analysis conducted by the Group in 
the previous three years has identified that an early 
adoption pathway carries the lowest risk for the 
Group. Consequently the Group will continue to 
advocate for progressive action on climate change in 
line with these scenarios, but recognises that a slow 
pace of change to government policy and funding 
and other constraints in the macro environment 
pose a risk to the UK remaining on an early-action 
pathway. 
Accountabilities 
Climate change is a boardroom topic with the CEO 
setting the agenda. Carbon strategy is directed 
by the CFO with delivery steered by the Group’s 
Sustainability Director, Head of Environment and the 
Fleet, Property and Commercial teams along with 
nominated leads in each of the Group’s businesses. 
The Managing Director for CCF Ltd is the Group 
Leadership Team sponsor for Modernising 
Construction, including Scope 3 carbon reduction. 
Board oversight and engagement 
The management reporting cycle on the Group’s 
climate goals and targets is at least quarterly, with 
five sessions with the Group Leadership Team or 
plc Board during 2024. The Group has developed 
carbon roadmaps (Scope 1 and 2: Buildings and 
Fleet, and Scope 3: Product Decarbonisation) 
against which progress is monitored by the Group 
Leadership Team (GLT) and the Board. Moreover, 
the GLT and Board consider the principal climate 
risks and opportunities identified via the Company’s 
risk identification activities. The Company’s risk 
identification activities consider risks emerging from 
three future scenarios and over the short, medium 
and long term. The Board has recognised the 
strategic importance of managing climate-related 
risks and opportunities due to the Group’s ongoing 
materiality analysis. 
For more information on how the Board is apprised 
of climate-related risks and opportunities, see the 
climate change principal risk on page 65. 
The GLT and Board consider climate-related 
issues when reviewing and guiding strategy, major 
plans of action, risk management policies, annual 
budgets, and business plans as well as setting the 
organisation’s performance objectives, monitoring 
implementation and performance, and overseeing 
major capital expenditures, acquisitions and 
divestitures. 
For example in 2024 the GLT and Board approved 
the costs to renew the Group’s renewable electricity 
tariff and install further LEDs by the end of 2025 
and continued investment in HVO for over 200 
heavy goods vehicles (“HGVs”). 
Alignment of incentives to carbon 
commitments 
The 2024 bonus targets for the GLT included 
deliverables in line with the Group’s sustainability 
ambitions such as further carbon reductions and the 
development of more detailed carbon roadmaps. 
(see page 105). 
In addition, the restricted stock scheme included an 
ESG-related performance underpin (see page 95).

46
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
L
P
M
R
H
I
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Sustainability strategy
Principal risks and opportunities 
Risks and opportunities are identified via an assessment 
approach which aligns not only with the Group 
principal risk process and rating tables but also uses 
the risk drivers and types published by CDP. Internal 
stakeholders are invited to advise on the relevant risk 
and opportunity types, level of impact and speed of risk 
materialisation. External stakeholders have shared their 
insights on what is material to them through the Group’s 
materiality assessment (last completed in 2022) 
and ongoing stakeholder engagement. The impacts 
from risks and opportunities have been considered in 
relation to products and services, supply chain and/or 
value chain, investment in research and development, 
operations (including type of operations and location 
of facilities), acquisitions or divestments and access to 
capital. The risk and opportunity identification process 
is iterative and informed by scenario analysis which the 
Group is developing but recognises is not yet complete. 
For more details on the principal risk process see pages 
59-61. 
Across all three assessed time periods, geographies, 
scenarios and risk types the Group does not consider 
its direct operations to be very highly exposed to 
physical impacts from climate change. The Group is 
predominantly a UK-based distributor of products, 
with limited non-UK activity and limited manufacturing 
activity. Accordingly, the majority of the climate-
related financial risks and opportunities relate to 
what is purchased and sold, rather than how it moves 
through the Group’s businesses. The table to the 
right summarises the Group’s principal risks and 
opportunities.
Top climate-related financial impacts
RISK – TECHNOLOGY: TRANSITIONING TO LOWER EMISSIONS TECHNOLOGY
Description:
Risk for the 
Group*
Scenario in which 
this impacts:
Time period in which 
this impacts
Parts of the value chain most impacted:
Decarbonisation of the HGV fleet (c.1600 HGVs to transition away from diesel)
H
P  R
In-house: Travis Perkins Group
RISK – PHYSICAL: RISING SEA LEVELS AND EXTREME WEATHER EVENTS
Description:
Risk for the 
Group*
Scenario in which 
this impacts:
Time period in which 
this impacts
Parts of the value chain most impacted:
Decreased asset values (assumes some branches affected)
L  M
P  R  I
In-house: Travis Perkins Group
RISK – REGULATION: MANDATES ON AND REGULATION OF EXISTING PRODUCTS AND SERVICES
Description:
Risk for the 
Group*
Scenario in which 
this impacts:
Time period in which 
this impacts
Parts of the value chain most impacted:
Product carbon pricing (assumes a small portion of carbon-related cost price 
increases are not passed through)
L
P  R
Downstream and Upstream: Customers and 
Manufacturers
RISK – MARKET: CHANGING CUSTOMER BEHAVIOUR
Description:
Risk for the 
Group*
Scenario in which 
this impacts:
Time period in which 
this impacts
Parts of the value chain most impacted:
Obsolescence of product (assumes some product lines are no longer of interest 
to customers aligning with net zero)
L
P  R
Upstream: Manufacturers (particularly manufacturers 
of gas boilers or high-carbon building fabric materials)
OPPORTUNITY – PRODUCTS AND SERVICES: DEVELOPMENT AND/OR EXPANSION OF LOW EMISSION GOODS AND SERVICES
Description:
Risk for the 
Group*
Scenario in which 
this impacts:
Time period in which 
this impacts
Parts of the value chain most impacted:
Rising demand for new product mix and new technologies (to meet changing 
building regulations and low-emission targets)
H
P  R
In-house: Travis Perkins Group
Upstream: Manufacturers
OPPORTUNITY – RESOURCE EFFICIENCY: USE OF MORE EFFICIENT MODES OF TRANSPORT
Description:
Risk for the 
Group*
Scenario in which 
this impacts:
Time period in which 
this impacts
Parts of the value chain most impacted:
Increased revenue opportunity (assumes large customers move business 
towards merchants with decarbonised transport options)
L
P  R
In-house: Travis Perkins Group
OPPORTUNITY – PRODUCTS AND SERVICES: DEVELOPMENT AND/OR EXPANSION OF LOW EMISSION GOODS AND SERVICES
Description:
Risk for the 
Group*
Scenario in which 
this impacts:
Time period in which 
this impacts
Parts of the value chain most impacted:
Rising demand for new product mix and new technologies (to adapt to climate change 
(i.e. strengthening flood resilience), and to react to climate events (i.e. extreme weather)
L
P  R
In-house: Travis Perkins Group
*	
Risk ratings are in line with those in the Principal Risks Section on pages 59-69.
Low
Proactive
Medium
Reactive
High
Inactive

47
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Timelines
The timelines considered and why they were selected is detailed in the table below.
Time Horizon
Description
Why chosen
  Short
1-5 Years (2022-2027) 
This time horizon was chosen to ensure impacts being felt now 
and their potential escalation are understood
  Medium
5-15 Years (2028-2037)
This time horizon was chosen to reflect that scenarios show 
limited divergence prior to this point
  Long
15-30 Years (2038-2052)
The physical impacts from climate change will magnify over a 
longer time period than usual business planning 
Strategic response to risks and opportunities
The material considerations in achieving the Group’s 
strategic commitment to the transition to a low-
carbon economy include: 
•	 Accelerated trends in product replacement and the 
associated changes to the Group’s business model, 
including the move away from fossil-fuel boilers. 
•	 The need to adapt the Group’s branches and fleet 
to be low carbon or no carbon. 
•	 Changes to customer projects and locations that 
may impact the Group’s estate. 
•	 Strong customer and supplier partnerships remain 
key in achieving a successful transition. 
Carbon transition plan
The Group has shared the roadmaps to 2035 for Scopes 1, 2 and 3 on its corporate website and these now all include interim targets. Key activities include: 
Despite tough economic conditions, we’re making progress in 
reducing product carbon by engaging with industry partners, 
fostering innovation, and driving sustainable practices.
Heinrich Richter
Head of Commercial - Sustainable Products and Services
(1)  Reducing the embodied and in-use carbon of 
products sold 
(Scope 3 represents 99% of the Group’s footprint 
with Category 1 (Purchased Goods and Services) 
and Category 11 (Use of Sold Products e.g. gas 
boilers) representing 87% of this). 
•	 Working with the whole value chain to phase out 
the majority of fossil-fuel boilers from sales by 
2035. This primarily relates to commercial gas 
boilers sold by the BSS business. 
•	 Reducing the embodied carbon in the goods the 
Group sells. This will be achieved through 
influencing supplier action and supporting their 
uptake of new technologies such as carbon capture 
and storage and introducing alternative materials 
or products where carbon reduction is not viable. 
(2)  Decarbonisation of the Fleet and Estate 
(Scopes 1 and 2 represent 1% of the Group’s footprint) 
•	 Phasing in the use of HVO fuel for diesel engines 
as a transition fuel. Over 200 HGVs used HVO 
instead of diesel in 2024. 
•	 Introducing electric or alternate technology HGVs 
from around 2027. The first electric HGV was 
deployed in 2021 as a pilot to inform the Group’s 
roadmap and the Travis Perkins Managed Services 
fleet now has seven electric vans. 
•	 Taking action to improve the energy efficiency of 
both freehold and leasehold buildings. 
•	 100% renewable energy tariff for all UK sites. This 
tariff was introduced in October 2021. 
•	 Continuing to move from gas boilers to air-source 
heat pumps and other low-carbon technologies to 
heat the Group’s branches and offices. 
(3)  Climate adaptation plan 
The Group has reviewed the physical impact risk 
across different warming scenarios for both its own 
estate, UK infrastructure and its supply chains. This 
information is used to inform: 
•	 Commercial strategy for the medium to long term to 
ensure both continuity of supply and a just transition. 
•	 Group property decisions and planning for new site 
locations and existing site adaptation. 
•	 Group insurance planning to best manage future 
risks and business continuity. Physical climate risk 
impacts are rated as low to medium. Early 
conversations are underway on this and plans will 
evolve more in the coming year.
•	 Climate risk is now also influencing sales 
opportunities for the Group with opportunities to 
supply the climate adaptation products needed by 
customers. 

48
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Risk and opportunity 
management
As climate governance is integrated into business 
decision-making, principal risks and uncertainties 
are recorded and reported with other business risks 
and uncertainties on page 65. The identification of 
risks and opportunities around climate change uses 
the same complementary likelihood and impact 
criteria as other Group risks and the assessment 
covers direct and indirect physical and transitional 
impacts. In addition, risks and opportunities over the 
Group’s three chosen scenarios (Proactive, Reactive 
and Inactive), as well as over three timelines (five 
years, 15 years and 30 years) are taken into account 
by referencing the results of the scenario analysis. 
A detailed risk assessment process is conducted 
annually to identify any emerging risks and ensure 
the assessment of impact from all risks and the 
selection of management approach is appropriate. 
A risk report is presented to and discussed annually 
with the GLT and Board. The Group’s principal 
risk list, which includes climate change risk, is also 
reviewed by the Board and the Group’s financial 
auditors. Details of the most material climate risks 
and opportunities have been published annually for 
the last 15 years in the CDP climate disclosure. 
The uncertainties around impacts are considered via 
scenario analysis which is detailed on the next page. 
Sizing and scaling of risks and opportunities is 
performed in conjunction with internal and external 
stakeholders and uses the outputs from the Group’s 
scenario analyses, materiality assessments and the 
professional judgement of the internal sustainability 
team together with external advisers. Decisions to 
mitigate, transfer, accept, or control the risks are 
made by the risk owners (nominated GLT members) 
with confidence to make decisions provided by a 
clear carbon strategy, target and roadmaps. 
In 2024 the Group followed up the scenario analysis 
undertaken in the previous three years with a 
desktop review of material risks and opportunities 
published by a sample of large materials suppliers 
and customer types. All other results published in 
this disclosure are from the 2023 scenario analysis.

49
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Scenarios and modelling process† 
The scenarios modelled outline possible physical and transitional impacts to 2050 and beyond. The transitional scenarios used are from the Network for Greening the Financial System (“NGFS”) and are the same 
scenarios used by the Bank of England in its Climate Biennial Exploratory Scenario publication which explores the financial risks from climate change. The Group selected the scenarios below to illustrate the best and 
worst outcomes and the sensitivities involved when identifying future impacts from changes to the climate and society’s response to that change. Note that no additional scenario analysis was conducted in 2024. The 
results were instead enhanced through a desktop review of risks and opportunities identified by selected supply chain partners.
Proactive
Reactive
Inactive
Early action
Late action
No additional action
Transitional
Action taken early and effectively. Global net zero CO2 emissions 
are achieved by 2050. Transition risks are low.
Action is delayed until 2031 and is more sudden and disorderly. 
Higher transition risk and short-term macroeconomic disruption.
No further action is taken on climate change and even current 
obligations are not met. Hence GHG emissions grow unchecked. 
Transition risks are low.
<2 degrees mean global warming
Between 2-3 degrees mean global warming
>3 degrees mean global warming
Physical
Using RCP 2.6. 
Using RCP 4.5.
Using RCP 8.5.
Global CO2 emissions peak by 2020 and decline to around zero by 
2080. Concentrations in the atmosphere peak at around 440 ppm 
in mid-century and then start slowly declining.
Emissions peak around mid century at around 50% higher than 
2000 levels and then decline rapidly over 30 years and then 
stabilise at half of 2000 levels. CO2 concentration continues on 
trend to about 520 ppm in 2070 and continues to increase but 
more slowly.
Concentrations of CO2 in the atmosphere accelerate and reach 
950 ppm by 2100 and continue increasing for another 100 years.
Scenario 
assumptions 
which apply to  
all three 
scenarios
•	 The retention of current market share in all categories where the Group is active
•	 The use of a blended construction and manufacturing GVA to project revenue. This assumes the sector moves from unsustainable manufacturing processes to new, as yet unknown, processes and materials
•	 A 0.5m rise in sea levels is effectively mitigated by sea defence adaptations
•	 Cost price inflation caused by supply chain mitigation of physical and transitional risks can be substantially passed on to customers
•	 The 166 UK sites, in 166 different towns and cities, assessed for physical climate risk are representative of the Group’s UK sites and infrastructure and inferences about the portfolio risk can be made from the sample
•	 The expected number of days of business interruption from physical climate change impact are modelled with the Gumbel distribution to best represent extreme events
Scenario 
assumptions 
which apply  
to specific 
scenarios
•	 Full international implementation of country-level commitments on 
climate change action
•	 Price parity for non-fossil fuel delivery will not be achieved  
before 2040
•	 Current commitments by countries and businesses to GHG 
reductions are not met
†  Climate scenarios make projections on hypothetical futures and as such come with a degree of uncertainty. While some of the information obtained from existing climate models have a high degree of accuracy, there is still a level of uncertainty. As a result, 
scenario analysis should only be used as a guide for climate-related risks and opportunities.

50
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Risk and opportunity management continued
Scenario risk lenses
The climate change impact under each of the three scenarios was 
considered across a number of risks and opportunities for the Group, 
including the following examples.
The transition risk and opportunity assessment considered:
Policy and legal risks
•	 Carbon pricing
•	 Enhanced emissions-reporting obligations
•	 Mandates on and regulation of existing products and services
•	 Exposure to litigation
Market risks
•	 Increased cost of raw materials
•	 Changing customer behaviour
Reputation risks
•	 Stigmatisation of the sector
•	 Shifts in consumer preferences
•	 Increased stakeholder concern or negative stakeholder feedback
Technology
•	 Costs of lower emissions technology
•	 Unsuccessful investment in new technologies
•	 Substitution of existing products and services  
with lower emission options
The physical risk and opportunity assessment considered:
•	 Rising mean temperatures
•	 Changing precipitation patterns
•	 Sea level rise
•	 Extreme weather
•	 Wildfire
This was taken into account for the Group’s UK estate as well as 
UK-wide infrastructure (roads, ports, railways, utility supply, IT 
infrastructure), selected supply chain locations and comprehensive 
timber supply chain locations. Impacts on the UK workforce due to 
physical climate risk were also reviewed.
In future reporting periods the Group will conduct deep dive 
assessments on other material types in its supply chains.
Scenario results 
Resilience over the 3 scenarios
Scenario
Proactive
Reactive
Inactive
FUTURE COSTS 
(resilience)
LOWEST
The proactive scenario aligns with  
the Group’s own SBTi approved targets 
and roadmaps. Transitional costs (fleet 
and estate) have been considered in 
line with this roadmap. Product-related 
carbon costs are assumed to be 
substantially passed through to the 
market. Costs from physical impacts of 
climate change  
are expected to be low to moderate.
HIGHER
The reactive scenario introduces more 
risk as policy around climate change is 
either too late or too weak, exposing the 
Group to higher transitional costs and a 
supply chain with less mandate to 
change. Costs from physical impacts 
remain low to moderate for the UK but 
may be higher in the Group’s supply 
chains.
HIGHEST
The inactive scenario introduces 
reputational risk around target 
achievement as there would be no 
further changes from the government, 
leaving the Group unsupported by 
policy to meet its SBTi targets. The 
Group’s UK infrastructure will be 
impacted by rising sea levels and 
flooding by 2050. There will be supply 
chain disruption.
The Group’s exposure to financial stress from physical climate change or transitional climate change impacts can be successfully mitigated by 
following the adopted strategy and roadmaps outlined in this disclosure. Transitional impacts are expected to be far greater than physical impacts 
and the ability to pivot away from some construction materials and technologies and towards the supply of other materials will be key to the 
future success of the Group.
The proactive scenario delivers a decarbonised business model in the most efficient way with the best financial outcomes. The Group’s SBTi 
approved targets and roadmaps are aligned to this early action pathway. 
Summary of transitional risks
There are two predominant transitional risk implications of climate change for the Group – both of which are rated as high-risk. Firstly, impacts on 
the ongoing relevance of the products and services that the Group sells to the market. Secondly, impacts on the pace and methods of upgrading 
the Group’s own fleet, in line with or ahead of UK policy. 
With regard to products and services, the Group’s businesses will need to evolve their product mix and develop services to meet the product, 
data and service requirements of a low-carbon construction sector. The analysis has identified a risk of product obsolescence, for example gas 
boilers in some markets, and changing customer demand towards materials, products and solutions that reduce lifetime GHG emission levels 
from buildings. The Group measures product sales that contribute to a low-carbon economy and is looking at ways of promoting more sustainable 
construction in the medium and longer term.
Carbon pricing will introduce a cost to embodied emissions and climate experts are calling for carbon pricing across more sectors and on high-
emission materials such as steel, plastic, cement and bricks (see forecast trends on the following page). In 2023, the EU implemented the Carbon 
Border Adjustment Mechanism trial phase, placing a cost on the embedded emissions in certain materials. The UK will likely follow and introduce 
a similar mechanism. Whilst the Group has a policy to pass price increases through to customers, thereby not directly taking on these costs, 
the market will consider alternative materials, and the Group will need to adapt to remain relevant.

51
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Steel price
1,600
£/tonne of Steel
1,400
1,200
1,000
800
600
400
200
0
2020
2025
2030
2035
2040
2045
2050
The price of steel after the introduction of a carbon border 
mechanism across each climate scenario and timeframe.
Proactive
Reactive
Inactive
2050
PVC price
1,400
£/tonne
1,200
1,000
800
600
400
200
0
2020
2025
2030
2035
2040
2045
The price of PVC across each scenario and timeframe.
Proactive
Reactive
Inactive
Cement price
£/Mt
Heat pump installation projections
1.8
Installations (million)
1.6
1.4
1.2
1.0
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
0
2020
2025
2030
2035
2040
2045
2050
Proactive
Reactive
Inactive
Government target
Heat pump installation projections.
Oil price
Pricing for oil under each of the three scenarios.
Proactive
Reactive
Inactive
12.2
£/GJ
11.8
11.6
11.4
11.2
11.0
10.8
10.6
2020
2025
2030
2035
2040
2045
2050
12.0
350
300
250
200
150
100
50
0
2020
2025
2030
2035
2040
2045
2050
Proactive
Reactive
Inactive
The price of cement across each scenario.
In addition to the cost increase of high-embodied 
carbon products, there will also be a move to 
heating technologies with a lower carbon impact 
in-use, such as heat pumps instead of gas boilers. 
The data in these charts were modelled by Inspired 
ESG as part of the Group’s scenario analysis work in 
2023. They were not updated in 2024.

52
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Risk and opportunity management continued
Climate change risks impact all companies in the Group’s value 
chain. By understanding customer and supplier risks we can 
consider how to ready our own business as well as how we can 
support with climate adaptation products and services.”
Megan Adlen
Group Sustainability Director
The Group’s climate change strategy means it 
asks more from its value chain partners in terms 
of compliance and innovation. Over the medium 
term, the Group’s engagement strategy with its 
supply chain will become more targeted on lowering 
lifetime impacts. For example, in promoting 
innovative and sustainable products to customers 
and developing packaging waste solutions. The 
Group has expertise in developing low-carbon 
solutions that other parts of the value chain will 
require and is looking for ways to develop this into 
a service. The Group appointed a new Head of 
Commercial for Sustainable Products and Services 
and Sustainable Product Data Analyst in late 2023 
to accelerate this work.
With regard to the Group’s heavy fleet, the 
investment required to decarbonise the Group’s 
heavy fleet is affordable and is most effectively 
deployed in a phased manner. In the last three 
years, capital spend requirements to deliver 
efficiency programmes have been approved and 
have proven to decrease carbon impacts. In 2024, 
£14.3m was invested in replacement or new delivery 
vehicles and an additional £1m on plant assets 
across the network. £406k was invested into HVO 
fuel purchase, based on average costs compared to 
diesel in 2024. Transport-related carbon reduced by 
11.5% in 2024 as compared to 2023.
As a non capital-intensive business with 99% of 
emissions in the value chain, an internal carbon 
price is not a tool that has been adopted by the 
Group to date. Although this will be considered in 
future years as a tool to support the business case 
for change, particularly in light of the projected costs 
for oil under the three scenarios.
Summary of physical risks
The physical risk from climate change to the Group’s 
estate in the UK and the UK transport, utility and IT 
infrastructure is low to medium as the Group assets 
are large in number and geographically spread 
providing resilience to the physical impact from a 
changing climate.
The physical risk from climate change to the Group’s 
supply chain (causing business interruption) is also 
forecast as low to medium due to the Group’s ability 
to adapt to new supply routes and suppliers and the 
assumption that transactions with customers are not 
lost but delayed.
The physical risk from climate change to the Group’s 
customers (causing delays in developments and 
therefore lost or delayed sales) has been explored 
initially through a desktop review. This will be 
explored further in future reporting years.
A deep-dive on physical risk to the Group’s 
UK estate
The scenario analysis for physical risks 
(temperature, precipitation, fire and extreme 
weather) to the Group’s estate in the UK suggests 
broadly similar impacts (low to moderate) for each 
of the three warming scenarios. The likelihood of 
moderate risks increases in the reactive or inactive 
scenarios over time. The analysis suggests that not 
all regions will be impacted equally by changing 
precipitation, temperatures, wildfire risk or extreme 
weather events. 

53
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Direct flood impacts (damages to the Group’s 
property, stock and machinery) will likely increase 
in the inactive scenario. 45 branches are at direct 
risk from river flooding and 73 branches will be 
exposed to indirect risks of flooding i.e. affected 
transport networks. Annually, Wales, Scotland and the 
Northwest receive the most rainfall.
•	 Heatwaves are predicted to become more likely as 
the UK temperature is predicted to rise between 
0.67°C and 1.45°C by mid-century (from 
a 1980–2010 baseline). Extreme temperatures can 
disrupt transport networks, reduce employee 
productivity, increase the risk of wildfire and 
decrease the efficiency of electrical products. 
Greater London, the South East and South West 
will experience the most significant temperature 
increases under all three scenarios.
•	 A forecast 0.5m rise in sea levels would not impact 
on all of the Group’s coastal sites and shipping 
ports used in the supply chain equally. Sites and 
ports in the east of the UK are forecast to be the 
most vulnerable to sea level rise. Twenty-one 
Group sites could be impacted by 2050 under the 
Inactive scenario.
Proactive
Reactive
Inactive
Timeframe for 
0.5m sea level 
rise to impact
2110 
(86 years)
2080 
(56 years)
2070 
(46 years)
15% of the Group’s current estate was at risk of 
impact from wildfires within 10km of the branch 
between 2018–2022, although none directly 
impacted the estate or operations. The Group will 
keep monitoring wildfires as, whilst less common 
than flooding events, they could have a higher 
impact per event.
Higher increases  
in precipitation
Higher sea level rise 
impacts
Regions likely to experience the highest temperature increases under the three scenarios.
Region
Reference period 
(1980–2011)
Average daily temperature projection by 2052 (°C)
Proactive
Reactive
Inactive
Greater London 
10.77 
11.44 (6%) 
11.76 (9%)
12.22 (13%)
South East 
10.69 
11.36 (6%)
11.68 (9%)
12.14 (14%)
South West 
10.48 
11.15 (6%)
11.47 (9%)
11.93 (14%)
Regions likely to experience the highest precipitation increases under the three different 
scenarios. 
Region 
Reference Period 
(1980-2011) 
Annual Precipitation Projection by 2052 (mm/yr) 
Proactive
Reactive
Inactive
Wales 
1032 
1056 (2%)
1082 (5%)
1066 (3%).
Scotland 
1028 
1029 (0.1%)
1029 (0.1%)
1053 (2%)
North West 
937 
962 (3%)
972 (4%)
970 (4%)
The analysis, completed in 2023, confirms that overall physical risk across the Group’s UK-
based estate increases over time but never gets beyond medium in any region. Once impacts 
are monetised and seen in the context of the entire estate, the overall impact is considered to 
be low to moderate. 
The Group will use the insight provided by the scenario analysis to refine its property and 
insurance strategies.
Higher increases 
in temperature

54
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Risk and opportunity management continued
A deep-dive on physical risk to UK 
infrastructure
Scenario analysis completed in the previous 
financial year included a review of the physical 
climate risks affecting the UK infrastructure. 
The headlines of this analysis are as follows:
•	 Roads will be affected by increased precipitation 
due to landslide risks and closed roads, in addition 
to increased surface water runoff. Extreme heat 
can also cause roads to melt. Road disruption 
affects both distribution of goods and the ability for 
employees and customers to travel to sites.
•	 Ports will be affected by sea level rises, storm 
surges and damage to port infrastructure. Shipping 
fees may increase as ports raise handling fees for 
repairs after storm damage and port closures 
will cause bottlenecks at other ports across the UK. 
•	 Railways will be affected as heat waves can buckle 
tracks and flooding prevents trains from accessing 
tracks. Secondary risks include landslides and rock 
falls which can damage tracks and other rail 
infrastructure.
•	 Electricity supply will be affected as increased 
temperatures cause lower efficiency in electrical 
products, including solar panels. Storms can 
damage transmission lines and cause wind 
turbines to cut out. Storm damage to transmission 
lines left over one million people and businesses 
without power for a week in 2022. Extended 
droughts can impact water availability for 
hydroelectric power.
•	 IT infrastructure will be affected as increased 
flooding can corrode buried electrical cables and 
high-flowing flood water can damage telephone 
masts and other IT infrastructure. High 
temperatures impact wi-fi speeds as routers 
struggle to send and receive data.
The analysis confirms that the overall risks are low 
to medium, and the Group is well placed to balance 
the risk with the opportunity to sell products which 
prevent or remediate climate impacts.
The Group will use the insight provided by the 
scenario analysis to inform its approach to property 
locations, energy resilience, logistics planning, 
commercial strategy and business continuity.
A deep-dive on physical risk to timber  
supply chains
Scenario analysis completed in the previous 
financial year included a deep-dive review of the 
physical climate risks to timber supply chains. 
Globally, climate change is expected to increase the 
frequency of extreme weather events, exposing the 
timber industry to varying degrees of risk. 
Key takeaways from the analysis were as follows.
•	 Increased carbon in the atmosphere will benefit 
tree growth, providing other factors also increase 
(water availability, soil nutrients, etc.).
•	 There is a risk to timber quality as increased 
carbon can promote faster tree growth, potentially 
making the timber unsuitable for construction 
grade requirements.
•	 Increased heat waves can directly damage foliage 
on trees and bake soils, affecting growth rates.
•	 Drought events limit water availability for tree growth 
and can cause reduced yields or tree mortality.
•	 Wildfire events will be more frequent,  
damaging forests.
•	 Flooding, due to increased precipitation, can 
prevent access to forests.
•	 Warmer climates favour invasive pest and disease 
species, threatening trees and ecosystems.
•	 Storm damage will increase, damaging forests and 
also potentially requiring timber to be treated 
before it can be used in construction.
The Group is protected in general by its spread of 
supply chain partners, enabling continuity of supply 
when parts of the supply chain are affected. The 
risks of supply chain disruption are rated as low-
medium over the three scenarios. The Group will 
use the insight provided to inform its commercial 
strategy in order to ensure supply chain resilience 
and to work with suppliers to enable them to act 
early and support a just transition.
A desktop review of climate risks and 
opportunities of sample supply chain partners
A desktop review was completed in 2024 
of published climate risk reports from large 
manufacturers, in three product categories, and 
large customers, from two customer types. The 
results are presented on the next two pages. 
This research identified that:
•	 Suppliers and customers carry varying levels of 
risk and opportunity related to climate change, 
both transitional and physical.
•	 Companies within each category have “common 
risks” (i.e. certain transition risks relating to policy 
and markets) but also “company-specific risks” (i.e. 
physical risks based on their geographical 
locations, for example.)
•	 Common risks to all company types were physical 
impacts, carbon price and supply chain disruption.
•	 Manufacturers are dealing with the barriers to 
creating lower-carbon products while Customers 
are dealing with the risks of low availability of 
low-carbon solutions – there is progress underway 
but a hesitancy caused by technology, market and 
policy risks.
Implications for the Group
•	 The findings do not alter the Group’s climate risk 
and opportunity profile. However, the results do 
allow for better understanding and work with the 
supply chain to navigate the changes ahead.
•	 For companies that have identified their risks and 
opportunities and have adjusted their strategy 
accordingly, the Group can work with them to 
understand progress and their changing risk profile.
•	 For companies that have not yet identified their 
risks and opportunities, the Group can share 
guidance and insights to help them to understand 
the changes ahead and to ensure a just transition.
•	 The Group’s commercial team can use this 
information to consider the supplier portfolio and 
where other supplier partners may be needed over 
time to prevent supply chain disruption.
•	 The Group’s sales teams can use this information 
to consider which customer types need support to 
identify lower-carbon products or climate-
adaptation solutions.
•	 Additional product categories and customer types 
will be reviewed in future years to keep aware of 
upstream and downstream quantification of 
climate risk and opportunity and what this means 
for the Group.

55
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Risk type
Risk detail
Sample manufacturers
Sample customers
Plaster and 
plasterboard
Blocks, cements 
and concrete 
goods
Bricks
National 
housebuilders
Tier 1 contractors
Physical risk
Increase in intensity and frequency of extreme climate events
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Sea-level rise, increase in average temperatures, change in precipitation
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Water scarcity
Y
Y
Y
Y
Transition risk – Technology
Availability and cost of raw materials for low-carbon products
Y
Y
Y
Increase in costs for transition to low-carbon technology, energy and solutions
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Risk of lower product demand. New homes weight efficiency over space
Y
Y
Y
Slow technology innovation – CCUS*, hydrogen, low-carbon energy/transport
Y
Y
Y
Risk of new technology quickly becoming outdated
Y
Requirement for new skills to transition to new technology
Y
Y
Transition risk – Market
Increased price of Greenhouse Gas (GHG) emissions
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Increase in production and distribution costs (e.g. for high-carbon materials)
Y
Y
Y
Redefinition of types and nature of materials required
Y
Competitiveness risk with respect to imported materials (specific to Europe)
Y
Y
Disruptions in the value chain (supplies, operations, etc.)
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Risk loss of sales to lower-carbon alternatives or Modern Methods of Construction (MMC)
Y
Y
Risk of loss of competitiveness on new ranges of low-carbon solutions
Y
Risk of loss of competitiveness if low demand for low-carbon solutions
Y
Low availability of low-carbon product alternatives, not meeting demand
Y
Increased insurance premiums due to higher cost of adaptation measures
Y
Transition risk – Policy
Evolution of regulations (product, solutions, carbon reduction)
Y
Y
Y
Y
Climate change litigation
Y
Y
Y
Y
Extension of EU Emissions Trading Scheme (ETS), or reduction of free allowances on UK ETS
Y
Y
Poor accounting of full lifecycle of products
Y
Burden of enhanced/changing reporting regulations
Y
Y
Limitation on suitable fuels or materials
Y
Y
Lack of financial incentives for R&D and low-carbon investment
Y
Increased costs or risk of delays from changing housing regulations
Y
Y
Increased planning or site requirements lower land viability or cause delays
Y
Transition risk – Reputation
Continuation of extractive practices and the use of fossil fuels
Y
Lack of progress, communication and transparency on climate issues
Y
Y
Y
Changes in consumer preferences regarding the use of new materials
Y
Y
Y
Dissatisfaction of customers with new technology or homes
Y
Reduced access to capital or permits – if not meeting expectations
Y
Y
Greenwash risk from competitors – misleading the market
Y
Y
Public opposition for companies not meeting expectations
Y
Y
Challenges retaining/attracting talent – if not meeting expectations
Y
Y
*	
Carbon capture, utilisation and storage

56
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
Risk and opportunity management continued
Opportunity type
Opportunity detail
Sample manufacturers
Sample customers
Plaster and 
plasterboard
Blocks, cements 
and concrete 
goods
Bricks
National 
housebuilders
Tier 1 contractors
Physical opportunities
Impacted built environment in some areas driving demand for product
Y
Y
Transition opportunities – 
Technology
New materials and construction methods for lower environmental impact
Y
Y
Development of solutions to reduce dependence on raw materials
Y
Development of CCUS capability
Y
Y
Lower operating costs from energy efficiency measures
Y
Transition opportunities – Market
Increasing demand for low-carbon and/or recycled products, or MMC
Y
Y
Y
Y
Increasing demand to take local climate considerations into account
Y
Rising energy prices (e.g. need for energy saving products, etc.)
Y
Recognition of thermal mass benefits
Y
Y
Increasing demand for, and affordability of, green new homes and other developments
Y
Y
Green mortgage and energy efficiency cost savings allow for premium charge
Y
Home buyers can borrow more with a green mortgage and get a larger home
Y
Land buying and local partnerships enhanced with low-carbon homes
Y
Sustainability performance opens green financing (lower interest rates)
Y
Demand for retrofitting services including prioritisation over new build
Y
Increasing demand for climate adaptation measures and climate-resilient buildings
Y
Transition opportunities – Policy
Changes in regulations related to site operations (GHGs, Energy Performance Certificates (EPCs))
Y
Changes in regulations relating to product (recycled, low-carbon, labels) 
Y
Y
Y
Changes in local regulations due to regional climate conditions
Y
Credible accounting of full lifecycle of products
Y
Y
Lower carbon tax exposure where carbon reductions are made
Y
Transition opportunities – 
Reputation
Consumers’ need for transparency concerning environmental impact
Y
Y
Y
Investors’ need for transparency concerning environmental impact
Y
Y
Y
Greenwash risks well managed – allowing credit to be given where due
Y
Y
Increasing expectation of colleagues for sustainable business – talent attraction
Y
Y
Lower cost of capital opportunity
Y
To note: 
The companies reviewed often described their risks and opportunities differently or allocated them to different risk/opportunity types. Sensible 
decisions were made to consolidate this information and results are indicative only.
The companies reviewed had ranked their risks and opportunities according to severity. This is not presented in the table above to keep the summary 
simple as all companies only presented “material” risks and opportunities.
Whether one or all companies assessed listed a particular risk or opportunity, a “Y” was added to the table. The results show the breadth of risks and 
opportunities, and the differences by company type, rather than a weighting.
Companies reviewed: 
Plaster and plasterboard – Saint Gobain (parent company to British Gypsum)
Blocks, cements and concrete goods – Forterra, Heidelberg Materials, H+H, Marshalls, Tarmac, Tobermore
Bricks – Forterra, Ibstock, Wienerberger
National house builders – Barratt Developments, Taylor Wimpey
Tier 1 contractors – Balfour Beatty, Wates Group
Note: Sample companies selected based on availability of data (not all companies have published climate risk reports) and were limited to a small, 
representative sample.
Note: As only large listed (originally) and large private (recently) companies are required to publish information on climate risk, the research shows the 
naturally higher risk profile of large companies. Much of the Group’s customer base is SME trades who have not published climate risk reports and 
would be unlikely to identify with many of these risks and opportunities.

57
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Metrics and KPIs
Major 
emissions
categories
Other
emissions
categories
The Group sets out performance against a number 
of environmental KPIs, including absolute carbon 
reduction and performance against targets and 
additional detail on energy consumption. The Group 
has also included interim targets within the three 
carbon reduction roadmaps (buildings, fleet and 
Scope 3).
KPIs and metrics which align to the Group’s material 
climate-related risks and opportunities are set out in 
the table below. For additional detail required under 
Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting (“SECR”) 
please see the table on page 185.
The carbon KPIs are measured using the GHG 
protocol, are independently verified by LRQA 
and accepted by the SBTi. More details about the 
methodology can be found on the Group’s website 
(www.travisperkinsplc.co.uk/sustainability). The 
Group’s net zero target follows the UK government’s 
definition of total Scope 1 and 2 carbon emissions 
that are equal to or less than the emissions the 
Group removes from the environment. Data points 
from prior years may have been restated where 
better data is now available.
Carbon data table 
The Group has reported on all of the emission 
sources required under the Companies Act 2006 
(Strategic report and Directors’ reports) Regulations 
2013. The numbers reported include data for 
companies where Travis Perkins plc has operational 
control. Scope 1 and 2 emissions are calculated 
using the DEFRA Conversion Factors for Company 
Reporting 2024 on an operational control basis. 
Scope 3 emissions are calculated using EcoInvent or 
DEFRA factors, Environmental Product Declarations 
(“EPDs”) or other Life Cycle Assessment (“LCA”) 
data. Specific data points in the carbon chart and 
the carbon data table, marked with the logo 
, have 
been assured against Lloyd’s Register verification 
procedures. For a link to the assurance report 
see page 35. The following two footers relate to 
references in the carbon data table on the following 
page.
1.	 Fugitive emissions from domestic refrigeration and building 
air conditioning are excluded as they are not material to the 
Group’s overall emissions. 
2.	 Scope 3 data quality improved in 2024, due to data 
corrections and the use of Environmental Product 
Declaration carbon data where available within Category 
1: Purchased Goods and Services, instead of estimated 
emissions factors. The data methodology for Scope 3 is 
shared on the website https://www.travisperkinsplc.co.uk. 
Total emissions Scope 1, 2 and 3 
(tonnes CO2 e)
6,530,092
Scope 3 % of total emissions
99%
Breakdown of the Group’s 2024 Scope 3 carbon by category
Category 11: Use of sold products – 52%
Category 1: Purchased goods and services – 36%
All other categories – 12%
Category 4: Upstream transportation and distribution – 6.59%
Category 9: Downstream transportation and distribution – 2.01%
Category 12: End-of-life treatment of sold products – 1.58%
Category 10: Processing of sold products – 1.07%
Category 13: Downstream leased assets – 0.52%
Category 3: Fuel and energy related activities – 0.43%
Category 2: Capital goods – 0.42%
Category 6: Business travel – 0.09%
Category 7: Employee commuting – 0.07%
Category 5: Waste generated in operations – 0.01%

58
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
2024
2023
2020 (Baseline)
Performance in 
2024 vs 2023
Targets 
(with 2020 
baseline)
Performance in 
2024 against 
2020 target 
baseline year
UK
Non-UK
Total*
UK
Non-UK
Total*
UK
Non-UK
Total*
%*
%*
Energy GWh
Operational carbon
GWh energy
Annual energy use relating to gas, purchased electricity and transport 
fuel (for SECR compliant kWh data see the data table on page 185)
268
9
277
306
6
312
334
5
340
(11)%
Carbon Dioxide Equivalent (CO2e) Tonnes
Scope 1
Direct emissions from burning gas and solid fuel for heating and from 
road fuel use for distribution1
44,440
1.097
45,537 
51,325
501
51,826 
60,656
641
61,297
(12)%
Scope 2
Indirect emissions from the Group’s use of electricity
0
402
402 
0
856
856
17,333
461
17,794
(53)%
Scope 1 and 2 Absolute
44.440
1,499
45,939 
51,325
1.357
52,682
77,989
1,102
79,091
(13)%
Net zero by 2035 
(min. 80% reduction)
(42)%
Scope 1 and 2 Intensity
Tonnes Scope 1 and 2 emissions per £m of revenue
9.8
13.1
9.9 
10.7
11.3
10.8
21.3
15.7
21.2
(9)%
(54)%
Scope 1 and 2 Intensity *NEW KPI*
Tonnes Scope 1 and 2 emissions per tonne of product sold
0.0055
0.0927
0.0057
0.0062
0.0964
0.0063
(10)%
% of fleet (inc. MHE) that is low-carbon in use (either electric,  
hybrid or alternate fuel)
42%
25%
16%
17 ppt
Supply chain carbon
Scope 3 Absolute2
Indirect emissions from the supply chain. Including all Scope 3 categories
6,244,830
239,323
6,484,153 
6,666,567
292,988
6,959,554
8,466,700
424
8,467,124
(7)%
63% reduction 
by 2035
(23)%
Scope 3 Intensity
Tonnes Scope 3 emissions per £m of revenue
1,374
2,088
1,391 
1,401
2,448
1,426
2,316
6
2,274
(2)%
(39)%
Scope 3 Intensity *NEW KPI*
Tonnes Scope 3 emissions per tonne of product sold
0.779
14.794
0.807
0.802
20.807
0.836
(3)%
% heat generators sold which are low carbon (i.e. heat pumps, solar thermal 
or electric boilers)
19.00%
10.7%
8.3 ppt
% of Group product spend with suppliers engaged on decarbonisation 
(carbon calculated and targets set)
61%
57%
1%
4 ppt
Total 
carbon
Scope 1, 2 and 3 Absolute
6,289,270
240,822
6,530,092
6,717,892
294,345
7,012,237
8,544,689
1,526
8,546,215
(7)%
(24)%
SUSTAINABILITY REPORT CONTINUED
*	
Note that figures stated are rounded to a sensible whole number or decimal point. 
Totals or percentages reflect true not rounded number calculations.
1 and 2: See previous page for more information on these two points

59
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
STATEMENT OF PRINCIPAL RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES
Maintaining a dynamic and effective risk management process is central to the successful delivery of the Group’s strategic objectives and 
building resilience, as the Group continues to navigate a challenging external environment, an evolving risk landscape and continued uncertainty.
Risk management framework
The Group takes a balanced approach to manage risks in a proactive, efficient and effective way, targeted at the most significant risks, particularly where there is a low tolerance for risk or uncertainty. The risk management 
framework considers risk from both a “top down” and “bottom up” perspective, to support a comprehensive and common understanding of the risks and opportunities and their potential impact on the achievement of the 
Group’s strategic priorities, and to provide a multi-layered approach to the review and management of risk. The approach and key responsibilities remain consistent with prior years, as set out in the diagram below:
Key activities
Risk appetite – An annual Board exercise to consider the nature 
and level of risk it is prepared to accept to deliver the strategy
Risk identification – Key review and decision-making processes 
capture risks, including reviews of strategy, major programme 
and performance
Risk assessment – Risks are prioritised using a standard scoring 
mechanism and compared to appetite
Risk response – Action is taken, if possible, for risks outside 
appetite. Risk acceptance is formalised 
Reporting and monitoring – The Board, Audit Committee and 
GLT receive regular risk reports and challenge and agree the 
Group’s principal risks and mitigation strategies twice a year
Emerging risks and issues – areas of change are monitored 
through regular risk activities, assurance processes and horizon 
scanning
Internal control and assurance framework – a “three lines” 
model to confirm effective risk management
TOP DOWN
Board – Audit Committee 
– GLT – Risk function
Activities focused on the assessment and 
mitigation of material risks to the Group’s strategy, 
business models and operations
The Board
•	 Overall responsibility for risk management and internal control, 
reviewing effectiveness annually
•	 Reviews and selects the Group principal and emerging risks 
and approves related disclosures
•	 Sets the risk appetite and monitors adherence
The Audit Committee
•	 Regular assessment of the risk management framework, and 
development activities
•	 Monitors the results of key assurance processes 
•	 Provides assurance to the Board on the effectiveness of risk 
management and financial, compliance, and operational 
controls
The Group Leadership Team (“GLT”)
•	 Undertakes regular top-down risk reviews
•	 Monitors key risks particularly in relation to safety, programmes 
and performance
Business and functional leadership
•	 Responsible for control, compliance with minimum standards 
and the active management of risk for their area 
The Risk function
•	 Maintains the risk management framework 
•	 Co-ordinates “top down” reporting, horizon scanning and risk 
disclosures 
•	 Reviews and challenges risk content and the quality 
of mitigation plans
BOTTOM UP
Risk Function – Business  
and Functional Leadership 
– Major Programmes
Activities across the Group that capture and  
assess significant risks at a business unit, 
programme or functional level
Further details on the Group’s risk management responsibilities and oversight are set out in the Corporate Governance report on page 74.

60
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
STATEMENT OF PRINCIPAL RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES CONTINUED
Risk appetite
The Board accepts that, in order to achieve its strategic objectives, and generate suitable returns for 
shareholders, it must accept and actively manage a certain level of risk. The Board undertakes an exercise, 
at least annually, to consider the nature and level of risk it is prepared to accept to deliver the strategy and 
to set its resulting risk appetite. Following a comprehensive restatement of risk appetite last year, the Board 
has reviewed and updated its position during 2024. No significant changes were made during the year, and 
the risk appetite statements for the principal risks were approved by the Board. These are used to define the 
risk-taking parameters for all significant activity within the business.
The risk appetite continues to balance opportunities for growth and business development in areas that 
present a clear opportunity for reward, against a low risk tolerance for activities that offer little commercial 
advantage or that may present a significant safety, legal, regulatory or reputational risk.
The Board also considered the principal risks in the context of risk appetite and assessed current and 
planned mitigating activities to ensure that these key risks are being managed within the stated appetite.
Principal risks
The Group operates in an industry and markets which, by their nature, are subject to a number of inherent 
risks. In common with many large organisations, the Group is also influenced by a complex set of external 
factors, including geopolitical and economic risks, which have continued to bring uncertainty during 2024. 
The principal risks that are considered to have a potentially material impact on the Group’s operations and 
achievement of its strategic objectives are set out below. Further detail in respect of the potential risk impact 
and the mitigating actions taken is explored on the following pages. The scope and potential impact of risks 
will change over time. As such the risks set out below should not be regarded as a comprehensive statement 
of all potential risks and uncertainties that may manifest in the future. Additional risks and uncertainties that 
are not presently known, or which are currently deemed immaterial, could also have an adverse effect on the 
Group’s future operating results, financial condition or prospects.
The Board and GLT assess the Group’s principal and emerging risks at least twice a year, with a detailed 
assessment of external and internal developments and influences on the risk set.
The existing principal risk set remains relevant and appropriate, and no risks have been added or removed in 
the latest risk review. Whilst each of the risks and associated mitigations continue to evolve, the overarching 
trends and inherent risk levels are assessed to be broadly consistent year-on-year. The Board has discussed 
risk trends and influencing factors, and as set out in the half year results, the trend for the Managing Change 
principal risk was updated to Increasing as a result of the large-scale change experienced by the Group during 
2024, including the appointment of a new CEO and Chair and implementation of new systems. The risk 
trend relating to Macroeconomic Volatility was also updated to Limited change year-on-year to reflect a 
relative stabilisation in the level of uncertainty in the macro environment impacting the Group.
Figure 1 – Principal risks: at a glance
Risk category
Principal risks
Strategic 
objective
Risk trend
Inherent 
risk1
2024
2023
External
1. Long term market trends
ABCD
High
2. Macroeconomic volatility
AE
High
3. Supply chain resilience
BC
High
Strategic
4. Managing change
ABCDE
Medium
5. Climate change & carbon reduction
D
High
Technological
6. Cyber threat and data security
D
High
Operational
7. Health, safety & wellbeing
D
Medium
8. Legal compliance
D
Medium
9. Critical asset failure
BCD
Medium
1	
Risk is stated before the application of control.          Key   
  New   
  Increasing   
  Decreasing   
  Limited change year-on-year
2024 strategic objectives:    A  Operating & leading in attractive markets    B  An efficient and sustainable operating model   
C  Maximising the potential of Toolstation    D  Leveraging the scale of the Group    E  Delivering attractive financial outcomes
Principal risks heat map:
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
9
8
After mitigating action or controls
Impact
Likelihood
Key disruptive risks that may impact the viability of a strategy or business model are also identified and 
managed. The Group does not currently consider any of these to be standalone principal risks. Several  
of the risks set out below, particularly long-term market trends, include elements that can be considered 
disruptive in nature, however they are categorised in the table above according to the primary driver of the 
risk for the Group.

61
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Emerging risks
The risk environment in which the Group operates will continue to evolve as a result of future events and 
uncertainties, and awareness of related emerging risks forms part of the overall risk assessment process. 
The Group seeks to capture emerging risks that do not currently present a significant risk but which may 
have the potential to adversely impact its operations in the future. This enables the Group to monitor and 
understand the potential implications and build these into the decision-making processes at the right 
time. The Group identifies new and emerging risks through a process of horizon scanning that includes 
assessment of our risk set against a diverse set of external benchmarks, alongside perspectives on emerging 
risks collated from assessments made by the business and functional leadership teams and  
the results of assurance activities.
Unrest across the Middle East and the war in Ukraine continue to be monitored as potential risks in relation 
to the Group’s supply chain and macroeconomic volatility more generally, and the Group continues to ensure 
compliance with relevant trade sanctions. Changes following globally significant elections during 2024 will 
be closely monitored, and the Board remains watchful of developments which may impact the Group. There 
are no other emerging risks considered significant enough to report at this time.
Long-term market trends
Inherent risk: 
High
Relevance:
Industry-wide
Risk 
Trend: 
Description
The construction sector is changing, driven by both macro and sector-specific factors. In the short term, 
the sector saw an improvement following the pandemic, only to be then impacted by multiple macro 
factors: a recession in the UK, global economic instability and a change of government. In the long-term, 
there are multiple opportunities and risks for the Group:
•	 The housing shortage in the UK, covering both private and social housing, presents significant 
opportunity for the Group. A growing population and desire for home ownership both fuel long-term 
demand. New government targets look to increase the number of houses built each year, however the 
ability to deliver on this target in the next five years is considered a significant challenge.
•	 A growing productivity challenge in the construction sector needs to be addressed alongside an 
increasing scarcity of technical knowledge and a more general labour shortage.
•	 The challenges presented by the age and condition of existing housing stock in the UK, further 
impacted by the need to meet the Decent Homes Standard.
•	 Manufacturers of the materials and products sold by the Group may look to sell directly to end 
customers. Disintermediation has the potential to increase in a challenging economic environment 
where customers are more price sensitive and proposition differentiation becomes less important.
•	 ESG factors are becoming more fundamental to long-term success but are challenging to address, 
requiring investment and broad engagement across the sector.
•	 Changing UK legislation and a move to modern methods of construction drives a need to manage 
changing building standards and the future framework for heat in buildings through the products 
and services offered by the Group.
Mitigation
Whilst current macroeconomic conditions are challenging, the long-term fundamental drivers of the 
Group’s end markets remain robust. The UK faces a shortage of new and affordable housing, alongside a 
significant backlog of maintenance and improvement work on public sector assets and the need to 
decarbonise an ageing housing stock is growing in urgency. 
The Group is well positioned to partner with the construction industry to address these challenges. Its 
balanced portfolio of businesses all hold #1 or #2 positions in their markets and benefit from a diverse 
end market exposure, from small independent builders to large national contractors.
The Group has five focused businesses serving specific construction markets. There is local 
empowerment to serve small trade businesses and the general builder. This is then complemented by 
specialist propositions for larger contractors that have the technical capability to add value.
The Group has a nationwide network, with purchasing power of over £3bn annually, built upon a wide 
product range with strong availability and relationships. The Group continues to be underpinned by its values 
and doing the right thing, whilst continuing to develop an efficient and sustainable operating model.
The Board conducts an annual review of strategy, which includes an assessment of likely competitor 
activity, market forecasts and possible future trends in products, channels of distribution, 
disintermediation threats and customer behaviour.
The Group maintains a comprehensive tracking system for lead indicators that influence the market for 
the consumption of building materials in the UK.
Impact: Adverse effect on financial results; loss of market share

62
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
STATEMENT OF PRINCIPAL RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES CONTINUED
Macroeconomic volatility
Inherent risk: 
High
Relevance: 
Industry-wide
Risk 
Trend: 
Description
The Group’s operations are predominantly based in the UK, serving UK customers, with a small presence in 
the EU. These operations place some reliance on a multi-territory supply base that exposes the Group to 
much wider macroeconomic and geopolitical uncertainty. 
The UK continues to face a range of macroeconomic challenges including, along with many of the countries 
from which the Group also sources product, weak demand in the construction sector (driven in part by 
persistently high interest rates) and an increasing tax burden on both individuals and businesses.
Alongside general economic conditions, Group performance is affected by a number of specific drivers 
of construction, RMI and DIY activity. Whilst current trading conditions remain challenging, the Group’s 
lead indicators, which include the volume of housing transactions, house price inflation, and consumer 
confidence, suggest an improving outlook. However, the timing and strength of a recovery in the UK 
construction sector remains uncertain and is likely to vary across specific segments.
Continued uncertainty in the external environment could negatively impact the Group’s ability to grow 
market share and deliver an improved trading performance. A stable government with a large majority, 
however, does provide a more reassuring backdrop and potentially will encourage increased investment 
in the UK. The Autumn 2024 budget may offer some opportunities for the Group through increased 
infrastructure investment but the additional taxes levied on employers to support this investment will 
require mitigating management actions. The new Government’s target of building 1.5 million new homes 
over the next five years is unlikely to be achieved but the intent, alongside positive steps to reform the 
application of planning laws, is supportive for a recovery in new housebuilding activity which the Group is 
well placed to benefit from.
Mitigation 
The Group remains confident in the long-term resilience of its diverse end markets, which are showing 
early signs of recovery, but needs to consider capital investment and overhead management carefully 
given the uncertainty regarding the speed and scale of a recovery in UK construction demand. Actions 
taken in 2024, such as the consolidation of the Group’s Commercial and Supply Chain functions, and 
modernising of key technology platforms, will deliver operational efficiencies whilst ensuring the Group is 
in a strong position to respond to the anticipated recovery in underlying markets when this begins to 
materialise.
The Group continually reviews pricing strategies and product availability across each of the businesses.
Policy and legislative changes that may impact the Group are monitored and, where appropriate, actions 
taken to ensure the Group is adequately prepared to address relevant changes.
The Group has a conservative hedging policy to reduce its exposure to currency and energy price 
fluctuations.
The Group has committed debt facilities of £800m, including a £375m revolving credit facility that was 
renewed in November 2023 with a five-year term plus a two-year extension option. 
The Group has balanced supporting colleagues at a difficult time with adjusting the cost base to reflect 
market conditions. Colleague salaries were reviewed in April 2024, with lower paid colleagues supported 
with a larger pay increase whilst higher paid colleagues received a more modest uplift. 
Impact: Operational disruption; adverse effect on ranging and/or price, customer service and financial results

63
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Supply chain resilience
Inherent risk: 
High
Relevance: 
Industry-wide
Risk 
Trend: 
Description
A resilient supply chain is a critical factor in serving customers and achieving strategic objectives. 
There is both breadth and depth in the supply chain. Sourcing is undertaken across the globe and the 
Group sells a wide range of products, from materials such as timber through to power tools comprising 
many components. The smooth operation of this extensive supply chain may be disrupted by many events 
and circumstances outside of the Group’s direct control including public health crises, geopolitical and 
macroeconomic factors, industrial action, transport network disruption and climate impacts.
In certain product categories, the Group faces risk in relation to key supplier dependencies, where there are 
limited alternative options. The Group is the largest customer to a number of our suppliers and, in some 
cases, those suppliers are material enough to cause significant difficulties and disruption if they are unable 
to meet their supply obligations. Alternative sourcing may be possible, but the volumes required and the 
production time needed could impact availability.
ESG matters are increasingly important to the Group and its customers: sourcing responsibly is a strategic 
focus area. This places additional requirements on the supply chain, which may increase over time. This is a 
means to assess supplier resilience but if suppliers do not meet the Group’s standards it could further 
restrict supplier options.
Mitigation 
The Group maintains strong relationships with its key suppliers and continuously works with them to agree 
mutually beneficial contracts, conduct due diligence in line with its commitment to responsible sourcing, and 
ensure a continuous supply of quality materials. 
Where possible the Group has multiple sourcing strategies for key products, to reduce the effect of a 
supply failure. The Group keeps stock levels under constant review and has a track record of effectively 
managing availability issues in conjunction with suppliers. 
Potential impacts to the Group’s supply chain from geopolitical developments are closely monitored.
During 2024 the Group’s Commercial function was restructured, with teams now aligned by product 
category, eliminating duplication, lowering costs and enabling the Group to build broader category 
expertise alongside harmonising ranges and trading terms. The changes will also enable the development 
of a Group-wide customer proposition.
Investment in the Group’s distribution capabilities has continued in 2024, with a number of actions taken 
to consolidate the Group’s supply chain, drive efficiency, and reduce risk where possible, including:
•	 Closure of Toolstation distribution centres in Bridgwater and Daventry in order to drive long-term 
efficiencies from the investment in the Pineham distribution centre.
•	 Consolidation of the Group’s timber supply chain with the closure of the King’s Lynn and Tilbury 
timber supply centres.
•	 Closure of the Benchmarx assembly facility in South Molton with kitchen cabinets now solely 
assembled at the Group’s Primary Distribution Hub in Northampton.
The Group holds Authorised Economic Operator status as a preferred importer in order to reduce 
potential customs delays.
Published Supplier Commitments clearly articulate the Group’s expectations. Independent checks are 
undertaken at the factories producing products for the Group, covering ethical, safety, environmental, 
financial and quality factors. The results of these checks are kept under review with action taken as 
necessary to address any concerns. Guidance is provided for suppliers and workshops are held to help 
them to improve and protect their own operations and supply chains.
Impact: Adverse impact on ranging and/or price, customer service and financial results

64
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
STATEMENT OF PRINCIPAL RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES CONTINUED
Managing change
Inherent risk: 
Medium
Relevance: 
Company specific
Risk 
Trend:
Description
Embracing and effectively navigating change is fundamental to the Group’s future success.
The ability to attract, retain and develop colleagues, or add capability through targeted acquisitions or 
partnerships, is central to ensuring that the Group has the right skills and experience to deliver its 
strategic initiatives. The Group increasingly competes for skills nationally and internationally and, in key 
areas such as data analytics, the demand for skills may increase recruitment time and costs. Market 
forces could make it harder to secure capabilities key to strategic delivery.
Technology-enabled business change
The Group has embarked on a number of major technology projects to underpin its operations, enable 
the future growth plans and meet customers’ changing needs. Delivering the systems and associated 
business change required is key to achieving these objectives.
In adopting a more agile, incremental approach to business change, enabled by technology, the Group 
needs to manage an extended transition period where old and new technologies must successfully 
co-exist.
Against a backdrop of economic uncertainty and difficult trading conditions, the pace of delivery may 
need to flex with available resources, which could lead to missed opportunities or delays to access 
operational benefits and/or deliver on strategic priorities. The Group has not delivered significant 
technology change for a long time, and through the projects undertaken in 2024, a need to further build 
our internal skills base and expertise has been identified, to ensure the business is better positioned and 
prepared to undertake future change.
Mitigation 
A Group-wide “Idea to Live” process is used to prioritise, approve and manage change initiatives in a 
transparent and consistent way. 
Dedicated teams deliver major programmes with external expertise added to support when necessary. 
Programmes consider the related capability requirements and the options to buy or grow the skills 
needed for a strategically significant opportunity.
Major programmes are sponsored by a designated GLT member. Defined governance structures are in 
place, including programme Steering Committees, and oversight of programme assurance at the Audit 
Committee. Regular Board reporting and the monthly GLT Programme Review to assess progress, 
milestones, risks, interdependencies and key decisions.
The transition of finance processes into the Kerridge system is now complete, and the system will be 
rolled out to the branch network in 2025, facilitating significant modernisation of the technological 
landscape in BSS.
Oracle Financials was implemented across the other merchanting businesses, and will continue to deliver 
significant technological and business process enhancements, resulting in a more robust control 
environment.
The Group undertakes post-investment review exercises to assess the success of change programmes, in 
both financial and non-financial terms. If projects do not deliver against expectations, the “lessons 
learned” inform future programmes.
Impact: Failure to deliver the strategy; adverse effect on financial results, shareholder value, colleague engagement

65
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Climate change and carbon reduction
Inherent risk:
High
Relevance:
Industry-wide
Risk 
Trend: 
Description
Climate change will significantly impact the construction sector during the transition to a low-carbon 
environment. The nature, extent and scale of that change remains unclear although headline risks and 
opportunities have been forecasted through climate scenario analysis. The Group is committed to 
helping the industry decarbonise by providing low-carbon products, supplied through efficient 
operations, to produce improved outcomes for communities. 
This commitment not only promotes a sustainable business model, but also supports progress against 
the Group’s carbon targets and influences the wider industry, to mitigate the significant threats posed by 
climate change.
The Group’s top climate-related risks relate to:
•	 The move to a low-carbon fleet, given the Group has one of the largest UK vehicle fleets;
•	 Increasing costs of goods due to producer country carbon pricing mechanisms; 
•	 The ability to transition to new lower-carbon product categories; and 
•	 Product obsolescence for higher-carbon product categories.
Delivering the Group’s carbon reduction targets will be challenging. It requires significant investment and 
engagement with the wider construction products industry to reduce supply-chain and product carbon. 
In a difficult economic environment, both the Group and the wider industry must collaborate to deliver 
this change amid short-term capital expenditure restrictions which could limit progress and shorten the 
target period for investment.
Environmental matters are increasingly important to colleagues, customers, suppliers, investors and 
government, driving changes to demand, expectations and information requirements, which the Group 
must identify and effectively respond to.
Mitigation
The Group regularly identifies its most material climate-related responsibilities and challenges in order to 
target investment and drive effective mitigation. Governance is led by the Board, which receives regular 
reports on the most material climate risks and opportunities, the action taken and the progress made.
The Group has made progress against its SBTi accredited targets, which are underpinned by clear 
roadmaps for delivery in each business, although absolute reductions will also have been impacted by 
recent volume declines.
The Group allocates capital to meet its commitments. The Group completed its roll-out of new electric 
forklift trucks, replacing diesel alternatives and saving around 5,000 tonnes of carbon a year. The Group 
has also invested in HVO as an alternate fuel in 37 branches, serving 210 HGVs in 2024. The LED roll out 
also continues across the branch network.
A key element of plans to address Scope 3 carbon emissions is engagement throughout the whole 
supply chain. The Group is working closely with suppliers to collect Environmental Product Declarations in 
order to extract and better use carbon data and provide customers with information to support Scope 3 
reductions. By the end of 2024, 14% of the Group’s spend was backed by high-quality carbon data 
(Environmental Product Declarations or other Life Cycle Assessments) at a product level, with work 
ongoing to continually improve this coverage. Collaboration and engagement with suppliers and 
customers on decarbonisation continues with either tailored support or wider industry working groups  
and events.
Alongside targeted investments and ongoing engagement, developments to support ongoing carbon 
reduction in 2024 include:
•	 Development of a product-carbon report for customers by CCF, soon to expand to the Group. This 
builds on the previously developed delivery-carbon report.
•	 Investment in the renewables category team to expand the Group’s offering and support customer 
adoption of new technology.
Further information on progress made during the year can be found in the Sustainability report on pages 
30-31, 34-35 and 57-58.
Impact: Adverse effect on reputation, financial and/or operational performance; competitive disadvantage; less attractive as an investment stock

66
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
STATEMENT OF PRINCIPAL RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES CONTINUED
Cyber threat & data security
Inherent risk:
High
Relevance:
Industry-wide
Risk 
Trend: 
Description
Events in the last year highlight how geopolitical crises and technological changes increase the risk of 
cyber attacks. Sophisticated, targeted and increasingly frequent cyber-crimes represent a real and 
present risk to all Group businesses, particularly given the drive to accelerate application development to 
support the expanding adoption of digital services by customers large and small. Risks associated with a 
growing digital footprint are further exacerbated by geopolitical tensions, cyber warfare and 
advancements in highly disruptive new technologies, such as artificial intelligence.
Incidents impacting the confidentiality, integrity and availability of the Group’s data and systems could 
disrupt customers and the supply chain. Theft and misuse of confidential data, damage to or 
manipulation of operationally critical data or interruption to technology services would have a serious 
consequential impact on the Group’s reputation, ability to trade and the risk of fines relating to non-
compliance with regulations, including the Payment Card Industry Data Security Standard and General 
Data Protection Regulation.
The Group currently assesses its main risk of attack to be from opportunistic criminals seeking financial 
gain either from the theft and sale of personal data or encrypting data to demand ransom payments, 
either directly or as the result of supply-chain attacks. The Group has seen a year-on-year continued 
increase in the volume, frequency, and sophistication of attempted cyber-attacks, which aligns with 
broader trends.
As the Group continues to drive digital change to meet customers’ expectations and obtain competitive 
advantage, the underlying data that powers these services is of increasing value to cyber criminals.
In executing the technology, data and security strategy, the Group will move away from legacy internally 
hosted systems and transition to new cloud-based services, with enhanced native cloud security 
capabilities that will improve the overall security maturity and posture for the Group.
Mitigation 
The Group is proactive in ensuring it meets its responsibilities and legal obligations in respect of 
information security and compliance, taking a risk-based approach in relation to people, process and 
technology to reduce the overall likelihood and impact of cyber incidents. 
To ensure the Group stays ahead of evolving threats, it is essential to maintain the security of its network 
edge perimeter, infrastructure and sensitive data, while continuing to build cyber resilience into 
technology-driven digital processes. Key elements of the framework to achieve these aims include: 
•	 Modern XDR endpoint protection and continuous threat hunting to rapidly identify potential 
vulnerabilities and attack vectors rapidly.
•	 Regularly reviewing, updating and rehearsing incident capabilities, including lessons learnt from 
attempted attacks and threat intelligence sharing. The Group has third-party support services with 
an approved NCSC Incident Responder (IR) specialist capabilities, including forensic, containment 
and recovery.
•	 Education and awareness are promoted across all colleague levels: baseline cyber awareness 
training is in place, which is further enhanced with regular phishing simulations, awareness 
campaigns and the work of information security champions.
The Group continually tests its security posture via CREST-approved Penetration Testers and takes steps 
to remediate any vulnerabilities or weaknesses identified. Changes to technology solutions require 
Information Security review and approval.
Impact: Operational disruption; adverse effect on reputation; potential legal action, fines and penalties

67
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Health, safety & wellbeing
Inherent risk:
Medium
Relevance:
Industry-wide
Risk 
Trend: 
Description
Keeping people safe and well is clearly aligned to the Group’s purpose. The Group expects everyone to 
go home safe and well, every single day.
The Group operates a large estate, with many sites running complex and busy yards. The Group also 
operates one of the largest vehicle and mechanical handling equipment fleets in the UK, distributing 
heavy and bulky materials. Certain products that are sold pose health and safety risks. Poorly 
implemented safety practices on site, on the road and at delivery locations could result in significant 
harm to colleagues, customers and the wider community.
Full ownership of Staircraft adds a further element to the Group’s safety risk profile, with this business 
carrying an inherent risk (and greater likelihood) of harm from the manufacturing process, in a sector 
with different requirements and greater regulatory scrutiny.
Mitigation 
Health, safety and wellbeing are fundamental to the Group’s values. The Group continues to challenge 
current ways of thinking to de-risk its operations and improve safety performance. An open reporting 
culture is fostered, with colleagues encouraged to “Call It Out” if they see anything that they consider to be 
unsafe. Monthly communication to colleagues highlight examples of successfully “calling it out” or where 
there are lessons to be learned.
Safety governance is well established and designed to promote continual focus and improvement. A 
process of reviewing the Group Safety strategy has commenced, with a view to identifying further 
opportunities to drive compliance and performance against existing controls. Safety performance is 
reviewed at every level of the business, including at all Board meetings and by the dedicated Safety 
Committee, which is chaired by a Non-executive Director. The process of assessing safety compliance 
and performance at sites across the Group has been reviewed during 2024 and will be rolled out in 2025 
to maintain focus on key risks and drive consistency in management reporting.
Staircraft has now embedded the Group’s Safety Management System and is supported by dedicated 
safety support along with a new business leadership team.
The Mental Health First Aider community continues to support colleagues and the Group maintains 
a suite of resources in the online StayWell hub during the year.
Further information on progress made during the year can be found in the Safety and Wellbeing report 
on page 40.
Impact: Harm to colleagues, customers or the public; potential legal action, fines and penalties; adverse effect on reputation

68
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
STATEMENT OF PRINCIPAL RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES CONTINUED
Legal compliance
Inherent risk: 
Medium
Relevance: 
Industry-wide
Risk 
Trend: 
Description
The Group is subject to a broad range of existing and evolving governance requirements, environmental, 
health and safety and other laws, regulations, standards and best practices which affect the way that it 
operates and gives rise to significant compliance costs, potential legal liability exposure for non-
compliance and potential limitations on the development of the Group’s operations and strategy, if not 
managed correctly. The scope of these requirements is in keeping with an organisation of our scale and 
operational model.
The ongoing global development of ESG reporting regimes, the continuing implementation of the Building 
Safety Act 2022, as well as responding to UK corporate governance reforms all require the Group to 
assess current processes, controls and related assurance. New requirements may also be placed on the 
Group as it develops new value-add services in response to the evolving needs of our customers.
Should the Group fail to deliver against its legal and regulatory obligations, as well as broader 
responsibility commitments, this could significantly undermine the Group’s reputation, result in the 
imposition of fines or other enforcement action, and adversely impact operations and results.
Mitigation 
The Group maintains a number of teams of subject matter experts with responsibility for supporting 
delivery against legal and regulatory obligations that affect the business. Internal subject matter expertise 
is augmented by external advisors. The GLT and the Board regularly monitor compliance with laws 
and regulations.
A Code of Conduct, supported by minimum standards, all-colleague mandatory training and 
comprehensive framework of detailed policies, sets out the requirements for all colleagues to do business 
in the right way with adherence periodically monitored by the GLT.
The Group encourages colleagues to speak up whenever they see or suspect activity that contravenes the 
values, Code of Conduct or policies. All cases reported through the independent hotline are investigated.
The Group shares a Supplier Manual and Supplier Commitments to articulate its expectations of the 
supply base and higher risk suppliers are assessed against these requirements through onsite audits or 
an Online Risk Assessment. As construction is exposed to more modern slavery than many other 
industries, the Group is a member of the Supply Chain Sustainability School’s Modern Slavery Group, and 
contributed to the development of the School’s new Operational Toolkit; “Combatting Slavery in the Built 
Environment” to support businesses with their modern slavery due diligence.
The Group has mapped out the ESG reporting changes ahead and is readying the data and information 
required to meet these in the timescales indicated. Further information on the Group’s climate disclosures 
in line with TCFD guidelines can be found on pages 43 to 58.
Progress continues in the product provenance strategic workstream to track product data from source 
through the supply chain to a customer’s project.
The Group has begun a scoping and materiality assessment as part of its preparation for the first internal 
controls declaration required by UK Corporate Reform requirements, and regular updates will be provided 
to the GLT and Audit Committee throughout the year, ahead of the reporting deadline.
Impact: Adverse effect on reputation, financial and/or operational performance; potential legal action, fines and penalties; diversion of management attention

69
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Critical asset failure
Inherent risk:
Medium
Relevance:
Company specific
Risk 
Trend: 
Description
Disruption of a critical Group asset, whether a primary Group distribution location, or a key system failure 
or outage, could significantly interrupt operations. More generally, if the Group is unable to effectively 
respond to global or national events, which may impact multiple sites simultaneously, this could also 
significantly impact operations and performance.
Distribution centres
The Group operates a small number of distribution centres with significant stockholdings with an 
increasing volume of deliveries that are shipped direct to the end customer. Whilst many categories, 
particularly lightside products, are held throughout the network such that a short period of disruption 
could be managed, certain categories such as kitchens would present more significant challenges over  
a prolonged period of disruption. Certain distribution locations hold product, and related handling 
equipment, that is not carried elsewhere in the network.
IT systems
In its day-to-day operations the Group is dependent on a wide range of IT systems and supporting 
infrastructure. The Group’s current IT landscape is complex and includes some legacy systems that lack 
the functionality of modern software and where expertise is diminishing. Although adequate resources 
and processes are in place that keep the current IT estate well maintained and operational, and there is a 
plan to replace the legacy systems over time, the older systems present an increasing risk of failures or 
outages and require more effort to maintain.
Mitigation 
Crisis management & business continuity planning
The Group has developed crisis response capabilities, overseen by a Group-level steering group. In the 
event of an incident, tiered crisis response teams are mobilised that coordinate activity and provide 
ongoing monitoring, decision support and communications.
A risk-based approach is taken to business continuity management with a focus on critical infrastructure. 
This is currently being reviewed through the preparation of updated strategic business impact 
assessments in each Group business. The supporting business continuity plans prepared for key sites 
cover a range of scenarios. Regular prevention measures, such as fire risk assessments, are undertaken 
across the estate as well as maintenance programmes, in order to reduce the risk of internally-generated 
disruption.
The Group’s size and scale helps to mitigate stock issues in the event of disruption. The Group carries a 
level of buffer stock in the network that would be sufficient to cover a short-term disruptive event. The 
Group has the ability to leverage the lightside capability in Toolstation to support an issue in Travis 
Perkins, and vice versa. Branch-level disruption would be managed by fulfilling orders from alternative 
local sites and re-routing stock.
IT disaster recovery
The Group’s incident management process is designed to prioritise and respond to any incident quickly 
and effectively, with escalation and communication protocols. Recovery targets are in place, designed to 
minimise the operational and customer impact. The Group’s IT function is in the process of moving IT 
infrastructure and systems to the AWS Cloud which will further remove physical risks and continue to 
modernise the Group’s technology infrastructure, and is on target to complete the migration in 2025.
Impact: Adverse effect on performance: financial, operational, customer service; diversion of management attention

70
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
NON-FINANCIAL AND SUSTAINABILITY INFORMATION STATEMENT
The information below is intended to help users of these accounts understand our position on key  
non-financial and sustainability matters and has been prepared in response to the reporting requirements 
contained in section 414C(7), 414CA and 414CB of the Companies Act 2006.
Reporting requirements
Principal risks
Policy embedding, outcomes and key performance indicators
Link
Colleagues
Health, safety and 
wellbeing
Business model
Page 11
KPIs – Accident frequency rate
Page 15
Safety and wellbeing
Page 40
Managing change
Development
Page 37
Modern slavery and human rights
Page 36
Diversity and inclusion
Page 38
Colleague voice and engagement
Page 41
Reward
Page 41
Directors’ remuneration report
Page 90
Directors’ report – Employees
Page 119
Environment
Climate change and 
carbon reduction
Business model
Page 11
KPIs – Carbon emissions
Page 15
Climate-related financial disclosure
Page 43
Sustainability report
Page 26
Carbon
Page 30, 
34, 58
Waste
Page 34
Modernising construction
Page 30
Human rights, 
anti-bribery 
and anti-corruption
Legal compliance
Human rights and modern slavery
Page 36
Supply chain resilience
Legal compliance
Page 36
Directors’ report – Modern slavery
Page 119
Social and 
community
Managing change
Business model
Page 11
Charity and community
Page 42
Responsible sourcing
Page 32
A description of the Group’s business model and how it creates sustainable value can be found on pages 14 
to 15. Most of the reporting on these topics and KPIs is contained in the Strategic report under the sections 
Business model, Sustainability report and Statement of principal risks and uncertainties or are incorporated 
into the Strategic report by reference from the pages noted. The Group has appropriate policies and 
diligence procedures regarding all the non-financial information presented in this Annual Report.
Section 172 statement
Working together with our stakeholders towards shared goals is part of how we deliver long-term sustainable 
success. Go to page 94 to see more.
The Strategic report on pages 2 to 70 was approved by the Board of Directors and signed on its behalf by:
Geoff Drabble	
	
	
Duncan Cooper
Chair	
	
	
	
Chief Financial Officer
31 March 2025	
	
	
31 March 2025

71
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
GOVERNANCE
Contents
72	
Board of Directors
74	
Corporate governance report
78	
Section 172 statement
81	
Nominations Committee report
84	
Audit Committee report
90	
Directors’ remuneration report
118	
Directors’ report
121	
Directors’ statement of responsibilities

72
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
BOARD OF DIRECTORS
Committee 
membership key:
A
Audit 
N
Nominations
R
Remuneration 
S
Stay Safe
Chair
Geoff Drabble
Chair
Date of appointment to the Board
October 2024
Committee memberships: None
Experience
Geoff has unrivalled leadership experience 
from publicly listed businesses across the 
building materials distribution, equipment hire 
and tools markets nationally and internationally.
He has gained this from both executive and 
non-executive roles, and is currently 
Non-executive Chair of multinational 
plumbing and heating products distributor, 
Ferguson Enterprises Inc. He previously 
served as Non-executive Chair of DS Smith 
plc, Senior Independent Director of Howden 
Joinery Group plc and was CEO of Ashtead 
Group plc during a period of unprecedented 
growth. He has also been Executive Director 
of The Laird Group plc and held a number of 
senior positions at Black & Decker.
External appointments
•	 Ferguson Enterprises Inc (Chair)
Jez Maiden
Senior Independent  
Non-executive Director
Date of appointment to the Board
June 2023
Committee memberships: A
N
Experience
A qualified accountant (FCMA), Jez is a proven 
Senior Independent Director with diverse sector 
experience spanning household FMCG, 
management consultancy, food manufacturing, 
transport and chemicals. He has extensive 
finance and audit, public company and capital 
markets expertise and has held a number of 
Executive Director CFO positions, latterly as 
Group Finance Director for Croda International 
Plc. He has previously served as a Non-executive 
Director at PZ Cussons plc and Synthomer plc 
and is currently a Non-executive Director and 
member of the Audit Committee at Intertek 
Group plc, and has recently been appointed  
as a Non-executive Director, Chair of the Audit 
Committee and a member of the Remuneration 
Committee of Smith & Nephew plc.
External appointments
•	 Centre for Process Innovation Ltd 
(Non-executive Director)
•	 Smith & Nephew plc (Non-executive Director)
•	 Intertek Group plc (Non-executive Director) 
Marianne Culver
Non-executive Director
Date of appointment to the Board
November 2019
Committee memberships: R
S
Experience
Marianne has extensive executive and board 
experience in the global distribution and 
logistics sectors. She has served as Chief, 
Global Supply Chain with Premier Farnell plc 
and as Chief Executive (UK & Ireland) of TNT. 
Marianne was latterly Global President of RS 
Components, (formally Electrocomponents 
plc). 
Her non-executive career to-date has 
included membership of the boards of Rexel 
SA (listed on Euronext Paris), The British 
Quality Foundation and EDS Corporation and 
she is a current member of the Supervisory 
Board of BME B.V.
External appointments
•	 BME B.V (Supervisory Board)
Duncan Cooper
Chief Financial Officer
Date of appointment to the Board
January 2024
Committee memberships: None
Experience
Duncan is a Chartered Accountant and, in 
addition to having a strong finance 
background, has experience in corporate 
communications, strategy design and 
implementation and large-scale technology 
change. Duncan joined the Group from Crest 
Nicholson plc, where he was appointed Chief 
Financial Officer in 2019. 
He formerly worked at J. Sainsbury plc where 
he held multiple roles since 2010, culminating 
in Director of Group Finance. Prior to that 
Duncan held finance roles at BSkyB plc and 
GlaxoSmithKline plc after qualifying at 
Deloitte LLP.

73
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Louise Hardy
Non-executive Director
Date of appointment to the Board
January 2023
Committee memberships: R  N
Experience
Louise brings to the Board over 30 years  
of business and significant leadership 
experience from across the construction  
and infrastructure industry.
A civil engineer by background, Louise has 
held a range of senior roles at London 
Underground, Bechtel and Laing O’Rourke, 
where she was the Infrastructure Director for 
the London 2012 Olympic Park. Her most 
recent executive appointment was European 
Project Excellence Director for AECOM.
Louise remains a keen volunteer within the 
construction industry as a STEM ambassador 
and diversity champion.
External appointments
•	 Crest Nicholson Holdings plc 
(Non-executive Director)
•	 Balfour Beatty plc (Non-executive Director)
•	 Oriel (Chair)
Jora Gill
Non-executive Director
Date of appointment to the Board
August 2021
Committee memberships: 
N
S
A
Experience
Jora has extensive data and digital experience 
having held a number of Chief Information 
Technology Officer and Chief Digital Officer 
roles in significant organisations, including 
Standard and Poors, Elsevier, The Economist, 
and latterly SHL Group Ltd where he served 
as Chief Digital Officer until December 2021.
Jora is now the CEO and co-founder of an  
AI company, Insights Driven. In addition, he 
serves as a Non-executive Director of the 
Phoenix Life Limited, a role he has held since 
June 2023.
External appointments
•	 Insights Driven (CEO)
•	 Phoenix Life Ltd (Non-executive Director)
Heath Drewett
Non-executive Director
Date of appointment to the Board
May 2021
Committee memberships: A
R
Experience
Heath is an experienced CFO and currently 
Chief Financial Officer for Aggreko; a global 
power, temperature control and energy 
services company and constituent of the FTSE 
250, prior to its takeover in August 2021.
He also has extensive experience in the 
engineering, leisure and transportation and 
industrial sectors having previously worked for 
WS Atkins, British Airways, Morgan Advanced 
Materials and PwC. Heath brings a wealth of 
financial and commercial acumen to the Board 
at Travis Perkins based on his experience 
across a number of markets and sectors 
adjacent to the construction industry.
External appointments
•	 Aggreko (Chief Financial Officer)

74
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REPORT
UK Corporate Governance Code
Throughout the year ended 31 December 2024, the 
Company was in compliance with the principles and 
provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code 
2018 issued by the Financial Reporting Council (“the 
Code”) and which is available at www.frc.org.uk, 
subject to the following explanations.
Further explanation in relation to Provision 24 of 
the Code and regarding the role of Jez Maiden as 
both the Interim Chair and as a member of the 
Company’s Audit Committee is provided in the 
Audit Committee report on pages 84 to 89. 
It is a requirement under Provision 12 of the Code 
that one of the independent non-executive directors 
of a company be the Senior Independent Director 
(“SID”). The responsibilities of the Company’s SID 
are described under the “Division of responsibilities 
and meetings” heading below. Jez Maiden was the 
Company’s SID during 2024. When Jez became 
Interim Chair with effect from 31 May 2024 it was 
decided that engagement between the Non-
executive Directors and by the Company with its 
shareholders would not be adversely affected by 
this temporary arrangement, especially given the 
Board’s focus on confirming the plan for permanent 
Chair succession, which it was anticipated would be 
fully resolved within a reasonable period. There was, 
therefore, no appointment of an alternative SID. As 
such, Jez Maiden was the only Director nominated 
as SID during 2024, including during the period 
when he was also Interim Chair.
Under Provision 4 of the Code, when 20% or 
more of votes have been cast against the Board 
recommendation for a resolution, the Company 
should explain, when announcing voting results, 
what actions it intends to take to consult 
shareholders in order to understand the reasons 
behind the result. An update on the views received 
from shareholders and actions taken should 
be published no later than six months after the 
shareholder meeting. The shareholder consultation 
by the Company described in further detail under 
the “Annual General Meeting” heading below was 
conducted substantively within six months of the 
2024 AGM; however, the update on views and 
actions was published on 18 November 2024 which 
was six months and 27 days after the AGM.
Role of the Board
The Board is responsible for considering the 
opportunities and risks relevant to the success of the 
Group and for setting the tone and approach  
to corporate governance.
The Board has a schedule of matters reserved 
to it, which was last reviewed and approved in 
December 2024. The latest approved schedule of 
matters reserved can be found on the Company’s 
website. In line with the Code, the Board has a 
number of Committees to which it delegates certain 
responsibilities: Audit, Nominations, Remuneration 
and Stay Safe. Aligned with the Code the Audit, 
Nominations, and Remuneration Committees all have 
three independent Non-executive members. The 
Committees all have defined terms of reference that 
are available on the Company’s website.
Culture
The Board makes use of a range of insights to 
assist in its understanding of the Group’s culture. 
This enables the Board to monitor the alignment of 
practices and behaviour with Group policy, strategy 
and values. Sources of insight include:
•	 Feedback received informally through visits by 
members of the Board to branches and other sites 
across the Group.
•	 Responses to the Group-wide colleague 
engagement survey (“Your Voice, Our Future”).
•	 Feedback from colleague listening sessions held 
by members of the Board.
•	 Review of issues raised through the Group’s Speak 
Up line.
These insights are useful to the Board in its 
assessment of the extent to which prevailing culture 
in the Group is aligned to the Group’s policy, strategy 
and values.
Engaging with stakeholders and the workforce
Engagement with stakeholder groups such as 
shareholders, customers, suppliers and colleagues 
occurs when formulating the strategic direction 
of the Group. The Board takes the views of its 
stakeholders into account when strategic decisions 
are made. A statement on the ways in which the 
Group meets its duties under s172 of the Companies 
Act 2006 is described in the Section 172 statement 
on pages 78 to 80. This includes detail regarding 
engagement with major shareholders and the 
outcomes influenced by that engagement.
The Board has designated a workforce Non-
executive Director to help bring the colleague voice 
into the boardroom. This role was fulfilled by Louise 
Hardy in 2024. Louise held listening sessions to 
gauge engagement and colleague sentiment.
Conflicts of interest and raising concerns
Declarations of any actual or potential conflicts of 
interest with items on the agenda are requested and 
made at the start of every Board and Committee 
meeting. A register of the Directors’ interests and 
conflicts is maintained by the Company Secretariat. 
Geoff Drabble
Chair
31 March 2025
In this the first Annual Report 
since I was appointed Chair, I am 
pleased to present the Corporate 
governance report for the year 
ending 31 December 2024.

75
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Directors complete an annual questionnaire on 
potential or actual conflicts of interest and their 
activities throughout the year. Any potential conflicts 
are reviewed by the Board as a whole and, if 
necessary, mitigating actions are taken and recorded 
on the register of Directors’ interests and conflicts. 
The impact of any relationships or involvements 
are considered carefully to ensure that they do not 
compromise or override the Directors’ ability to 
exercise independent judgement.
Concerns in relation to the operation of the Board 
can be raised with the Chair or the SID. As part of 
the leadership evolution in 2024, the views of Board 
members were sought by the SID and discussed 
by the Board without the then Chair present, in 
accordance with good governance practice.
During 2024, the Group continued to emphasise 
the importance of “doing the right thing” aligned 
to the Code of Conduct and of “speaking up” 
using the Speak Up line. A number of policies and 
related guidance were updated and communicated. 
Communication included details of how colleagues 
could whistleblow using the Speak Up service 
where they believed that others may not be doing 
the right thing. The Speak Up service is available 
for colleagues and others to raise concerns by 
telephone call or web portal submission regarding 
issues that are inconsistent with its Group’s values 
or otherwise require investigation and attention. The 
Audit Committee, on behalf of the Board, received 
regular reports during 2024 regarding issues raised 
through the Speak Up line and subsequent action 
taken. The Board also reviewed the effectiveness of 
the Speak Up line at its meeting in December 2024.
Board composition and effectiveness
Board changes
Appointments of new Directors are made by the 
Board on the recommendation of the Nominations 
Committee.
There were a number of changes to the Directors 
during 2024. Duncan Cooper took up the position of 
CFO on the Board on 9 January, with Alan Williams 
stepping down from the Board on 23 January. 
Jasmine Whitbread stepped down as Chair from 
the Board on 31 May and at that point Jez Maiden 
became Interim Chair. Nick Roberts stepped down 
from the Board and Pete Redfern took up the post of 
CEO with effect from 16 September and regrettably 
resigned due to ill health on 10 March 2025. I joined 
the Board on 1 October. As at 31 December 2024, the 
Board comprised six Non-executive Directors and two 
Executive Directors. The biographies of the Board as 
at the date of the Annual Report and Accounts are 
listed on pages 72 to 73.
Re-election of Directors
All Directors as at the date of the Annual Report and 
Accounts are considered to be eligible, on the basis 
of their performance and contribution to the long-
term sustainable success of the Company, to submit 
themselves for re-election at the 2025 Annual 
General Meeting.
Board effectiveness review
Consistent with the requirements of the Code, 
evaluation of the performance of the Board and its 
Committees was carried out in 2024 as described 
in the Nominations Committee report on pages 81 
to 83.
Division of responsibilities and meetings
Chair and CEO
The roles of the Chair and CEO are split and the 
Board has approved a written statement of the 
division of key responsibilities between the Chair 
and CEO which was reviewed in December 2024 
and is available on the Company’s website. The 
Chair leads the Board and ensures its effectiveness. 
Jasmine Whitbread and Jez Maiden were 
independent on appointment as Chair/Interim Chair 
and remained so for as long as they held that post. I 
was independent on appointment as Chair.
Non-executive Directors
The Board ensures that at least half of its members, 
excluding the Chair, are independent Non-executives 
and reviews any relationships or circumstances which 
are likely to affect their independence. Provision 10 
of the Code sets out circumstances which are likely 
to impair, or could appear to impair, a Non-executive 
Director’s independence, including where individuals 
hold cross-directorships or have significant links 
with other Directors through involvement in other 
companies or bodies. The Board is satisfied that there 
were no relevant cross-directorships or other links in 
2024 and that none of the circumstances set out in 
provision 10 of the Code currently applies. The Board 
is satisfied, therefore, that all Non-executive Directors 
remain independent.
The Non-executive Directors provide constructive 
challenge, strategic guidance and appraise 
Executive Directors’ performance against agreed 
performance targets, including through the work of 
the Remuneration Committee. The Non-executive 
Directors and Chair meet regularly without the 
Executive Directors present.
A Non-executive Director is appointed as the SID. 
The SID acts as a sounding board for the Chair and 
an intermediary for Directors and shareholders. The 
SID is available to shareholders should they wish to 
raise an issue through an alternative channel. The 
Non-executive Directors led by the SID meet without 
the Chair present annually to discuss the Chair’s 
performance and any other matters as required. The 
details of the responsibilities of the SID are set out in 
writing and are available on the Company’s website. 
Jez Maiden is the Company’s SID and fulfilled the 
foregoing responsibilities during 2024, while also 
serving for part of this period as Interim Chair.
Time commitment
When making new appointments, the Board 
considers the competing demands on candidates’ 
time. Prior to appointment, candidates are required 
to disclose any significant commitments along with 
the estimated associated time commitment. Each 
Non-executive Director’s letter of appointment 
sets out the time commitment expected of them 
and these letters are available for inspection at the 
Annual General Meeting. So far as is practicable, the 
Company liaises with the Non-executive Directors to 
ensure the schedule of meetings does not clash with 
external appointments. Directors are able to attend 
meetings by video or telephone conferencing if there 
is an issue with location or travel.
The Board considers, on an annual basis, the time 
commitments of each Director and it is satisfied 
that all Directors continue to have sufficient time 
available to fulfil their duties. Any new external 
appointments during the year are given careful 
consideration and (if necessary) before consent is 
given, taking into account the number and scale of 
each Director’s other commitments.

76
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REPORT CONTINUED
Subject to approval by the Board, Executive 
Directors are allowed to accept one external non-
executive directorship with a listed entity.
Board and Committee meetings
The Board held nine meetings in 2024, dealing 
with the annual cycle of activity planned in advance 
of the year and other matters arising during its 
course. The format for meetings of the Board in 
2024 was a mix of in person and virtual using video 
conferencing. Regular items on the agenda for 
consideration included:
•	 Detailed updates on financial results and 
performance against related KPIs, in particular 
delivery of the Group’s business improvement 
priorities.
•	 Health and safety policies and performance.
•	 Strategic reviews of the Group as a whole and its 
businesses.
•	 Governance matters, including review of the work 
of the Committees to the Board and the conduct of 
matters reserved to the Board.
•	 New appointments.
Examples of other areas of particular focus in 
certain meetings include:
•	 Review of the outturn trading performance of 
Group in 2023 and the response of the Group to 
the trading conditions prevailing in 2024.
•	 Colleague voice; review of key themes in the feedback 
from the Your Voice our Future engagement survey.
•	 Investor relations; review of feedback received 
from investors in the course of the year and 
discussion of investor relations priorities for 2024.
•	 Sustainability and corporate affairs; review of 
climate-related risks and opportunities, the 
sustainability reporting landscape and the 
roadmap for the Group’s external engagement.
•	 Technology and data enablement; review of the 
delivery of technology enabled business change, 
aligned to the objectives of the Group.
•	 Risk Appetite and Principal Risks; to facilitate the 
calibration of Board risk appetite and including 
coverage of cyber risk preparedness. Group talent 
agenda; review with particular focus on talent and 
succession.
•	 Implementation of Oracle Financials; receiving 
updates ahead of and post “go live”, to monitor  
and support delivery.
•	 Business reviews of specific trading operations 
within the Group.
The Chair meets regularly with Board members 
and with members of the Group Leadership Team 
(“GLT”) between Board meetings and ensures that 
Board members are kept informed of material 
developments. At meetings the Chair encourages 
debate and equal contribution from each Board 
member within a transparent and constructive 
atmosphere. The names of the Directors who served 
on the Board during the year together with the 
number of Board and Committee meetings attended 
by each Director is set out in the following table.
PLC
Board
Audit
Committee
Nominations
Committee
Remuneration
Committee
Stay Safe
Committee
Overall
attendance 
(%)
Number of meetings
9
4
2
3
2
98
Attendance:
D. Cooper
9/9
–
–
–
–
100
M. Culver
9/9
–
–
3/3
2/2
100
G. Drabble1
2/2
–
–
–
–
100
H. Drewett2
8/9
4/4
–
3/3
–
94
J. Gill
9/9
4/4
2/2
–
2/2
100
L. Hardy3
9/9
–
1/1
3/3
–
100
J. Maiden
9/9
4/4
2/2
–
–
100
P. Redfern4
3/3
–
–
–
1/1
100
N. Roberts5
6/6
–
–
–
1/1
100
J. Whitbread6
3/3
–
1/1
2/3
1/1
88
A. Williams7
1/1
–
–
–
–
100
1	
Geoff Drabble joined the Board on 1 October 2024.
2	 Heath Drewett was absent from one Board meeting as a result of a personal emergency.
3	 Louise Hardy joined the Nominations Committee on an interim basis on 30 April 2024.
4	 Pete Redfern joined the Board as CEO on 16 September 2024.
5	 Nick Roberts stood down from the Board on 16 September 2024.
6	 Jasmine Whitbread stood down from the Nominations, Remuneration and Stay Safe Committees on 30 April 2024 and from the Board on 31 May 2024.
7	 Alan Williams stood down from the Board on 23 January 2024.
Group Leadership Team
The Board has delegated responsibility for the 
execution of the Group’s strategy and the day-to-
day management and operation of the Group’s 
business to the CEO. The CEO leads the GLT, which 
comprises key business and functional leaders.
Other colleagues are invited to attend GLT meetings 
from time to time in relation to specific matters. The 
main purpose of the GLT is to assist the Executive 
Directors in the performance of their duties, 
particularly in relation to:
•	 the development and implementation of strategy, 
operational plans, policies, procedures and 
budgets;
•	 the monitoring of operational and financial 
performance;
•	 the assessment of control of risk; and
•	 the prioritisation and allocation of resources.

77
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Provision of information and support
All Directors have direct access to the General 
Counsel & Company Secretary who is responsible 
for advising the Board on all governance matters. 
Directors may also seek independent professional 
advice at the Company’s expense in the furtherance 
of their duties as required.
Annual General Meeting
On 22 April 2024 the Company welcomed 
shareholders, their proxies and corporate 
representatives to the Annual General Meeting held 
in person at the London offices of Linklaters. All 
Directors were present and available for questions.
Support was received from shareholders, including 
those casting votes by proxy, sufficient to pass all of 
the resolutions put to the meeting, with an average 
of 92% of votes in favour of each resolution. Less 
than 80% support was received for two resolutions; 
79.06% of votes cast were in favour of resolution 3 
and 76.41% of votes cast were in favour of resolution 
12. The details of those resolutions were:
•	 Resolution 3: To receive and approve the Directors’ 
remuneration policy, which is contained in the 
Directors’ remuneration report as set out on 
pages 96-101 of the Annual Report and Accounts 
for the financial year ended 31 December 2023 
which will take effect from the date of its approval.
•	 Resolution 12: To re-elect Jasmine Whitbread as  
a Director of the Company.
In line with its responsibilities under the Code (where a 
resolution receives a more than 20% vote against), the 
Board consulted with shareholders to understand the 
reasons behind these votes. In respect of resolution 12, 
the then Chair and the SID held a number of meetings 
with shareholders during March and April 2024, and 
Jasmine Whitbread stepped down from the Board 
on 31 May 2024. Jez Maiden became Interim Chair 
and led the process to appoint both a new CEO and 
a permanent Chair, seeking input from shareholders 
on the characteristics that they would wish to see in 
the new appointments. This process was concluded in 
July 2024. Regarding resolution 3, following the AGM, 
Louise Hardy, Chair of the Remuneration Committee, 
sought further input from shareholders, which, together 
with previously articulated shareholder positions, 
has enabled the Company to better understand the 
rationale behind most of the voting which did not 
support resolution 3. A consistent theme of a lack of 
support for elements of the Company’s Restricted 
Share Plan (“RSP”) in the context of underlying 
performance.
Immediately following the shareholder consultation, 
against the backdrop of 88.02% shareholder 
support when the RSP was adopted, the Company 
did not believe an immediate change to its long-
term incentives was appropriate. However, as noted 
at pages 90 to 91 of the Directors’ remuneration 
report, the Company continued to keep the efficacy 
of its Directors’ Remuneration Policy under review; 
including, in particular, whether the RSP remained 
the best vehicle through which to provide long-term 
incentive to the relatively new executive team and 
to support the Group with the retention of executive 
talent through a period of business turnaround. 
The Board looks forward to welcoming shareholders, 
their proxies and corporate representatives who 
wish to attend the 2025 Annual General Meeting of 
the Company in person. The shareholder appetite 
for online broadcast of the Annual General Meeting 
appears to remain low and it has been decided that 
there will be no broadcast of the Annual General 
Meeting this year in order to use shareholders funds 
appropriately by avoiding unnecessary expenditure. 
Shareholder demand for remote participation will be 
kept under review and will inform the approach to 
arrangements for future Annual General Meetings.
Statement by the Board
A review of the performance of the Group’s 
businesses and the financial position of the Group 
is included in the Strategic report on pages 8 to 
25. The Board uses it to present a full assessment 
of the Group’s position and prospects, its business 
model and its strategy for delivering that model. 
The Directors’ statement of responsibilities for the 
financial statements are described on page 121.
Going concern
After reviewing the Group’s forecasts and risk 
assessments and making other enquiries, the Board 
has formed the judgement at the time of approving 
the financial statements that there is a reasonable 
expectation that the Company has adequate 
resources to continue in operational existence for 
the 12 months from the date of signing this Annual 
Report and Accounts. For this reason the Board 
continues to adopt the going concern basis in 
preparing the financial statements.
In arriving at their opinion the Directors considered:
•	 The Group’s cash flow forecasts and revenue 
projections.
•	 The impact on trading performance of severe but 
plausible downside scenarios. Key assumptions 
include significant reductions in revenue removal 
of property profits and limited reductions in fixed 
overheads, as well as mitigating actions such as 
delayed capital expenditure and dividend 
suspension.
•	 The committed debt facilities available to the 
Group and the covenants thereon.
•	 The Group’s debt maturity profile and investment 
credit ratings.
•	 The Group’s robust policy on liquidity and cash 
flow management.
•	 The Group’s ability to successfully manage the 
principal risks and uncertainties outlined on pages 
59-69 during periods of uncertain economic 
outlook and challenging macroeconomic conditions.
The downside scenarios tested, outlining the impact 
of severe but plausible adverse scenarios based on 
a severe recession and housing market weakness, 
show that there is sufficient headroom for liquidity 
and covenant compliance purposes for at least the 
next 12 months from the date of approval of these 
financial statements.
The Board’s fair, balanced and 
understandable declaration
At the Board meeting during which the Group’s 
results for the year were presented, the Board 
considered whether the Annual Report and 
Accounts, when taken as a whole, present a fair, 
balanced and understandable overview of the 
Group and its performance. After hearing from the 
CFO, receiving a report from the Audit Committee 
Chair on that Committee’s meeting to review the 
preparation and content of the year-end financial 
statements and the audit conducted upon them, 
and reviewing the content of the Annual Report 
and Accounts, the Board concluded that the 
Annual Report and Accounts are fair, balanced 
and understandable and accordingly the Directors’ 
declaration to that effect can be found under the 
Directors’ statement of responsibilities on page 121.
Effectiveness of the system of internal control 
and risk management
In conjunction with the Audit Committee and in a 
process that accords with the Financial Reporting 
Council guidance on Risk Management, Internal 
Control and Related Financial and Business 
Reporting, the Board has carried out an annual review 
of the overall effectiveness of the system of internal 
control and risk management during the year and 
up to the date of approval of the Annual Report and 
Accounts, and concluded that these systems are 
effective. A further description of this work is set out 
in the Audit Committee report on page 87.
Geoff Drabble
Chair
31 March 2025

78
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SECTION 172 STATEMENT
The Group has taken into consideration the interests of key stakeholders and the success of 
the Company for the benefit of its members as a whole, in line with Section 172(1) (a) to (f) of 
the Companies Act 2006 (“s172”). This s172 statement explains how:
•	 the Directors have taken into consideration the interests of members as a whole in key decision-making; and
•	 the Group, including the Directors, has engaged with stakeholders.
s172 requires Directors to have regard (amongst other matters) to:
a.	The likely consequences of any decision in the long-term;
b.	The interests of the Company’s employees;
c.	The need to foster the Company’s business relationships with suppliers, customers and others;
d.	The impact of the Company’s operations on the community and the environment;
e.	The desirability of the Company maintaining a reputation for high standards of business conduct; and
f.	 The need to act fairly as between members of the Company.
For example and as set out below, the Board had particular regard to the requirements of s172 (amongst 
the other requirements of s172 and other matters more generally) in connection with the decision to close 
Toolstation France. 
Key Board decision
Key requirements
Closure of Toolstation France – The Board reviewed and ultimately approved the closure of Toolstation 
France.
The Board first approved an internal engagement with the Works Council and colleagues, the results of 
which informed the decision to communicate externally in March 2024 the strategic plan to review 
options for Toolstation France. 
Engagement with, and support for, colleagues, suppliers and other stakeholders impacted by the 
potential change was maintained throughout the review process, the outcome of which was reported 
regularly to the Board. In response to the review the Board confirmed the decision to close Toolstation 
France, to include the sale of stores as a going concern where this would be feasible and not detrimental 
to the interests of the Company’s shareholders.
Eight Toolstation France stores were sold as a going concern as part of the subsequent closure process, 
securing jobs for 10% of the colleagues impacted.
The operation closed by the end of 2024 and is presented as a discontinued operation.
Likely consequences of decision in the long term
The Board based its decision on a consideration of the likely long-term consequences of either extending into the longer 
term the Group’s investment in the Toolstation France business or ending its investment in 2024.
Interests of colleagues
The Board had regard to the impact of decisions on colleagues, informed by its understanding of the local consultation process 
described in the preceding column.
Need to foster business relationships
In a similar way to which it had regard for the impact on colleagues, the Board had awareness of how the closure would affect 
relationships with local suppliers and customers.
Impact of operations on the community and the environment
The Board’s regard to the impact of the closure of operations and resulting redundancies on colleagues included consideration of 
the positive feedback from the Works Council on the suitability of the post-redundancy support package for ex-colleagues. By 
reason of this, the Board’s regard included the impact on people post-closure as members of the community.
Desirability of maintaining a reputation for high standards of business conduct
The Board assured that the process connected with the review and decision to close was conducted in compliance with local 
legislation throughout the process.
Need to act fairly as between members of the Company
The best interests of the Company’s shareholders, and by implication the need to act fairly as between them, were key to the 
Board’s decision making regarding the closure of Toolstation France.

79
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Relevant issues, factors and stakeholders
The Group’s Strategy and ESG framework take into account key macro factors and challenges (pages 60 and 61), growth drivers (page 10) and double materiality assessment results (page 27), and have been formed through 
expert teams and in-depth consultation with key stakeholder groups. 
Stakeholder engagement and key issues
Building positive stakeholder relationships through engagement, collaboration and dialogue is important to the Group. Working together with its stakeholders towards shared goals assists the Group in delivering long-term 
sustainable success. The Group comprises a number of businesses and stakeholder engagement takes place both at a Group level and also within each business as each has its own unique stakeholders. Details of key 
stakeholders and how the Group engages with them are set out below.
Stakeholder type
How the Group engages with them
Key ESG issues
Shareholders
The Group relies on the support of shareholders and places importance on their opinions. The Group wants to enable shareholders to have an in-depth understanding of strategy 
and operational and financial performance, so they can accurately assess the value of their shares in the Company. The Group has an open dialogue with shareholders through 
one-to-one meetings, group meetings, and the Annual General Meeting. Discussions with shareholders cover a wide range of topics including financial performance, strategy, 
outlook, governance and ethical practices. Shareholder feedback along with details of movements in the shareholder base are reported to and discussed by the Board and their 
views are considered as part of decision-making.
The Group’s Chair and management team undertook 163 investor interactions during 2024, including attendance at nine investment bank conferences and organising two North 
American roadshows. The management team recognises the benefits of virtual meetings with regard to efficiency and reaching a wide investor base but remains focused on 
in-person meetings as it is their belief that this facilitates better quality conversation and helps to build long-term relationships with shareholders. In 2024, over two-thirds of all 
investor interactions were in-person, this figure rising to over 80% with UK-based investors.
Carbon
Supply chain
Governance
Customers
The success of the Group, both historically and into the future is dependent on the ability to understand and meet the needs of customers. The Group continues to invest in data 
capability to bring a greater level of understanding to the behaviour of customers and when combined with the time spent discussing their needs and perceptions this produces a 
significant amount of insight which is used to guide action. Taking a long-term view of customer needs has allowed different business units to begin to develop and deploy a range 
of services which are designed to go above and beyond the traditional model of the straight supply of materials. By looking forward and seeking to understand the potential range 
of impacts which may affect the business of our customers in the future we are able to assist in the development of solutions to bring mutual value, enabling, for example, 
customers to work with changing environmental planning legislation to construct houses that meet current and future standards. Many of these examples are shared under 
“Modernising construction” on pages 30-31. The Group’s businesses ran customer surveys and the ESG team engaged with over 120 customers in 2024.
Carbon
Sustainable products
Responsible sourcing
Social value
Packaging
Colleagues
People are key to the Group’s success and it is important that they are successful individually and as a team. The Group aims to build a fully inclusive environment where treating 
each other with respect and encouraging everyone to be themselves is at the heart of the Group’s values. The Group works hard to engage with and listen to colleagues in a 
variety of ways. A Group-wide engagement survey in 2024 was sent to 16,000 colleagues with a participation rate of 80%, representing the views of almost 13,000 colleagues. 
The engagement survey included detailed questions around safety, belonging, equal opportunity, customer focus and corporate citizenship. Group diversity and inclusion networks 
with GLT sponsorship and the Diversity and Inclusion Advisory Board continued to drive the Group’s agenda to retain a diverse pipeline of colleagues, enable a high-performance 
culture, develop inclusive leaders and positively impact a generation of young people.
ESG training sessions were delivered across a number of teams at Group and within the businesses by the Group Sustainability team and an ESG module is included in all apprenticeships.
The role of the designated workforce Non-executive Director is to help bring the colleague voice into the boardroom. This role was fulfilled by Louise Hardy in 2024. Louise held 
listening sessions to gauge engagement and colleague sentiment.
Safety and Wellbeing
Reward
Skills
Diversity, Equity and Inclusion
Carbon

80
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
SECTION 172 CONTINUED
Stakeholder type
How the Group engages with them
Key ESG issues
Suppliers
The Group’s suppliers are experts in the wide range of products sourced from them. Macro factors such as the increasing relevance of ESG and sector-specific changes seen in 
the development of modern methods of construction are raising expectations from customers and creating opportunities. The Group aims to build strong supplier relationships 
and develop mutually beneficial, lasting partnerships that meet these expectations and seize these opportunities. Engagement with suppliers is primarily through a series of 
interactions and formal reviews. In 2024, the businesses engaged proactively with suppliers in connection with the launch of Oracle Financials to enhance product data and to 
work together to manage and overcome challenges. The Group’s businesses also host conferences to bring suppliers and customers together to discuss shared goals and build 
relationships. 60 suppliers were supported by the Group sustainability team during 2024. The Board recognises that relationships with suppliers are important to the Group’s 
long-term success and is briefed on supplier feedback and issues on a regular basis.
Carbon
Responsible sourcing (including QA)
Sustainable products
Packaging
Safety
Modern slavery
Communities and 
the environment
Investing in sustainable growth means supporting the communities in which the Group operates. By ensuring a positive contribution, the Group can help its communities and 
strengthen the business. Colleagues engage with the communities the Group operates in, building trust and understanding local issues. Key areas of focus include how the Group 
can support local causes and issues; create opportunities to recruit and develop local people; and help to look after the environment. In 2024, work continued towards the 
long-term target for people development for 10,000 people to successfully complete apprenticeships by 2030 (delivered both for the Group’s own colleagues and those in the 
wider industry). The Group’s businesses partner with local charities and organisations at a local level to raise awareness and funds. The Group’s impact on the environment is a 
key focus for the Board. During 2024, progress was made towards the Group’s targets for buildings and fleet (Scope 1 and 2) and for the supply chain (Scope 3). Further 
information is available in the Sustainability report on pages 26 to 58.
Carbon
Sustainable products
Safety
Quality
Skills
Responsible sourcing
Government and 
regulations
The regulatory environment significantly impacts the success of the business. The Group believes it is important that those who can influence policy, law and regulation 
understand its views, sharing information and perspectives on areas that impact the Group’s businesses. Engagement with the government and regulators takes place through a 
range of industry consultations, forums, meetings and conferences to communicate views to policy-makers relevant to the Group’s sectors and businesses. Key areas of focus 
during 2024 were around a national retrofit strategy, Future Homes Standard, decarbonisation of specialist fleets, the skills gap and health and safety. The Board is updated on 
legal and regulatory developments and takes these into account when considering future actions.
Fleet decarbonisation
Retrofit
Future Homes Standard
Skills
Governance
Trade and 
professional 
bodies
The Group collaborates with trade and professional bodies to raise awareness, share best practices and to move forward together as an industry on shared opportunities, issues 
and challenges. For example, the Group sits on the Builders Merchant Federation Board and each of its industry working groups. The Group is a CO2nstructZero Business 
Champion, the Construction Leadership Council’s framework for net zero in the construction industry. The Group is represented in the National Retrofit Hub, Future Homes Hub, 
Logistics UK, Builders Merchant Federation, Supply Chain Sustainability School and other forums relevant to the Group’s material risks and opportunities.
The Group is a founding member of The Construction Inclusion Coalition, which has been established to raise sector standards on equity, diversity and inclusion.
Net Zero new build and retrofit
Skills
Safety
Diversity, Equity and Inclusion.
Delegated decision-making
The Group’s governance framework delegates authority for local decision-making to each of its businesses, up to defined levels of cost and impact, which allows the businesses to take account of the needs of their own 
stakeholders in their decision-making. The leadership teams of each business make decisions with a long-term view and with the highest standards of conduct in line with Group policies. In order to fulfil their duties, the directors 
of each business and of the Group itself take care to have regard to the likely consequences on all stakeholders of the decisions and actions which they take. Where possible, decisions are carefully discussed with affected 
groups and are therefore fully understood and supported when taken.

81
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
NOMINATIONS COMMITTEE REPORT
Dear shareholder
In April 2024 the Board asked me, as Senior 
Independent Director, to step into the role of 
Interim Chair of Travis Perkins plc, following 
Jasmine Whitbread’s decision to step down. 
As a result, I have also led the Nominations 
Committee of the Board and am pleased to 
present to you the Committee’s report on its 
activities during 2024. 
A key role of the Committee is to ensure that there is 
a rigorous and transparent process for appointments 
to the Board. In 2024, the Committee was asked 
by the Board to recommend a new CEO to lead 
the management of the Group and to identify 
a new permanent Chair. To run both processes 
simultaneously to deliver an effective outcome was 
a demanding brief for the Committee. I would like to 
take this opportunity to thank my fellow Committee 
members, Louise Hardy and Jora Gill, for their 
unstinting commitment and support throughout this 
vital process, together with the support of the rest of 
the Board in enabling the timely appointment of the 
selected candidates.
Following a difficult year in 2023 in which earnings 
were notably lower, the Board recognised the under 
performance of the business and that it was the right 
time to search for a new CEO to replace Nick Roberts 
and take the business forward. The Committee 
began an externally facilitated search process to 
identify a new CEO, with a focus on operational 
strength, margin management and cash generation 
from a candidate with proven success in delivering 
shareholder returns. We reviewed an extensive range 
of candidates, interviewed many and selected Pete 
Redfern who joined the business in September, but 
who unfortunately had to stand down in March 2025 
due to ill health.
As noted in the Governance Report, Jasmine 
stepped down from the Board and as Chair on 
31 May 2024. Reflecting input from a number of 
shareholders, the Committee launched a further 
externally facilitated search process to identify a new 
permanent Chair. This process ran in parallel with the 
CEO search, allowing the Committee to assess the 
complementary skills of candidates for the two roles 
and enabling the preferred candidates for these two 
key roles to meet and explore their future relationship 
prior to appointment. The result of the Chair search 
was announced alongside the CEO appointment 
in July, with Geoff Drabble appointed as a Non-
executive Director and Chair Designate from October. 
Geoff took over from me as Chair on 1 February 
2025, following a period of onboarding, and he will 
also assume the role of Chair of the Nominations 
Committee from me following publication of this 
report.
Geoff was CEO of the international plant hire 
company Ashtead plc for 13 years, a Non-executive 
Director of Howden Joinery Group plc for eight years 
and is the current Chair of Ferguson plc, the buildings 
materials distribution business listed on the New York 
and London Stock Exchanges, and which primarily 
operates in North America. Geoff’s experience 
of public companies operating in our markets is 
unrivalled. 
During 2024, we also completed the appointment 
of a third key role, with Duncan Cooper taking over 
in January as the Group’s Chief Financial Officer, 
following Alan Williams’ decision to retire, as set out 
in last year’s Committee report. The Committee is 
pleased that Duncan has hit the ground running, with 
a smooth transition from one CFO to another. 
Process for Board appointments
These recent Board appointments followed the 
Committee’s previously defined approach. This sets 
out a rigorous selection process, with appointments 
made on merit and against an agreed set of specific 
and objective criteria. The Committee oversees this 
process on behalf of the Board and advises the Board 
on the identification, assessment and selection of 
candidates. The appointment process includes:
1.	 Agreeing the key skills, attributes and business 
experience required for the role as well as 
diversity priorities.
2.	Preparing a role description.
3.	Engaging independent search consultants.
4.	Conducting a market search via the search 
consultants.
5.	Preparing a “long list” of candidates, taking 
into account diversity considerations and 
the Committee’s review of the composition, 
experience and skill-sets of the Board.
6.	Selecting a shortlist which meets the 
Committee’s criteria.
7.	 Candidate interviews and assessments.
8.	Making a recommendation to the Board, following 
detailed references. 
9.	Appointees are provided with a programme of 
induction meetings and visits with key personnel 
to each business within the Group.
During the year, the Committee used the services of 
Russell Reynolds. Other than the use of their services 
in search assignments and advising on succession 
planning, the Directors have no connection with 
Russell Reynolds. 
Jez Maiden
Chair, Nominations Committee
31 March 2025
2024 focus area
•	 Delivering effective change at Board level
•	 Chair and CEO appointments
Number of meetings during 2024
2

82
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
NOMINATIONS COMMITTEE REPORT CONTINUED
Committee membership
With the change in Chair role announced in April 
2024, Louise Hardy was appointed to the Nominations 
Committee on an interim basis to ensure that the 
Committee could continue to function effectively and 
to support the critical Board appointment processes.
Board diversity policy
Another key role of the Committee is to promote and 
set targets for appropriate ethnic and gender diversity 
at Board and senior management levels. Disclosure 
Guidance and Transparency Rule (“DTR”) 7.2.8AR 
requires disclosure of the diversity policy applied to 
a board and its remuneration, audit and nomination 
committees. It has always been the Company’s 
approach to seek diversity in all senses, including 
age, gender, ethnic and social backgrounds, sexual 
orientation, disability and experience and to foster a 
culture of inclusion. That remains our approach in all 
the activities of the Board and its Committees. In light 
of DTR 7.2.8AR, the Board has approved and adopted 
a formal diversity policy which can be found in the 
Governance section on the Company’s website.
The FTSE Women Leaders Review (“FWLR”) 
recommends that boards should comprise 40% 
female directors, with a female in at least one of 
the roles of Chair, SID CEO or CFO, and that, by the 
end of 2025, 40% of the leadership team (executive 
committee or its equivalent) and its direct reports 
should be female. As previously mentioned, the 
Board underwent significant change in 2024, such 
that, at the end of the year, two Directors out of eight 
were female (25%) and, following the resignation 
of Jasmine Whitbread, none of the four key Board 
positions identified by the FWLR was occupied by a 
female. Accordingly, the Company does not meet the 
currently applicable recommendations of the FWLR.
Whilst the Board supports the aim of the FWLR 
to promote greater gender diversity on boards 
and amongst companies’ executive and senior 
management teams, the Committee and the Board 
have had to manage a dynamic set of circumstances 
this year. Although the Committee included a focus 
on gender balance in the searches conducted and 
in the appointments which have been made during 
the year, the Committee and the Board have been 
guided by the overarching principle of appointing 
the most suitable individuals with experience best 
suited for the roles, irrespective of gender. During 
2024 the Committee was necessarily focused on 
Board changes. The Committee plans to review 
opportunities to improve Board gender diversity 
during 2025 as part of its commitment to be FWLR 
compliant once Geoff Drabble has assumed the role 
of Chair of the Committee and its membership has 
stabilised.
Full details of the Group’s gender diversity are set out 
at page 38 in the Sustainability report. The gender 
split amongst the executive committee and its direct 
senior management reports is 70% male and 30% 
female. In order to achieve the 40% target in 2025 
(and assuming typical employee turnover) we would 
require the majority of the senior management hires 
this coming year to be female. Given the limited 
female representation in our industry, this may not 
be achieved. We continue to maintain our focus on 
improving gender balance in the leadership team.
The Parker Review (on ethnic diversity) has 
recommended that, by 2024, FTSE 250 companies 
should have at least one director who identifies 
as minority ethnic. At the end of the year and at 
the date of this report, the Board has met that 
recommendation. In its latest report, the Parker 
Review recommended that listed companies should 
set targets to be met by 2027 for ethnic diversity in leadership teams (executive committees and their direct 
reports) and that from December 2024 onwards, listed companies should report on their progress towards 
those targets. Our current ethnic diversity amongst our leadership team is low with 96% from white ethnic 
backgrounds and 4% from Asian ethnic backgrounds (excludes prefer not to say/unable to disclose/do not 
know). We remain committed to improving ethnic diversity across the Group and the target we have set 
ourselves to be achieved by the end of 2027 is 7% of the leadership team from minority ethnic backgrounds. In 
the context of diversity within our industry, we believe that to be a realistic but stretching target.
The disclosures required to be made by Listing Rule 6.6.6R(10) are set out above. The following table is 
included in compliance with Listing Rule 6.6.6R(10) in the format prescribed by that rule and set out in Listing 
Rule 6 Annex 1:
Gender identity or sex (at 31 December 2024)
Area
No. of Board 
members
% of the 
Board
No. of senior  
positions on the Board
No. in executive 
management
% of executive 
management
Men
6
75
4
4
66.7
Women
2
25
–
2
33.3
Not specified/prefer not to say
–
–
–
–
–
Ethnic background (at 31 December 2024)
Area
No. of Board 
members
% of the 
Board
No. of senior  
positions on the Board
No. in executive 
management
% of executive 
management
White British/Other White 
(including Minority White 
groups)
7
87.5
4
6
100
Mixed/multiple ethnic groups
–
–
–
–
–
Asian/Asian British
1
12.5
–
–
–
Black/African/Caribbean/
Black British
–
–
–
–
–
Other ethnic groups, including 
Arab
–
–
–
–
–
Not specified/prefer not to say
–
–
–
–
–

83
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Board effectiveness review
This year’s Board effectiveness review was conducted 
in-house with the process facilitated by the Company 
Secretary. Using a combination of questionnaires 
and discussion, the effectiveness of the Board and 
its Committees was assessed. Notwithstanding the 
level of change experienced during the year, the 
Board and its Committees were found to be operating 
effectively, with an effectiveness level of 70%, albeit 
this was lower than the prior year, unsurprising given 
the significant challenges faced in 2024. The Interim 
Chair received feedback on his performance in his 
temporary role.
In 2024, assessed against its existing skills matrix, the 
Board improved its skills and capability balance, with 
stronger industry, building distribution and customer 
experience, secured through key appointments. In 
light of the challenging market environment, together 
with company-specific weakness experienced in 
the second half of 2023 and into 2024, the Board 
focused its time on a limited number of business 
improvement initiatives, with a reduced focus on 
long-term strategic initiatives. These improvement 
initiatives included stabilising short-term profit 
performance, particularly in the general merchant, 
overhead cost reduction, improved cash generation, 
addressing loss-making operations and delivering 
leadership change. I would like to thank Nick Roberts 
for supporting me in this work prior to his stepping 
down as CEO in September 2024. 
This is reflected in progress against the four focus 
areas identified from the 2023 Board effectiveness 
review, as follows:
Focus area
Progress
Continuing focus on the balance of constructive challenge and support between the 
Non-executive Directors and the Executive as relationships between Directors become 
better established.
The focus on a limited number of improvement initiatives and the process to change 
leadership helped the Board to better challenge and support executive management in 
delivering change and beginning to stabilise performance. With the recent 
appointments, the Board is establishing stronger relationships between Directors and 
this will remain a focus in 2025.
Improving the feedback loop with the Board regarding actioning within the business of 
issues raised by the Board.
More targeted actions and initiatives, supported by clearer KPIs, enabled the Board to 
better monitor and advise on business issues. Continued work on this area is 
anticipated in 2025.
Continuing to improve risk management processes, in particular, the articulation of the 
Board’s risk appetite to the business.
Further improvement to an already robust risk management framework was achieved, 
better linking risk appetite to the Group’s principal risks and ensuring that risk 
management is pragmatic and appropriate.
Achieving an appropriate balance of focus between short-term performance 
improvement and long-term strategic success.
Inevitably, 2024 saw a focus on short-term performance management and remedial 
action, initially reacting to performance issues and then becoming more proactive as 
work plans and progress were delivered. Under new leadership, 2025 will see a 
progressive move to a more strategic approach.
2025 focus areas
Based on the 2024 Board effectiveness review and reflecting key changes in leadership, the Board has identified the following focus areas for 2025:
•	 CEO recruitment.
•	 Development of a new strategy and a focus on medium-term success.
•	 Rebuilding, supporting and constructively challenging the Executive in improving shorter term performance.
•	 Managed Board and Executive succession planning.
•	 Improving the identification and understanding of the key drivers of success and the KPIs to manage these.
I will be available at the AGM to answer any questions on the work of the Nominations Committee in 2024.
Jez Maiden
Chair, Nominations Committee
31 March 2025

84
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
AUDIT COMMITTEE REPORT
Dear shareholder
I am pleased to present the Audit 
Committee’s report for the year ended 
31 December 2024. The report sets out 
the Audit Committee’s work in relation 
to financial reporting, internal audit, risk 
management and oversight of the external 
audit process.
I will be available at the Annual General Meeting to 
answer any questions about the work of the Audit 
Committee.
Audit Committee membership and 
attendance
The members of the Audit Committee for the year 
ended 31 December 2024 have been:
•	 Heath Drewett
•	 Jora Gill
•	 Jez Maiden 
All members are independent Non-executive Directors. 
In accordance with provision 24 of the UK Corporate 
Governance Code (“the Code”), at any time at least 
two of the members have recent and relevant financial 
experience and all members have competencies 
relevant to the Company’s sector, gained through a 
variety of corporate and professional appointments 
(see biographies on pages 72 to 73).
It is also required under Provision 24 of the Code 
that the chair of a company’s board should not 
be a member of that company’s audit committee. 
Jez Maiden is a member of the Company’s Audit 
Committee. Jez became Interim Chair with effect 
from 31 May 2024. It was decided that it would be in 
the best interests of the Company for there to be no 
immediate resulting change to the membership of the 
Audit Committee, given the continuing value of Jez’s 
experience and competency to the work of the Audit 
Committee, combined with the Board’s focus on 
confirming the plan for permanent Chair succession, 
with it being subsequently confirmed that the role of 
Chair was intended to pass to Geoff Drabble once his 
capacity allowed, which it was reasonably anticipated 
would resolve the issue by early 2025. As such Jez 
Maiden was present at two meetings of the Audit 
Committee in 2024 while also Interim Chair.
The Audit Committee held four meetings in 2024. 
Attendance of members at the Audit Committee’s 
meetings during the year can be found in the 
Corporate governance report on page 76. The 
following, and when appropriate those deputising 
for them, were also invited to attend the Audit 
Committee’s meetings in 2024:
•	 Chair of the Board (including Chair designate) 
•	 Chief Executive Officer
•	 Chief Financial Officer
•	 General Counsel & Company Secretary
•	 Director of Group Finance
•	 Group Financial Controller
•	 Director of Internal Audit & Risk
•	 On behalf of the Group’s auditor, the lead audit 
partner and other audit team members
From time to time Non-executive Directors who are 
not members of the Audit Committee may be invited 
to attend meetings of the Audit Committee where this 
will facilitate a richer discussion and avoid potential 
inefficiencies in repeating a review of matters at both 
an Audit Committee and a Board meeting. In 2024 
other Non-executive Directors were invited to attend 
the meeting in February on this basis for, among other 
reasons, the review of principal and emerging risks.
The Group’s Director of Legal Services & Deputy 
Company Secretary is the Secretary to the Audit 
Committee, as nominee of the General Counsel & 
Company Secretary.
The Audit Committee met separately with the 
Director of Internal Audit & Risk (and her deputies 
when appropriate) and with representatives of the 
external auditor without members of management in 
attendance. The Audit Committee also met separately 
with management but without representatives of 
external auditor in attendance.
Role of the Audit Committee
The Audit Committee assists the Board in fulfilling 
its oversight responsibilities. The main roles and 
responsibilities of the Audit Committee include:
•	 Monitoring the integrity of the financial statements 
of the Company and any formal announcements 
relating to the Company’s financial performance, 
which includes reviewing significant financial 
reporting judgements contained therein.
•	 Reviewing the effectiveness of the Company’s 
internal financial controls and internal control and risk 
management systems.
•	 Monitoring and reviewing the effectiveness of the 
Company’s Internal Audit function.
•	 Maintaining an appropriate relationship with the 
Company’s external auditor and reviewing and 
monitoring its independence, objectivity and 
effectiveness in carrying out the audit process, 
taking into account relevant professional and 
regulatory requirements and ethical guidance.
Heath Drewett
Chair, Audit Committee
31 March 2025
2024 focus areas
•	 Monitoring the integrity of financial 
statements and other external financial 
announcements
•	 Assessment of effectiveness and maturity  
of risk management and internal control
•	 Assurance in connection with the Group’s 
finance modernisation programme
•	 The external audit tender process
Number of meetings during 2024
4

85
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Work of the Audit Committee
In carrying out the activities referred to above, 
the Audit Committee places reliance on regular 
reports from management, the Company’s Internal 
Audit function and the external auditor. The Audit 
Committee is satisfied that it received sufficient, 
timely and reliable information to enable it to fulfil its 
responsibilities during the year.
The Audit Committee’s performance evaluation has 
been conducted as part of the Board Effectiveness 
Review, as described in the Nominations Committee 
report on pages 81 to 83, which found the Audit 
Committee to be operating effectively.
The Audit Committee conducts an annual agenda of 
business covering financial reporting, external audit 
activity, internal controls, risk management, internal 
audit activity and other specific items as required. 
This agenda is reviewed regularly by the Audit 
Committee to ensure that it reflects the priorities of 
the Company and continues to include all matters 
for which consideration must be given in order to 
meet the Audit Committee’s corporate governance 
responsibilities. Details of the main matters covered 
in the business of the Audit Committee at each of its 
meetings in 2024 are as follows:
Q1 (February 2024)
Q2 (May 2024)
Q3 (July 2024)
Q4 (November 2024)
•	 Year-end accounting for 2023*
•	 External audit report for 2023
•	 Review of internal controls
•	 Review of principal and emerging risks
•	 The content of the 2023 Annual Report 
and Accounts and the associated press 
release
•	 External audit plan including half-year 
strategy
•	 Progress reports on information 
security initiatives
•	 Review of performance and 
effectiveness of external auditors
•	 Half-year accounting for 2024*
•	 External audit report including auditor 
quality control and independence
•	 Review of principal and emerging risks
•	 External auditors report including 
progress against plan for 2024 audit 
and findings
•	 Updates regarding the status of annual 
impairment testing and other significant 
accounting matters
•	 Effectiveness assessment of Internal 
Audit and reapproval of Internal Audit 
charter
•	 Approval of Internal Audit plan for 2025
•	 Cyber security update
•	 Review of the Audit Committee terms 
of reference
•	 The recommendation to the Board 
following tender of the external audit
In addition to the above specific matters, the Audit Committee considered at each of its meetings in 2024 the following standing agenda items:
•	 Review of non-audit fees
•	 Review of progress reports concerning the Internal Audit Plan for 2024, including approving additions and deferrals proposed
•	 Review of internal audit reports, including progress on implementing recommendations arising from internal audit work
•	 Review of reports on activity within the relevant period by the Group’s Operational Compliance Support teams
•	 Review of updates regarding Oracle Financials, focused in the first three meetings of the year on assurance activity in the lead up to full delivery of the system and in the 
fourth meeting on progress following go-live in relation to financial reporting
•	 Review of reports regarding matters disclosed to the Group’s Speak Up hotline in the first three meetings of the year; the final quarterly report was made to the Board in 
December 2024
*	
In considering accounting for both the year-end and the half year, in discharging its financial reporting responsibilities, the Audit Committee has special regard for accounting policies and compliance with accounting standards, going 
concern and viability assumptions, and significant financial reporting estimates and judgements made during the preparation of the Group’s annual and interim accounts.
The Board is updated on key matters and recommendations following each Audit Committee meeting.

86
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
AUDIT COMMITTEE REPORT CONTINUED
Significant issues related to the financial statements
The Audit Committee has assessed whether suitable accounting policies have been adopted by the Group and whether management has made appropriate judgements and estimates. The table below sets out the key 
judgement areas associated with the Group’s financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2024 that were considered by the Audit Committee. This is not a complete list of all issues of accounting, estimation and policy 
considered, but includes those which the Audit Committee believes are the most significant. Regarding such issues the Audit Committee considered papers and explanations given by management, discussed each matter in 
detail, challenged assumptions and judgements made and sought clarification where necessary. It reviewed and discussed any internal audit reports in respect of the matters under consideration and the Audit Committee also 
reviewed a report from the external auditor on the work undertaken to arrive at the conclusions set out in the Independent Auditor's report on pages 123 to 130.
Area
Issue and nature of judgement
Factors considered and conclusions reached
Defined 
benefit 
pension 
schemes
At 31 December 2024 the Group’s balance sheet included a net asset position of 
£117m in respect of its defined benefit pension schemes, which reflects a gross 
pension asset of £971m and pension liability of £854m.
The valuation of the pension liability is calculated under the unit credit method 
specified in IAS 19 – Employee Benefits and depends on several key assumptions 
including the discount rate, inflation forecasts and life expectancy. By their nature, 
these estimates are subject to considerable uncertainty and small changes in the 
value could materially impact the valuation of the liability.
Management presented the Committee with papers setting out the results of the work done, the assumptions made and the 
conclusions reached with respect to the Group’s defined benefit pension schemes. Management explained to the Committee how the 
discount rate, inflation and life expectancy estimates were prepared and how sensitive the valuation was to changes in these key 
assumptions. After reviewing these papers and obtaining further explanation where necessary, the Committee concluded that 
management had taken a consistent, balanced and reasoned approach to preparing its calculations and made acceptable judgements. 
Further information is given in the financial statements (note 18 – Pension arrangements).
The carrying 
value of 
goodwill and 
other assets
The Group balance sheet contains £908m of goodwill and other intangible assets 
and £1,317m of tangible fixed assets and right-of-use assets.
The Directors are required to determine annually whether those assets have 
suffered any impairment. They do so by comparing the present value of future 
cash flows for each cash-generating unit with the carrying value of assets. In 
addition, the Company balance sheet contains £2,417m of investments. The 
Directors compare the net present values of future cash flows from each 
investment to the carrying value of the investment in the balance sheet. The 
calculations undertaken to help arrive at a conclusion incorporate a consideration 
of the risks associated with each cash generating unit and are based upon 
forecasts of their long-term future cash flows, which by their nature require 
judgement to be exercised and are subject to considerable uncertainty.
The cash flow forecasts used for impairment considerations are prepared from the strategic business plans presented to, and 
approved by, the Board of Directors annually. Management presented the Committee with papers setting out the results of the work 
done, the assumptions made and the conclusions reached. They explained to the Committee how the cash flow and discount rate 
calculations were prepared, the key assumptions and judgements that were made and how sensitive those cash flows were to changes 
in the key assumptions. After reviewing management’s papers and obtaining further explanation where necessary, the Committee 
concluded that management had taken a consistent, balanced and reasoned approach to preparing its calculations and that the 
judgements made were acceptable. It noted that the value-in-use and FVLCD models used by management showed that all material 
cash generating units had significant headroom, except for Staircraft and certain branches in the Merchanting segment for which 
impairments have been recognised and except for Toolstation Benelux, Travis Perkins General Merchant and CCF for which sensitivity 
disclosures have been included in the financial statements. The Committee concurred with the £96m impairment recognised. The 
Committee also discussed the calculations supporting the carrying value of investments held by the Company and concurred with 
management’s conclusions.
Further information is given in the financial statements (note 9 – Goodwill and other intangible assets and note 29 – Impairment).

87
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Risk management and internal controls
Risk management
During the year:
•	 Key risks are collated and reviewed by the Group 
Leadership Team (“GLT”) and the Board to assess 
the potential impact and likelihood of occurrence, 
after taking into account key controls and 
mitigating factors, as well as interdependencies.
•	 Horizon scanning and risk benchmarking is also 
undertaken to test the Group’s key risk set and 
identify emerging risks, which informs the Board’s 
review.
•	 Risks are also logged and managed on an ongoing 
basis at both a Group and business unit level, and 
assessed in key strategic and performance review 
processes, with additional mitigating actions put in 
place to manage risks within the Board’s risk appetite.
The above supports the continuous improvement 
approach to risk management adopted by the Group. 
Following the deep-dive exercise undertaken in 2023 
to assess existing appetite levels and ways of working 
with senior leaders, the risk appetite for the Group’s 
Principal Risks was reset in November 2023. This 
has been reviewed again by the Board and with the 
Audit Committee in 2024 to ensure these remain 
appropriate and reflective of the Group’s current 
risk landscape and approach. No fundamental 
changes have been made to the risk appetite set in 
2024, and work continues to embed awareness and 
understanding of risk management across the Group.
The Statement of principal risks and uncertainties is 
set out on pages 59 to 69, together with information 
on how those risks are mitigated and how emerging 
risks are assessed.
Internal controls
The Company operates a “three lines of defence” 
assurance model. The Audit Committee plays a 
key role in monitoring activities in respect of the 
Company’s internal control and assurance framework 
throughout the year, to ensure that risks are 
adequately mitigated (see the Statement of principal 
risks and uncertainties on pages 59 to 69). The Audit 
Committee has received regular updates on the 
status of these activities.
The internal control and assurance framework is 
intended to support the management, rather than 
elimination, of the risk of failure to achieve business 
objectives and can only provide reasonable, and not 
absolute, assurance against material misstatement 
or loss.
The Audit Committee maintained a review of the 
effectiveness of the Company’s risk management 
and internal controls, concluding that, overall, they 
remain effective. In 2024, particular Audit Committee 
focus has been on continuing management 
initiatives to improve the internal financial control 
environment, including in connection with the ongoing 
developments in UK corporate reform ("UKCR"), and 
where required targeted improvements have been 
planned or agreed to continue to improve our control 
environment and to appropriately manage risks. The 
proposed approach to ensuring that the Group can 
meet all reporting requirements of UKCR has been 
reviewed by the Audit Committee and this will be a 
matter of further Audit Committee focus in 2025. 
Oracle Financials will enhance the Group’s 
consistency and automation of controls, giving the 
Group greater ability to improve its control framework 
to support compliance with UKCR. Post-launch 
performance of the system has been monitored by 
the Audit Committee throughout 2024, including 
review of the reports provided by PwC in its capacity 
as independent assurance provider. During the 
immediate post-implementation period, derogations 
to normal internal controls were accepted in some 
areas such as the number of super-users and the 
frequency of reconciliations to reflect the anticipated 
early-life challenges of a new finance system, 
however these were appropriately addressed through 
mitigating controls.
All major internal assurance processes, including 
operational compliance and health and safety, are 
also an area of focus for the Internal Audit function 
to review and to track recommended control 
improvement actions to completion. This is a core 
part of the continuous improvement of controls and 
the progress of this activity is reported to the Audit 
Committee and reviewed at each of its meetings, 
which enables its ongoing assessment of the overall 
effectiveness of the system of internal control and 
risk management. Further explanation of the role of 
the Group’s Internal Audit function is given below.
Internal audit
The Internal Audit Plan is the annual plan for delivery 
of internal audit activity aligned with the Group’s 
strategic priorities, major change programmes and 
principal risks. The Internal Audit Plan is, therefore, 
a key source of internal assurance for the Group. 
The Internal Audit function develops the Internal 
Audit Plan, taking into consideration relative levels 
of risk, historic coverage and management requests, 
and conducts a rolling risk assessment within each 
year to ensure that internal audit activities remain 
targeted at the areas presenting the most risk to the 
Group, as these can change over time. The Internal 
Audit function delivers the majority of internal audit 
activity, supported as needed by co-source partners 
to provide specialist knowledge and skills. The Audit 
Committee assesses and approves the Internal 
Audit Plan and reviews results and progress at each 
Audit Committee meeting. The Audit Committee 
will also review and decide whether to approve 
recommendations received from the Internal Audit 
function regarding updates to the Internal Audit Plan 
to ensure it remains aligned with business priorities 
and risks. 
The audits delivered during 2024 covered a broad 
range of operational, financial, legal, regulatory, IT and 
transformation activities. Core financial control areas 
are audited regularly. In 2024 this included:
•	 reviews of balance sheet reconciliations;
•	 critical systems recovery;
•	 key systems privileged access; and
•	 security operations.
In addition, Internal Audit has supported the 
Oracle Financials programme, and the Kerridge 
programme, to deliver a new finance system in BSS, 
by undertaking reviews of purchase-to-pay processes 
and business continuity readiness, by updating 
management and by providing input into changes 
to operational ways of working in relation to both 
programmes.
The 2025 Internal Audit Plan was approved by the 
Audit Committee at its meeting in November 2024. 
The 2025 Internal Audit Plan is targeted at assurance 
in relation to:
•	 follow-ups in key areas that have previously been 
the subject of the most significant audit findings;
•	 key technology programmes including those 
related to Group finance systems;

88
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
AUDIT COMMITTEE REPORT CONTINUED
•	 control effectiveness across key business 
functions; and
•	 areas or processes aligned to principal risks.
Internal Audit will also focus in 2025 on mapping 
material controls and assurance in response to the 
requirements of the UK Corporate Governance Code. 
The 2025 Internal Audit Plan includes standing 
annual requirements to review internal financial 
controls self-assessments, the basis for the Group’s 
Senior Accounting Officer declaration regarding tax 
controls, and rolling assurance coverage to support 
the Group’s ISO14001 certification. Any subsequent 
changes to the Internal Audit Plan will be approved by 
the Audit Committee. 
All audit findings and agreed management actions 
are communicated to the Audit Committee and 
tracked to completion. The Audit Committee receives 
an update at every meeting on the age of findings 
and the level of risk. Internal Audit launched an app 
in 2024, allowing management to view and update 
agreed actions in real time. This has resulted in a 
more focused approach to addressing findings. In 
turn, this improves the level of control in relation to 
risks identified in the audit findings.
Effectiveness of the Internal Audit function is 
assessed against a series of attributes and it was 
reported to the Committee that the target level for 
each attribute was achieved in 2024. The Internal 
Audit function also reported to the Audit Committee 
that good progress continues against all three of 
the priority areas captured in its strategic pillars: 
Alignment to Business Needs; Leverage Data & 
Technology; Continuous Improvement. In keeping 
with the continuous improvement priority, the Internal 
Audit function also sets initiatives in relation to its 
strategic pillars annually and reports progress to the 
Audit Committee, as the team looks for opportunities 
to enhance its standard of effectiveness. In 2024 
initiatives focused on the development of the data 
analytics capability of the Internal Audit function, to 
include the consideration of data analytics in all audit 
work, and implementing a forum to bring together 
representation from assurance providers across the 
Group. This has enabled enhanced cross-functional 
working and sharing of knowledge to reduce risk 
exposure and increase efficiency. 
Based on its review of the updates on activity 
undertaken and progress made, the Audit Committee 
was satisfied with the effectiveness of the Internal 
Audit function and that the quality, experience and 
expertise of the function was appropriate for the 
Group throughout 2024.
External auditor
The Audit Committee discharges its responsibilities 
regarding the external auditor in accordance with 
the Financial Reporting Council’s Audit Committees 
and the External Audit: Minimum Standard (“FRC 
Minimum Standard”).
The Audit Committee confirms that the Company 
has complied with the provisions of the Statutory 
Audit Services for Large Companies Market 
Investigation (Mandatory Use of Competitive Tender 
Processes and Audit Committee Responsibilities) 
Order 2014.
KPMG LLP has been the external auditor since 2015. 
There are no contractual restrictions on the Group 
with regard to this appointment. The individual lead 
audit engagement partner for KPMG LLP is James 
Tracey, appointed in August 2022.
The scope of the external audit plan and strategy for 
the external audit of the 2024 Annual Report and 
Accounts was presented by the external auditor to the 
Audit Committee in November 2024 to enable the 
Audit Committee to interrogate the approach.
Assessment of the external auditor
The Audit Committee considers the effectiveness of 
the external auditor during the year and, with input 
from management, carries out a formal review of 
external auditor performance after the year-end audit 
has been completed. In undertaking this assessment 
the Audit Committee considers:
•	 The experience and expertise of the external auditor.
•	 The completion of the agreed external audit plan.
•	 The content, quality of insights and added value of 
external audit reports.
•	 The robustness and perceptiveness of the external 
auditor in its handling of key accounting and audit 
judgements.
•	 The interaction between management and the 
external auditor.
•	 The provision of non-audit services.
Independence and objectivity
Having considered the external auditor’s performance 
and representations from the external auditor about 
its internal independence processes, plus through 
its ongoing review of compliance with the policy on 
non-audit work by the external auditor (described 
in further detail below) the Audit Committee 
was satisfied with the independence, objectivity 
and effectiveness of the external auditor and 
recommended to the Board that it recommend that 
KPMG LLP be reappointed by shareholders at the 
Annual General Meeting on 22 April 2024 as external 
auditor for the 2024 audit.
Reporting
One of the Audit Committee’s responsibilities is 
to ensure compliance with the Board’s policy on 
services provided by and fees paid to the external 
auditor. The policy sets out the work that is permitted 
to be performed by the external auditor and the work 
that is prohibited. The amount of non-audit fees 
payable to the external auditor in any particular year 
cannot exceed 70% of the average of the current and 
previous two years’ audit fees.
The process for approving all non-audit work 
provided by the external auditor is overseen by the 
Audit Committee to safeguard the objectivity and 
independence of the external auditor. The Audit 
Committee considers whether it is in the interests of 
the Company that the services are procured from the 
external auditor rather than another supplier.
In 2024 KPMG LLP was engaged to provide non-
audit services only in relation to the June 2024 review 
of the Group’s interim financial statements. KPMG 
LLP was considered the most appropriate firm to 
carry out the work in respect of the interim review 
given its knowledge of the Group and the synergies 
that arise from running this engagement alongside 
the main audit.
The CFO reports to the Audit Committee on fees for 
non-audit services payable to the external auditor 
at every meeting. During the year the auditor was 
paid £3.1m (2023: £2.1m) for audit-related work and 
£0.1m (2023: £0.1m) for non-audit work. Non-audit 
work related to the review of the Group’s interim 
financial statements. Fees for non-audit work were 
3% (2023: 4%) of fees for audit-related work. The 
total fees paid by the Group to KPMG LLP in 2024 
represent 0.1% of KPMG LLP’s UK fee income. In 
addition, £2.9m (2023: £2.7m) of fees were paid to 
other accounting firms for non-audit work.

89
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
The Audit Committee is satisfied that the non-audit 
fees payable to the external auditor in relation to 
2024 do not exceed 70% of the average of the 
current and previous two years’ audit fees.
External audit tender
Introduction
The Group was required to run a tender process 
for the appointment of its external auditor for the 
2025 financial year in accordance with applicable 
legislation, having appointed KPMG LLP as external 
auditor for the 2015 financial year.
Governance
Governance was put in place to ensure a transparent 
and robust selection, and evaluation process. A 
steering group chaired by the Audit Committee 
Chair and including the Interim Chair, Chief Financial 
Officer and Group Financial Controller was formed 
to oversee, co-ordinate and execute the audit tender 
process. The Committee was involved throughout  
the process and the Board was included at key 
decision points.
Tender process
The process, which ran from July 2024 to December 
2024, was in compliance with statutory legislation 
and guidance issued by the FRC and was conducted 
with the overarching objective of running a process 
resulting in a high-quality, effective and efficient audit.
The scope of the tender consisted of the Travis 
Perkins plc Group audit and statutory audits of key 
subsidiaries with effect from the 2025 financial year.
Selection criteria
A range of candidates were considered, including 
audit firms outside the “Big 4” accounting firms.  
The Audit Committee and steering group agreed the 
selection criteria and which firms would be invited  
to tender.
The selection criteria included:
•	 Audit Quality: findings from the FRC Audit Quality 
Review inspections.
•	 General aspects of the audit firm: independence, 
conflicts of interest, ethics and compliance 
standards.
•	 Understanding of the business and industry: audit 
credentials in building materials distribution and 
the broader construction sector and knowledge of 
the Group’s business and industry.
Invitation to tender
Three firms were invited to tender, including a firm 
from outside the “Big 4”. At this stage, one firm 
withdrew from the process and therefore two firms 
progressed to the next stage.
Assessment criteria
The requirements for the tender document and 
selection criteria were set out and detailed in the 
request for proposal and included:
•	 Confirmation of independence and details of how 
the firm monitors and maintains its independence, 
and the governance in place to ensure conflicts of 
interest do not arise.
•	 The firm’s and the team’s credentials.
•	 Internal quality assurance processes and output 
from latest FRC reviews.
•	 Understanding of Travis Perkins plc and the 
industry in which it operates.
•	 Audit approach: proposed scope, approach to 
controls and integration of technology in the audit, 
approach to technical judgements, availability of 
audit tools and their use to provide value-add 
insights.
•	 Audit planning: timetable, interaction with business 
finance teams including Toolstation and BSS, 
approach to working with management and 
approach to resolving issues.
•	 Technical expertise including firm’s experience and 
expertise in relation to sustainability reporting and 
assurance.
•	 Fees and terms.
•	 Transition approach, detailing how the firm will 
interact with the incumbent external auditor and 
the Group to ensure an effective and efficient 
process.
Each firm submitted a detailed tender document and 
provided an oral presentation of their proposal for 
external audit services to the steering group.
Final selection
The Committee agreed that both firms submitted 
excellent, professional and thorough tender 
proposals. However, after taking into account the 
process as a whole, the views of senior management 
who met with each firm, the presentations and results 
against the evaluation criteria, the Board identified 
Deloitte as the preferred new external auditor. We are 
now working closely with both KPMG and Deloitte to 
ensure that, if shareholders approve the proposed 
appointment of Deloitte at the 2025 AGM, there 
will be an efficient transition of the external audit. 
Deloitte shadowed key meetings through the 2024 
audit process and regular reports on the transition are 
being provided to the Committee.
The recommendation of Deloitte was free from 
influence by a third party and no contractual term 
of the kind mentioned in Article 16(6) of the Audit 
Regulation has been imposed on the Company 
whereby there would be a restriction on the choice to 
certain categories or lists of audit firms.
Financial Reporting Council
During 2024 the Audit Committee monitored the 
Group’s engagement with external stakeholders 
relevant to the Audit Committee’s areas of oversight, 
including the Financial Reporting Council (“FRC”).
In preparing the Group’s Annual Report and Accounts, 
the Group responds to the recommendations of the 
FRC made through its reviews of corporate reporting 
and its thematic reviews of specific areas of corporate 
reporting.
Heath Drewett
Chair, Audit Committee
31 March 2025

90
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT
Dear Shareholder,
As Chair of the Remuneration Committee,  
I am pleased to present the 2024 Directors’ 
remuneration report.
Performance in 2024 has continued to be tough, 
hampered by persistently weak trading conditions as 
well as a number of significant internal challenges. 
In light of these challenges and profit delivery 
below market expectations, the Group will not pay 
any bonuses to Executive Directors in respect of 
2024 performance. In addition, the Remuneration 
Committee exercised its discretion to adjust the 
vesting outcome for 2022 Restricted Share Plan 
“RSP” awards for former Executive Directors, in 
recognition of the Group’s performance and not 
meeting the Return on Capital Employed underpin. 
As a result of this decision, RSP awards granted to 
former Executive Directors in 2022 and with a vesting 
period from 2022 to 2024 lapsed in full.
Leadership changes
Nick Roberts stepped down from his role as Chief 
Executive on 16 September 2024. Pete Redfern 
joined the Group as Chief Executive on 16 September 
2024. Pete Redfern’s salary on appointment was set 
at £760,000. This positioning, whilst higher than his 
predecessor, reflected his skills and significant prior 
experience as Chief Executive of Taylor Wimpey. 
His annual incentive opportunity for 2024 was set 
in line with policy at 180% of salary and he received 
an RSP award on appointment with a grant value of 
125% of salary. His pension entitlement was set at 
10% of salary, in line with the rate available across 
the wider workforce. As a result of ill health, Pete 
Redfern stepped down from the Board and ceased 
employment on 10 March 2025.
Alan Williams retired as Chief Financial Officer on 
9 January 2024 and left the Group on 31 January 
2024. The new Chief Financial Officer, Duncan 
Cooper, joined the Group on 9 January 2024. As 
detailed in the 2023 Directors’ remuneration report, 
Duncan’s base salary was set at £525,000, which 
was lower than that of his predecessor.
Jasmine Whitbread stood down as Chair on 31 
May 2024, with Jez Maiden, Senior Independent 
Director, assuming the role of Chair on an interim 
basis for the remainder of 2024. On 10 July 2024, 
the appointment of Geoff Drabble as Non-executive 
Director and Chair (designate) was announced, 
with effect from 1 October 2024. Geoff took up the 
position of Chair on 1 February 2025, with the fee 
set at £350,000 from the date of appointment, 
reflecting the expected time commitment of the role 
and the calibre of the individual.
Remuneration policy
The remuneration policy was approved by 79% 
of shareholders. In light of the voting outcome, 
the Remuneration Committee Chair engaged with 
those shareholders that voted against the policy 
to gain a better understanding of their views. This 
indicated that the key reason for opposition from those 
shareholders was a lack of support for elements of the 
RSP, in the context of underlying performance in 2024.
Ahead of 2025, the Remuneration Committee 
reviewed the operation of its policy at its meeting in 
December, taking into account the feedback received 
at the 2024 AGM and the relatively new executive 
team amongst other things. The key conclusion 
was that whilst the current RSP has the potential to 
support the Group with the retention of executive 
talent through a period of business turnaround, it 
does not align with the cultural transformation that 
is in the early stages of being implemented. As 
announced in the Q3 Trading Update, the priorities 
are driving and incentivising branch-led performance, 
increasing operational effectiveness and identifying 
further ways to make the business run more 
efficiently to ensure the delivery of greatly improved 
returns to shareholders. In this context, performance 
shares with stretching performance targets provide 
a much stronger and direct performance-linkage for 
senior business leaders to complement the cultural 
change being implemented across the Group.
As a result, at the 2025 AGM, an amended 
remuneration policy will be tabled to replace the 
Restricted Share Plan with a Performance Share Plan. 
The maximum award level under the Performance 
Share Plan will be 250% of salary, which has been 
determined based on the current Restricted Share 
Plan maximum of 125% of salary and the market-
standard conversion ratio of 1:2 performance shares 
to restricted shares. Performance will be measured 
over a three-year period and a two-year post-vesting 
holding period will apply to vested shares, meaning 
any vested shares will be released five years  
after grant.
Subject to shareholder approval, long-term incentive 
awards in 2025 will be granted under this new PSP, 
with vesting based on the following equally-weighted 
performance conditions:
•	 33% on adjusted earnings per share (“adjusted 
EPS”)
•	 33% on relative total shareholder return (“TSR”)
•	 33% on adjusted return on capital employed 
(“adjusted ROCE”)
Louise Hardy
Chair, Remuneration Committee
31 March 2025
2024 focus areas
•	 Approval at the 2024 AGM of the 
remuneration policy
•	 Appointment of Duncan Cooper, Chief 
Financial Officer
•	 Appointment of Pete Redfern, Chief Executive
Number of meetings during 2024
7

91
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Adjusted ROCE has been chosen as it directly 
contributes to shareholder value creation. Adjusted 
EPS aligns with consistent delivery of profitable 
growth, which is expected to support shareholder 
returns through operational delivery driving a re-
rating of the share price. The use of TSR ensures 
there is a relative measure that will only reward 
executives if there is outperformance compared to 
the FTSE 250 (excluding Investment Trusts).
25% of the award vests on the achievement of 
threshold performance, with the full award vesting 
on the achievement of the maximum performance 
target, with straight-line vesting in between threshold 
and maximum. Details of the targets applying to the 
2025 award are set out on page 97.
In line with institutional investors’ best practice 
expectations, at the time of testing performance 
against the above conditions, the Committee will have 
the ability to adjust the vesting outcome if it considers 
that the vesting level is not reflective of the underlying 
performance of the executive or the Group (e.g. in 
the event there was a perceived windfall gain) or the 
vesting outcome was not consistent with the overall 
experience of shareholders or other stakeholders 
having had regard to the circumstances during the 
performance period.
There are no other changes to the current 
remuneration policy.
Each part of the remuneration package plays an 
important role in driving performance to deliver the 
Group’s strategy and improve shareholder returns. 
The link between the Group’s strategy and incentive 
measures is detailed under the “Remuneration in 
2024 – at a glance” section on page 94.
Shareholder engagement
As part of the review of the remuneration policy, the 
Committee engaged with major shareholders and 
the leading advisory agencies to explain and provide 
context for the proposed amendment to reintroduce 
the Performance Share Plan and detail its operation 
for 2025. The consultation process involved a letter 
being sent to the 20 largest institutional shareholders 
who collectively own over 70% of the Group’s shares 
to ask for feedback on the proposals and offering 
meetings on request.
The Committee met with or received written 
feedback from 15 investors as well as the advisory 
agencies. The proposed replacement of the 
Restricted Share Plan with a Performance Share 
Plan was positively received by the vast majority of 
shareholders consulted. There was some challenge 
around the top end of the EPS target range noting 
the market competitive award size at 250% of 
salary. The Committee considered the feedback and 
subsequently increased the maximum EPS target 
from 75p to 80p. The Committee was comfortable 
that this increase was appropriate, taking account of 
the following factors:
•	 It is a stretch compared to the internal plan, 
especially given current trading conditions;
•	 Using a three-year historical average price/
earnings ratio of around 15x, the target implies a 
doubling of the share price over three years; and
•	 The maximum EPS target is significantly ahead of 
the market consensus for 2026. There is no 
consensus available for 2027.
The Committee did consider reducing the size of the 
award instead of increasing the EPS target. However, 
given the factors above and as the proposed awards 
have broadly the same value as historical awards 
of Restricted Shares (i.e. Performance Shares are 
generally discounted by 50% when converting to 
Restricted Shares), it was felt that 250% of salary 
was appropriate in the context of the management 
team having been recruited on a policy of making 
Restricted Share awards at 125% of salary.
2025 salary review
This year’s annual salary review was a difficult 
balancing act, in delivering pay awards across 
all levels of the organisation that are affordable 
and fair, whilst also taking account of higher than 
anticipated uplifts to the National Living Wage 
minimum pay rates and additional employer National 
Insurance contributions taking effect in April 2025. 
Whilst inflation stabilised during 2024, living costs 
have remained high relative to earnings for many 
colleagues, and a key focus has been to ensure that 
lower earners receive a meaningful pay uplift and 
that appropriate pay differentials are maintained 
for colleagues working at different levels across the 
Group. Over half of the workforce will receive a salary 
increase above the rate of inflation on 1 April 2025, 
whilst higher earners will receive a salary increase of 
1.5%. Entry-level colleagues and apprentices are paid 
above the statutory minimum. 
Taking into account current market conditions, cost 
constraints and the approach to the pay review for 
the wider workforce, the Remuneration Committee 
reviewed the salaries of Executive Directors and 
determined that there would be a salary increase 
of 1.5% from 1 April 2025, in line with the approach 
taken for other management levels across the Group. 
This follows a similarly restrained approach to setting 
salaries for executives in the past. The former Chief 
Executive (Nick Roberts) received a 1.5% salary 
increase in April 2024, and he and the former Chief 
Financial Officer (Alan Williams) received a 4% salary 
increase in April 2023 and a 3% increase in April 
2022, which were lower than the increases offered to 
the wider workforce.
Non-executive Directors’ fees were reviewed but not 
increased in April 2024. The Chair’s fee was set on 
his appointment on 1 February 2025. The fees for 
Non-executive Directors will next be reviewed in  
April 2025.
2025 bonus plan
The Committee reviewed the annual bonus plan 
for 2025 to ensure the use of clear and simple 
performance measures focused on driving the 
recovery of the business. Reflecting the move to a 
more business-focused, performance-driven culture, 
it was decided that it would be appropriate to remove 
the element of the bonus plan that is linked to strategic 
performance until the new business strategy has 
been formulated and communicated externally and 
internally. This allows for greater focus on the Group’s 
key financial priorities in 2025, as it recovers from 
a sustained period of underperformance through 
depressed market conditions. This is intended to be 
a temporary change and it is expected that strategic 
measures will be reintroduced in future years.
For 2025, the key financial metrics will be operating 
profit and cash performance. Operating profit has 
been chosen to ensure that there is a continued focus 
on driving revenue and managing costs to deliver 
profit to shareholders. Operating cash flow is a critical 
measure for the business to ensure that there are the 
necessary resources to invest and deliver long-term 
returns to shareholders.

92
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
Cash performance will be measured against an 
absolute operating cash flow target in 2025 instead of 
the operating cash conversion measure that applied 
for 2024, as it is felt that this is a more appropriate 
measure given the reduction in operating profits over 
the past two years. These financial measures ensure 
the business is focused on delivering top and bottom 
line growth, while continuing to drive accountability 
on efficient management of stock and debtors and 
disciplined capital expenditure.
Prior to his stepping down from the Board and 
ceasing employment, part of Pete Redfern’s annual 
bonus was based on the operating profit of the Travis 
Perkins General Merchant business, reflecting his 
dual role as Interim MD, Travis Perkins in addition to 
being the Chief Executive of the Group. The former 
Chief Executive’s annual bonus was, prior to his 
cessation of employment, weighted 50% on Group 
adjusted operating profit (excluding property profits), 
25% on Travis Perkins General Merchant operating 
profit and 25% on Group adjusted operating cash 
flow. The Chief Financial Officer’s annual bonus 
will be weighted 75% on Group adjusted operating 
profit (excluding property profits) and 25% on Group 
operating cash flow.
For 2025, the bonus opportunity will start accruing at 
a threshold performance level, rising from 0% to 50% 
of maximum payout for achieving target, with payouts 
on a straight-line basis in between threshold and target, 
and target and maximum. The maximum opportunity 
will be unchanged at 180% of salary for Executive 
Directors. The target bonus opportunity for 2025, at 
50% of maximum, has been increased from 25% 
of maximum that applied as a temporary measure 
for 2024. This reflects a return to standard market 
practice and the challenging performance targets, 
which relate only to financial measures in 2025.
2025 Performance Share Plan
The first award under the Performance Share Plan 
will be made following the 2025 AGM, subject to 
shareholder approval of the amendment to the 
current policy. The Chief Financial Officer will be 
granted a PSP award equivalent to 250% of salary. 
A future Chief Executive appointment will be eligible 
to participate in the PSP on similar terms to the 
Chief Financial Officer, depending on the timing of 
any appointment and the amendment of the current 
policy at the 2025 AGM.
Performance will be assessed against three equally-
weighted performance conditions which align to 
the overall focus on sustainable value creation. The 
performance conditions and targets for the 2025 
award are set out below, with maximum vesting 
requiring around a 100% increase in profitability from 
2024. The Committee considers the maximum target 
to be genuinely stretching at the top end in light of 
ongoing challenging market conditions, whilst the 
lower end of the performance ranges have been set 
to be realistically achievable in this context.
•	 33% on adjusted EPS for the year ended 31 
December 2027, threshold at 65p and maximum 
at 80p;
•	 33% on adjusted ROCE for the year ended 31 
December 2027, threshold 9% and maximum 
10.5%; and
•	 33% on relative TSR, threshold at median and 
maximum at upper quartile.
To the extent that there are acquisitions or disposals, 
share buybacks or balance sheet events that 
materially impact the Group’s gearing (or other 
factors at the Committee’s discretion), the Committee 
would review the targets with a view to ensuring they 
fulfil their original intent.
Incentive outcomes in 2024
Weak trading conditions persisted throughout 2024, 
affecting all parts of the Group. As a result of these 
challenging conditions the Group downgraded its 
profit guidance in August 2024 and in October 2024. 
Performance against the key financial objectives in 
2024 was as follows:
•	 Group adjusted operating profit of £152m vs bonus 
target of £180m; and
•	 Group adjusted operating cash conversion of 130% 
vs bonus target of 149%.
2024 bonus payout – downward discretion 
exercised to award 0% of maximum
The annual bonus plan for Executive Directors 
in 2024 was based on adjusted operating profit 
(weighted at 55% of maximum), operating cash 
conversion (25% of maximum) and strategic 
performance (20% of maximum).
Group operating profit and operating cash conversion 
performance for 2024 were both below the threshold 
level, resulting in no payout against either of the 
financial measures. The Committee assessed 
the delivery against strategic measures at 22% of 
maximum (more details on page 95), meaning that 
a total of 4.4% of the total bonus opportunity was 
achieved during 2024.
In light of profit performance for 2024 being 
significantly below the initial guidance to market 
earlier in the year, and given that much of the wider 
workforce will not be receiving bonus payouts for 
performance over the same period, aligned with 
management’s recommendation, the Committee 
used its discretion and did not award any bonus 
payout for Executive Directors for 2024.
2022 RSP award – nil vesting in 2025
Long-term incentive awards granted to the former 
Executive Directors in 2022 were made in the form 
of Restricted Share Plan (“RSP”) awards, under the 
plan that was first introduced as part of the previous 
Directors’ remuneration policy approved at the 2021 
AGM.
In accordance with the previous remuneration policy, 
for Executive Directors, 75% of the 2022 RSP award 
vests after three years (March 2025) and 25% of the 
award vests after five years (March 2027). For other 
participants, RSP awards vest three years after grant. 
Whilst there are no performance targets attached 
to the vesting of RSP awards, the Committee may 
consider adjusting the extent to which awards will vest 
in the event the Group fails to meet the applicable 
performance underpins over the vesting periods.
The performance underpins for 2022 RSP awards 
were:
•	 Average adjusted return on capital employed 
above 9%; and
•	 Satisfactory governance performance including no 
ESG issues occurring or being identified by the 
Board which, in the Board’s opinion, have resulted 
in, or could result in, material reputational damage 
to the Group.
Average adjusted ROCE performance over the three 
financial years ended 31 December 2024 at 7.8% did 
not meet the adjusted ROCE underpin. As a result 
of the adjusted ROCE underpin being missed, the 
Committee undertook an assessment to determine 
whether it was appropriate to scale back the level 
of payout under the award. In recognition of wider 
performance delivery over the past three years, as 
well as the decline in the Group’s share price, the 
Committee concluded that it was appropriate that 

93
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
2022 RSP awards for Executive Directors do not vest. 
The Committee consequently exercised its discretion 
for these awards to lapse in full. In reaching this 
conclusion, the Committee noted that future RSP 
vesting would be considered having had regard to 
the relevant performance underpins as well as wider 
business performance and so the treatment of 2022 
awards was not considered to set a precedent as to 
the approach that would be taken in future years. For 
Executive Directors, 25% of the 2022 RSP award 
remains subject to the performance underpins over 
five-year period ended 31 December 2026.
Continuing to support colleagues in 
challenging times
Whilst needing to manage costs carefully in a 
challenging environment, a comprehensive package 
of benefits is offered to colleagues to support their 
financial, health and wellbeing needs. A key part of 
this has been the provision of the Wagestream tool 
to all colleagues from 2022, which allows colleagues 
to access a portion of their salary each month before 
pay-day to help manage short-term cash flow needs 
and allows colleagues to save directly from pay, all 
of which helps to build long-term financial resilience. 
30% of colleagues have enrolled with Wagestream 
and the short-term savings built up by colleagues 
across the Group to date have reached £2.2m. 
Other ongoing benefits include short-term loans, 
extensive retailer discounts, an employee assistance 
programme and a range of wellbeing and financial 
education resources.
Over the past few years the Group has prioritised 
higher pay uplifts for lower earners to support 
them with cost of living pressures. The Group has 
also introduced a free mortgage advice service 
and a health and wellbeing benefit, accessible by 
all colleagues and their families, which includes 
virtual GP advice, health checks, mental health and 
nutritional support. All colleagues in the UK and the 
Netherlands have the opportunity to participate in the 
discounted Sharesave programme, which has seen 
consistently high take-up over time.
2025 Annual General Meeting
At the 2025 AGM, the Committee will submit this 
annual remuneration report to a shareholder vote 
alongside the amendment to the current Directors’ 
remuneration policy to replace the Restricted Share 
Plan with a Performance Share Plan and a resolution 
to introduce a replacement long-term incentive  
plan in order to facilitate the operation of the PSP 
from 2025.
I look forward to receiving your support, and will be 
available to answer any questions.
Louise Hardy
Remuneration Committee Chair 
31 March 2025

94
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
REMUNERATION IN 2024 – AT A GLANCE
2024 remuneration outcomes
Executive Directors
Former Executive Directors
Element
Pete Redfern, CEO1
Duncan Cooper, CFO
Nick Roberts, Former CEO
Alan Williams, Former CFO
2024
2024
2024
2023
2024
2023
Base salary 
(annualised from 1 April)
£760,000
–
£525,000
–
£691,829
+1.5%
£681,605
£554,507
–
£554,507
Annual bonus (% of maximum)
–
–
–
–
–
Restricted Share Plan (% of maximum):
–
–
–
100%
–
100%
Share ownership (% of salary) (as at 31 December, or date of departure if earlier)
269%
39%
297%
392%
566%
648%
1	
Pete Redfern stepped down from the Board and ceased employment on 10 March 2025.
PAY FOR PERFORMANCE IN 2024 – AT A GLANCE
The following table shows how performance has been measured under the annual bonus and long-term incentive plans in 2024.
Ambition
Strategic KPI
Bonus weighting
RSP weighting
Profit growth
Adjusted operating profit
55%
–
Turning profit into cash
Adjusted operating cash conversion
25%
–
Delivery against investments
Average adjusted ROCE
–
Underpin
Strategic delivery
Strategic and operational objectives that continue to lay the foundations to deliver future success
20%
–
Governance
ESG measures and strong governance framework
–
Underpin
Delivering value to shareholders
Alignment to shareholder experience through share price movement
–
100% (since awards are made in shares)

95
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Annual bonus outcome for 2024: 0% of maximum
The maximum bonus opportunity for Executive Directors is 180% of salary. Half of the bonus earned is 
deferred into shares for three years. In light of the Group’s profit performance and the wider stakeholder 
experience, the Committee used its discretion and did not award a 2024 bonus payout to Executive Directors.
Strategic performance (22%)
Operating profit (0%)
Operating cash conversion (0%)
0%
25%
50%
% maximum achieved
75%
100%
Annual bonus performance for 2024
Long-term incentive plan outcome for 2022–2024: Committee exercised its discretion to scale 
back vesting to 0% of maximum
The maximum RSP award for Executive Directors was 125% of base salary. The ROCE underpin of an average 
of 9% over the performance period was not met with actual average ROCE of 7.8% over the period. Under the 
terms of the RSP this triggered a review of the level of vesting by the Committee. The Committee considered 
performance and shareholder experience and determined that the first portion of the 2022 RSP award should 
not vest.
The following charts illustrate how incentive outcomes for the Executive Directors have reflected performance 
over the past five years.
Historical bonus outcomes for the last 5 years vs Group operating profit
97%
Bonus payment (% of max)
100
500
Group operating profit £m
80
400
£353m
60
300
£295m
£227m
40
200
£180m
£152m
20
100
0%
0%
0%
0%
0
0
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
% of max
Group adjusted operating profit
Historical LTIP vesting outcomes for the last 5 years
2024
RSP underpin not met & discretion applied 0% 
RSP
RSP underpins met 100%
2023
PSP
2022
65%
CIP
100% 
RSP underpin performance for 2022 – 2024
Return on capital employed (ROCE)
Governance (including ESG)
one of two underpins achieved
2021
94%
100% 
2020
40%
100% 
0
20
40
60
80
100
% maximum achieved
All annual bonus and long-term incentive outcomes are subject to malus and clawback. Malus and clawback 
provisions apply for up to six years from the date of long-term incentive awards and for three years from the 
date of payment of the annual bonus.

96
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
REMUNERATION POLICY REPORT
The Group’s current Directors’ remuneration 
policy, which was approved at the 2024 
AGM, can be found in full on the Group’s 
website. An explanation of the proposed 
change to the policy which will be brought to 
the 2025 AGM for shareholder approval is 
set out in this section. A summary of the key 
elements of the remuneration policy and its 
implementation during 2024 is outlined in the 
annual remuneration report below. 
The principles of the Group’s amended remuneration 
policy, which were developed taking into account 
provision 40 of the UK Corporate Governance Code, 
are:
•	 Alignment to our culture, purpose and values
	 Remuneration arrangements are determined 
taking into account the culture, purpose 
and values of the Group, wider workforce 
remuneration and emerging best practice as 
well as ensuring there is robust governance and 
compliance with the 2018 Corporate Governance 
Code.
•	 Delivery of business strategy
	 Remuneration should support the execution of 
the strategy and long-term decision-making, 
contributing to the delivery of short and  
long- term financial returns for shareholders. 
Reward mechanisms should ensure that a 
significant proportion of variable pay is delivered 
in deferred shares, ensuring that executives retain 
a meaningful personal stake in the Group’s long-
term success.
•	 Rewarding sustainable and consistent 
performance
	 A significant proportion of executive remuneration 
is delivered in variable pay that is linked to 
business performance. Bonus and PSP outcomes 
are linked to performance against a limited 
number of measures which are clearly linked to 
our strategy and subject to stretching but fair 
targets. Reward structures should also reinforce 
the Company’s sustainability strategy and ESG 
agenda where relevant and appropriate.
•	 Attraction, development and retention of talent
	 Total remuneration should be competitive, fair 
and equitable, taking into account the size and 
scope of the role, external market practice as well 
as internal relativities and the wider workforce 
context. The principles that guide the approach 
to remuneration should be consistent for all 
colleagues across the Group. Reward structures 
should be clear, simple and transparent so that 
colleagues understand the value of their total 
remuneration and know how to contribute to 
performance.
•	 Fair and balanced remuneration outcomes
	 Remuneration outcomes are reviewed in the 
context of the shareholder experience, external 
climate and wider workforce. The Committee 
has the discretion to adjust reward outcomes to 
ensure that pay appropriately reflects underlying 
business performance and the wider context in 
a consistent and responsible way. All colleagues 
should be able to share in the success of the 
Group through participation in both annual bonus 
schemes and longer-term share plans.
•	 Management of risk
	 Malus, clawback and discretion provisions, 
holding periods and shareholding guidelines, 
including post-employment guidelines, should 
be in place to create alignment with shareholders 
and to mitigate reputational and other risk.
These principles apply across the Group. In addition 
to a competitive base salary, colleagues also have 
access to an extensive range of benefits, retirement 
benefits, an all-colleague Sharesave scheme and 
recognition awards.
Proposed change to policy
The proposed change to policy is replacing the 
current Restricted Share Plan with a Performance 
Share Plan. The policy for the PSP will be as follows:
•	 The maximum PSP opportunity will be 250% of 
salary (which aligns to the maximum under the 
current Restricted Share Plan, converted on a 
market-standard 1:2 multiple). This reflects the 
expected value of the long-term incentive 
opportunity agreed with Executive Directors on 
appointment in 2024 of 125% of salary under a 
Restricted Share Plan. In the context of a business 
turnaround, and noting the level of stretch in the 
targets, the Committee is comfortable the 
maximum opportunity is appropriate.
•	 Performance conditions will be set each year in line 
with the business strategy. For 2025, one third of 
the award will be based on EPS, one third on ROCE 
and one third on relative TSR.
•	 25% of the relevant part of the award vests for 
threshold performance, increasing to 100% for 
maximum performance.
•	 The Committee retains discretion to adjust the 
number of shares vesting having had regard to 
underlying performance across the vesting period 
and the shareholder experience during the vesting 
and holding periods.
•	 There are no changes to the three-year vesting 
period and two-year holding period or to the malus 
and clawback conditions that applied under the 
Restricted Share Plan.

97
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
ANNUAL REMUNERATION REPORT
The following sets out the annual remuneration report for 2024, which includes a summary of the remuneration policy, including the proposed amendment to replace the RSP with a PSP, and how it is intended to be 
implemented in 2025. This report is subject to an advisory shareholder vote at the 2025 AGM.
Implementation of the Directors’ remuneration policy in 2025
Executive Directors:
The following provides a summary of how the Group intends to implement the Policy during 2025.
Purpose and link to strategy
Individual maximum  
opportunity in 2025
Performance measures and weighting in 2025
Operation in 2025
Base salary (increase of 1.5% for the CFO from 1 April 2025)1 
Core element of total package, essential to support 
recruitment and retention of high-calibre 
executives.
CFO: £532,875  
(2024: £525,000)
n/a
The Remuneration Committee reviewed executive salaries and, 
taking into account current market conditions, determined that 
the base salary for the Chief Financial Officer would increase by 
1.5% from 1 April 2025, which is less than the workforce as a 
whole but in line with other management increases.
Benefits (no change)
Maintains a competitive package with a range of 
benefits for the Executive Director and his or her 
family.
n/a
n/a
Executive Directors continue to be entitled to benefits in line with 
the Policy, including private medical insurance, income protection, 
annual leave, company car (or cash alternative), life insurance of 
up to five times salary and participation in all-employee share 
plans such as Sharesave and Buy As You Earn.
Pension (no change)
Helps executives provide for retirement and aids 
retention.
10% of salary in line with the 
rate available across the wider 
workforce.
n/a
Executive Directors participate in a defined contribution 
arrangement or receive a cash allowance.
1.	 Pete Redfern stepped down from the Board and ceased employment on 10 March 2025 and so was not eligible for a 2025 salary increase.

98
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
Purpose and link to strategy
Individual maximum  
opportunity in 2025
Performance measures and weighting in 2025
Operation in 2025
Annual bonus (changes in performance measures to focus on critical areas for 2025)
Rewards achievement of annual performance 
objectives.
Deferred element encourages long-term 
shareholding and aligns reward to shareholder 
interests.
Malus and clawback based forfeiture provisions 
discourage excessive risk taking and short-term 
outlook, ensuring that Executive Director and 
shareholder interests are aligned.
Maximum annual bonus 
opportunity of 180% of salary.
The Committee reviewed performance measures for 2025 to 
ensure they were focused on critical areas to support the recovery 
of the business.  
The 2025 annual bonus will be based on the following measures:
Chief Executive¹:
•	 50% on Group adjusted operating profit (excluding property profits)
•	 25% on Group adjusted operating cash flow
•	 25% on TP General Merchant operating profit
Chief Financial Officer:
•	 75% on Group adjusted operating profit (excluding property profits)
•	 25% on Group adjusted operating cash flow
Adjusted operating profit has been chosen to ensure that there is a 
continued focus on driving revenue and managing costs to deliver 
profit to shareholders. Likewise operating cash flow is a critical 
measure for the business to ensure that we have the necessary 
resources to invest in the business and return value to shareholders.
Targets are determined in relation to the Group’s budget. For 
2025, there is no bonus payment below the threshold level of 
performance. 50% of the bonus is payable for target 
performance, and maximum payment is made only for 
performance in excess of the Group’s budget.
50% of bonus earned is deferred as shares that are held for three 
years. Malus and clawback provisions apply up to three years 
from the date of award.
Bonus targets are considered to be commercially sensitive, and 
disclosure of such may provide an unfair advantage to the 
Group’s competitors. However targets, and the corresponding 
level of bonus earned, will be disclosed retrospectively in the 
relevant reporting period.
Restricted Share Plan (to be replaced by the Performance Share Plan, subject to shareholder approval at the 2025 AGM)
Aligns participants with the shareholder 
experience, whereby participants build up a 
shareholding in Travis Perkins plc and are 
incentivised to deliver sustainable financial 
performance and enhance shareholder value over 
the long term. Helps retain Executive Directors.
n/a
n/a
n/a
1.	 Pete Redfern stepped down from the Board and ceased employment on 10 March 2025 as a result of ill health. The Committee will review the appropriateness of the above bonus metrics and targets on the appointment of a new Chief Executive having regard to the timing of any appointment to ensure the 
bonus remains strategically aligned with the role and similarly challenging.

99
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Performance Share Plan (for awards granted from 2025 onwards)
Purpose and link to strategy
Individual maximum  
opportunity in 2025
Performance measures and weighting in 2025
Operation in 2025
Aligns participants with the shareholder 
experience, whereby participants are incentivised 
to deliver sustainable financial performance and 
enhance shareholder value over the long term.
Maximum annual award of 
250% of base salary
For PSP awards granted in 2025, the performance conditions are 
as follows:
•	 33% on relative TSR, measured against the FTSE 250 excluding 
Investment Trusts
•	 33% on adjusted EPS
•	 33% on adjusted ROCE
Targets for each performance condition are set out below. The 
targets have been set to be realistically achievable at the lower end 
of the performance range and genuinely stretching at the top end:
•	 Adjusted EPS: threshold 65p and maximum 80p
•	 Adjusted ROCE: threshold 9% and maximum 10.5%
•	 Relative TSR: threshold at median and maximum at upper quartile
Any adjustments will be considered by the Remuneration 
Committee on a case by case basis but could include for example 
acquisitions or disposals, share buybacks or balance sheet events 
that materially impact the Group’s gearing (or other factors at the 
Committee’s discretion).
25% of the award vests on the achievement of threshold 
performance, with the full award vesting on achievement of the 
maximum performance target, with straight-line vesting for 
performance between threshold and maximum. 
Awards vest after three years, subject to a holding period of a 
further two years.
Malus and clawback provisions apply up to six years from the 
date of award.
Share ownership requirement
Aligns the interests of Executive Directors and 
shareholders.
Executive Directors are 
required to hold shares valued 
at 200% of salary within five 
years of appointment.
n/a
Executive Directors are also expected to maintain this level of 
shareholding (or their actual shareholding if lower) for a period of 
two years after stepping down from the Board.

100
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
Non-executive Directors:
Fees and benefits
•	 The Non-executive Director fees policy is to pay:
	
– A basic fee for membership of the Board.
	
– An additional fee to the Chair of a Committee and to the Senior Independent Director, taking into account the additional responsibilities and time commitment of the role.
•	 The Non-executive Chair receives an all-inclusive fee for the role.
•	 Non-executive Directors do not receive any other benefits (other than a staff discount card for purchasing products) and are not eligible to join the Group’s pension scheme.
•	 The review date for Non-executive Directors’ fees is 1 April. The basic fee was last increased by 4% with effect from 1 April 2023, in line with the approach for the wider workforce at the time. There was no increase to the basic fee or 
other Non-executive Director fees in April 2024. Jasmine Whitbread was paid an annual fee of £320,000 and stepped down as Chair and from the Board on 31 May 2024. Whilst acting as Interim Chair, Jez Maiden received a pro-rata 
payment of this Chair fee from 1 June 2024 to 31 January 2025, in place of his Non-executive Director and Senior Independent Director fee. The fee for the successor Chair, Geoff Drabble, effective 1 February 2025 is £350,000 per 
annum. The fee was set taking into account the expected time commitment of the role and the calibre of the individual. 
•	 The current fees are as follows:
	
– Chair fee	
	
	
	
£350,000
	
– Non-executive Director basic fee	
	
£64,272
	
– Audit/Remuneration Committee Chair fee	
£17,510
	
– Senior Independent Director fee	
	
£12,875
	
– Stay Safe Committee Chair fee	
	
£12,360

101
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Remuneration elsewhere in the Group
The approach to setting reward for the wider workforce is guided by the same principles that apply to executives, with a focus on attracting and retaining the best talent, competing within the industry sector and against the local 
market, and ensuring that pay outcomes are fair and equitable. The salary review process and incentive plan design are broadly consistent throughout the Group. A higher proportion of total remuneration for Executive Directors 
and the Group Leadership Team is variable and linked to business performance compared to the wider workforce.
The Group has prioritised its salary review budget on lower earners in recent years in recognition of continuing cost of living challenges. The longer-term aim is to continue to work towards meeting the Real Living Wage across the 
Group over time, whilst acknowledging the need to remain competitive at all levels in the organisation and to protect fair and appropriate internal pay relativities reflective of the skills, capabilities and experience of the workforce.
The Group’s wellbeing and benefit programmes are well established and provide comprehensive support to colleagues and their families during the moments that matter. Benefits include pension, share acquisition schemes, an 
employee assistance programme, recognition awards, discounts on Group products, an extensive retailer discount programme and a range of health, wellbeing, financial and lifestyle benefits. The take-up and use of benefits are 
closely monitored to assess the impact of cost of living pressures and resources have been invested in further communications direct with colleagues, as well as through line managers and offline communication methods such 
as driver handheld devices, to ensure that everyone is aware of the support that is available. The benefits offering is regularly reviewed and has steadily expanded over the past few years, with positive feedback from colleagues.
All colleagues based in the UK and the Netherlands also have the opportunity to participate in the Sharesave plan, which allows colleagues to save towards acquiring shares in Travis Perkins plc at a discounted option price. 
Senior leaders across the Group also receive long-term incentive awards.

102
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
AUDITED INFORMATION
Single total figure of remuneration
£000
2024
Salary
Benefits
Pension
Total fixed
Bonus
LTI1
Other2
Total variable
Total
Executive Directors
Duncan Cooper4
514
17
51
582
–
–
196
196
778
Former Executive Directors
Pete Redfern3
220
5
22
247
–
–
–
–
247
Nick Roberts5
486
20
49
555
–
–
–
–
555
Alan Williams6
34
1
3
38
–
–
–
–
38
Non-executive Directors
Marianne Culver
64
1
–
65
–
–
–
–
65
Geoff Drabble8
16
–
–
16
–
–
–
–
16
Heath Drewett
82
–
–
82
–
–
–
–
82
Jora Gill
77
1
–
78
–
–
–
–
78
Louise Hardy9
82
1
–
83
–
–
–
–
83
Jez Maiden10
219
1
–
220
–
–
–
–
220
Jasmine Whitbread7
133
–
–
133
–
–
–
–
133
Notes:
1	
Long-term incentives (“LTI”) reported for 2024 for Nick Roberts and Alan Williams relate to RSP awards granted in 2022, of which the first tranche (75% of award) is due to lapse in March 2025, as a result of the Committee exercising discretion to reduce vesting taking into account the performance of the 
business following the adjusted ROCE performance underpin not being met. 
2	 The figure disclosed as “Other” for Duncan Cooper relates to LTI buy-out awards in respect of deferred bonus shares forfeited from his previous employer on appointment to the Group, which are not subject to performance conditions. These have therefore been included in the single figure of remuneration in 
the year of grant valued based on the share price at the date of grant of £7.89. 
3	 Pete Redfern was appointed Chief Executive and joined the Group on 16 September 2024 and stepped down from the Board and ceased employment on 10 March 2025. Prior to this, Pete served as a Non-executive Director and as Senior Independent Director until 1 June 2023 and stepped down from the 
Board on 19 September 2023. 
4	 Duncan Cooper was appointed Chief Financial Officer and joined the Group on 9 January 2024. 
5	 Nick Roberts stepped down from the Board and from his role as Chief Executive on 16 September 2024.
6	 Alan Williams retired as Chief Financial Officer on 9 January 2024 and stepped down from the Board on 23 January 2024 and left the Group on 31 January 2024.
7	 Jasmine Whitbread stepped down from her role as Chair and from the Board on 31 May 2024.
8	 Geoff Drabble was appointed to the Board as Non-executive Director and Chair Designate on 1 October 2024. He took up the role of Chair on 1 February 2025.
9	 Louise Hardy was appointed to the Board on 1 January 2023 and as Chair of the Remuneration Committee on 1 December 2023.
10	 Jez Maiden was appointed to the Board as Senior Independent Director on 1 June 2023 and appointed as Interim Chair on 31 May 2024. During the period he served as Interim Chair, Jez received an aggregate fee of £186,667.

103
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Single total figure of remuneration continued
£000
2023
Salary
Benefits
Pension
Total fixed
Bonus
LTI1
Total variable
Total
Executive Directors
Nick Roberts
675
30
68
773
–
312
312
1,085
Alan Williams
549
19
55
623
–
254
254
877
Non-executive Directors
Marianne Culver
64
–
–
64
–
–
–
64
Heath Drewett
81
–
–
81
–
–
–
81
Jora Gill
76
–
–
76
–
–
–
76
Louise Hardy
65
–
–
65
–
–
–
65
Jez Maiden
45
–
–
45
–
–
–
45
Pete Redfern
51
–
–
51
–
–
–
51
Jasmine Whitbread
320
–
–
320
–
–
–
320
1	
The LTI figures for 2023 reported last year (£318,000 for Nick Roberts and £259,000 for Alan Williams) were calculated on an estimated basis using the average share price of the final quarter of 2023 of £7.76. These figures have been restated to reflect the actual share prices on vesting (£7.56 for the RSP 
awards that vested on 1 March 2024). 

104
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
Explanatory notes for the single total figure of remuneration table
Salary
Annual salaries for the Executive Directors increased by 1.5% on 1 April 2024. Fees for the Chair and Non-executive Directors were not increased on 1 April 2024.
Benefits
Benefits for 2024 for Pete Redfern, Nick Roberts, Duncan Cooper and Alan Williams include private medical insurance and the provision of a company car and fuel (or allowance alternative).
Benefits for Non-executive Directors include the reimbursement of travel and subsistence expenses for the attendance at Board meetings and the associated tax gross up paid on their behalf.
Directors’ pension entitlements
Duncan Cooper receives 10% of salary, paid as a mix of pension contributions to the Group’s defined contribution pension scheme and a cash allowance. This was also provided to Pete Redfern, Nick Roberts and Alan Williams 
until the date of their departure.
The value of Directors’ pension entitlements for the year ended 31 December 2024 (or the date of stepping down from the Board, if earlier) are outlined in the table below.
£000
Pete Redfern
Nick Roberts
Duncan Cooper
Alan Williams
Pension value in the year from employer contributions to defined contribution scheme
n/a
£7,061
£9,795
n/a
Pension value in year from cash allowance (salary supplement in place of employer pension contributions)
£22,024
£41,551
£41,564
£3,415
Total pension benefit accrued
£22,024
£48,612
£51,359
£3,415

105
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Annual bonus for 2024
Annual bonuses for 2024 were based on adjusted operating profit (55%), adjusted operating cash conversion (25%) and performance against strategic measures (20%). For 2024, in order to manage affordability, the bonus was 
structured such that there was no payout for below target performance, with 25% of maximum paying out for achieving target performance and 100% of bonus for achieving maximum levels of performance.
The following table summarises the bonus targets and achievement for 2024:
Weighting
Threshold 
(0% bonus)
Target  
(25% bonus)
Maximum 
(100% bonus)
Actual performance
Achieved 
(% maximum)
Adjusted operating profit
55%
n/a
£180m
£198m
£152m
0%
Adjusted operating cash conversion
25%
n/a
149%
159%
133%
0%
Strategic performance
20%
The Committee assessed performance against a number of strategic measures which were set at the start 
of  
the year. A summary of performance is provided below. The Committee determined that delivery against 
the strategic measures would have resulted in a payout of 22% of maximum for this element of the bonus 
plan.
22%
In light of financial performance, the Committee used its discretion and did not award a bonus payout against the strategic measures for 2024.
Strategic measure
Summary of strategic performance during 2024
Committee’s assessment
Customer relationships  
and market share
Decline in market share for TP General Merchanting and small market gain for Toolstation UK. Negative volume growth in Merchanting and small volume growth  
in Toolstation. Increased use of data to drive decision-making.
Not met
Operational efficiency
Oracle Financials went live in July 2024 and is in the process of being fully embedded across the Group. The final stage of the Kerridge implementation will be 
delivered in early 2025. The Toolstation France business was closed in 2024.
Partly delivered
Sustainability
Carbon emission reduction between 2020 and 2024 was 26% for fleet and 75% for buildings, which represents good progress towards the 2027 targets.  
Launch of “carbon change-maker” training has been delayed, but over 90% of colleagues participated in environmental training (which includes content on carbon). 
Sustainable product definitions were developed but the initial launch into the business was not delivered during 2024. In-depth Scope 3 roadmaps have been 
developed with all of the major businesses, allowing carbon impact to be considered in their commercial plans.
4.9% of new colleagues were recruited as apprentices, a reduction on prior year at 8%. 378 colleagues graduated from an apprenticeship in 2024,  
at a similar level to the year before and off-track against the target of 10,000 by 2030.
More detail on the Group’s progress against its sustainability and ESG objectives is detailed on page 29.
Partly delivered

106
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
Long-term incentives (LTI)
Long-term incentives in the single total figure of remuneration for 2024 comprise the following awards. 
Pete Redfern
No value reported in the single total figure of remuneration for 2024, since the first RSP award was granted on appointment in September 2024.
No buy-out awards were granted on appointment.
Duncan Cooper
£195,562
A total of 137,502 shares were granted on appointment as compensation for share-based incentives from the previous employer, Crest Nicholson plc, that were forfeited on joining the Group. 
Of these, 24,620 shares were granted in April 2024 in lieu of forfeited deferred bonus share awards originally granted in 2021 and 2022 and due to vest in January 2025 and January 2026, subject only to 
being employed on the vesting date. The replacement awards will vest on the same dates as the original forfeited awards.
166 shares in respect of dividend equivalents on the deferred bonus shares were added in the vesting period.
A total of 24,786 shares have been included in the single total figure of remuneration for 2024, with their value based on the share price of £7.89 at grant.
The remaining 112,882 shares were granted as performance share awards and will be disclosed as required in the single total figure of remuneration in the year of vesting.
Nick Roberts and 
Alan Williams
The first tranche of the 2022 RSP (75% of the award) was due to vest in March 2025. However, as set out below, the Committee exercised its discretion for these awards to lapse in full taking into account 
the wider performance of the business following the ROCE underpin not being met. The second tranche (25% of the award) is due to vest in March 2027, subject to the achievement of the performance 
underpins.
Consideration of performance underpin for 2022 RSP awards
Average ROCE over the three financial years ended 31 December 2024 at 7.7% did not meet the underpin of 9%. Performance against the other underpin on governance including ESG issues was assessed as satisfactory. In 
accordance with the terms of the underpin, as a result of the ROCE underpin being missed the Committee undertook an assessment to determine whether it was appropriate to scale back the level of payout under the award. In 
recognition of wider performance delivery over the past three years, including a number of profit warnings during 2023 and 2024 and a decline in the Group’s share price, the Committee concluded that it was appropriate that 
2022 RSP awards for Executive Directors do not vest. Therefore the Committee exercised its discretion for these awards to lapse in full. For Executive Directors, 25% of the 2022 RSP award remains subject to the performance 
underpins for the 5-year period ended 31 December 2026.
Overall, the Committee considers that the remuneration policy, noting the exercise of Committee’s discretion to adjust remuneration outcomes, has operated as it intended during 2024.

107
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Payments to past Directors and payments for loss of office
Pete Redfern
Pete Redfern stepped down from the Board and ceased employment on 10 March 2025 due to ill health. Pete did not receive any payments or compensation for loss of office. His six-month notice period under his service 
agreement was waived and accordingly he will not receive any notice payment or payment in lieu of notice.
In accordance with the remuneration policy and relevant plan rules, as a leaver due to ill-health, Pete Redfern’s 2024 RSP award will remain capable of vesting on its normal vesting date on 16 September 2027 subject to (i) an 
assessment of the applicable performance underpins; and (ii) a pro-rata reduction to 10 March 2025 (unless the Remuneration Committee determines such other period should apply). A two-year holding period shall apply to 
any shares received on exercise of the award following vesting. The 2024 RSP award will remain subject to malus and clawback provisions. Pete Redfern will not be eligible to receive any Restricted Share Plan award in 2025. 
The Committee determined that, given Pete Redfern’s shareholding had been built through shares acquired in the market (as opposed to from vested share awards) over a short period of employment, and in light of the 
circumstances of his cessation of employment being due to ill health, the post-employment shareholding guideline for Executive Directors will not apply.
Nick Roberts 
Nick Roberts stepped down from the Board and from his role as Chief Executive on 16 September 2024. In accordance with the remuneration policy, after he stepped down from the Board, Nick received salary (£203k), 
benefits (£6k) and pension (£20k) until the end of the 2024 financial year, and will continue to receive salary, benefits and pension until the end of his notice period on 27 March 2025. Nick remained eligible for a bonus for 
the 2024 performance year pro-rated to the date he stepped down from the Board on 16 September 2024. As noted above, the Committee determined that no bonus would be payable to the Executive Directors in respect of 
2024. Nick is not eligible for an annual bonus in respect of the 2025 performance year.
Nick’s unvested RSP awards (granted in 2022 and 2023) remain capable of vesting on their normal vesting dates, subject to time pro-ration and applicable holding periods. 75% of the 2022 RSP award will lapse in March 2025, 
as set out on page 106, and the remaining 25% is due to vest in March 2027 subject to the performance underpins. The 2023 RSP award is due to vest in March 2026 and March 2028, subject to the performance underpins. 
Nick did not receive a RSP award in 2024. 75% of the 2021 RSP award vested in March 2024, as disclosed in the 2023 remuneration report. Having regard for the performance of the Group in the period prior to the cessation of 
his employment, the Committee used its discretion to lapse the remaining 25% of the 2021 RSP award, which was due to vest in March 2026.
Nick’s outstanding 2022 Deferred Share Bonus Plan award will vest in full on its normal vesting date in March 2025. All other long-term incentive plan awards have vested but are, and will remain, subject to their applicable 
holding periods. Nick remains subject to the shareholding requirement policy for a period of two years after stepping down from the Board.
Alan Williams
Alan Williams stepped down from the Board and retired as Chief Financial Officer on 9 January 2024 and his employment with the Group ceased on 31 January 2024. Alan did not receive any payments or compensation for 
loss of office. In accordance with the remuneration policy, after he stepped down from the Board, Alan received salary (£12k) and benefits (£1k) and pension (£2k) until his last date of employment with the Group on 31 January 
2024. As a good leaver under the Policy by way of retirement with the agreement of the Board, Alan remained eligible for a pro rata bonus for the 2024 performance year to the date of his retirement on 31 January 2024. As 
noted above, the Committee determined that no bonus would be payable to the Executive Directors in respect of 2024.
In accordance with good leaver treatment under the Plan Rules having left employment by way of retirement with the agreement of the Board, Alan’s unvested RSP awards (granted in 2022 and 2023) remain capable of vesting 
on their normal vesting dates, subject to time pro-ration and applicable holding periods. 75% of the 2022 RSP award will lapse in March 2025 as set out on page 106, and the remaining 25% is due to vest in March 2027 
subject to the performance underpins. The 2023 RSP award is due to vest in March 2026 and March 2028, subject to the performance underpins.
Alan’s outstanding 2022 Deferred Share Bonus Plan award will vest in full on its normal vesting date in March 2025. All other long-term incentive plan awards have vested but are, and will remain, subject to their applicable 
holding periods. Alan remains subject to the shareholding requirement policy for a period of two years after stepping down from the Board.

108
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
Share interests awarded during the financial year
The Restricted Share Plan was approved by shareholders at the Annual General Meeting held on 27 April 2021.
Before granting awards under the RSP in 2024, the Committee took into account shareholder guidance that where the share price has fallen significantly compared to prior years, awards should be scaled back. The Committee 
considered that, although the share price at grant was lower than the prior year, it was not significantly lower and therefore they felt that it was appropriate to grant at the normal levels. In line with best practice the Committee 
retains discretion to adjust the vesting outturns if they are not considered to be reflective of the underlying financial or non-financial performance of the business or the individual over the performance period or where the 
outcome is not considered appropriate in the context of the experience of shareholders and other stakeholders.
If the Group does not meet one or more of the underpins, the Committee would consider whether it was appropriate to scale back the level of payout under the award to reflect this. The Committee retains discretion to 
determine what level of scale back is appropriate.
2024 long-term incentive awards
Date of award
Type of award
Basis
Face value*
Underpin assessment/performance period
Pete Redfern***
16 September 2024
RSP
125% of salary
£949,998
(108,373 shares at £8.766 per share)
1 January 2024 to 31 December 2026**
The award vests after three years, subject to the performance underpins. Shares that vest after three years 
are subject to an additional two year holding period post vesting
Duncan Cooper
25 April 2024
RSP
125% of salary
£656,248
(92,105 shares at £7.125 per share)
1 January 2024 to 31 December 2026**
The award vests after three years, subject to the performance underpins. Shares that vest after three years 
are subject to an additional two year holding period post vesting
25 April 2024
PSP
Buy-out
£379,328
(48,077 shares at £7.890 per share)
1 November 2021 to 31 October 2024
The award lapsed on 28 January 2025 since the original Crest Nicholson plc performance conditions that 
applied to the forfeited award were not achieved 
25 April 2024
DSBP
Buy-out
£87,035
(11,031 shares at £7.890 per share)
Not subject to performance conditions in line with the forfeited award
The award vested on 28 January 2025
25 April 2024
PSP
Buy-out
£511,311
(64,805 shares at £7.890 per share)
1 November 2022 to 31 October 2025
The award vests on 27 January 2026, subject to the achievement of the original Crest Nicholson plc 
performance conditions that applied to the forfeited award. 25% of the award may vest for threshold 
performance
25 April 2024
DSBP
Buy-out
£107,217
(13,589 shares at £7.890 per share)
Not subject to performance conditions in line with the forfeited award
The award vests on 27 January 2026, subject to being employed on the vesting date
*	
Awards are determined based on the share price prior to the date of the award. Awards are increased at each dividend payment date to reflect the dividends that would have been paid on vested shares between grant and the end of the holding period. The number of shares that vest will usually be reduced  
pro-rata to reflect the proportion of the individual’s employment during the vesting period from the grant date to the date of cessation of employment.
**	 The adjusted ROCE underpin applies over the period stated, with the governance/ESG underpin applying to the date of vesting.
*** Pete Redfern stepped down from the Board and employment on 10 March 2025. He will retain a pro-rata interest in the 2024 award having ceased employment by way of ill health.

109
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
2024 Deferred Share Bonus Plan (“DSBP”)
As no bonus was earned in respect of 2024, there will be no share awards under the Deferred Share Bonus Plan in 2025. There was also no annual bonus payout for 2022 and 2023 (and therefore no deferred share award in 
2023 and 2024).
Director’s shareholding and share interests – Executive Directors
Formal shareholding requirements apply to Executive Directors and senior executives. The Committee may decide to scale back or withhold participation in long-term incentives if the requirements are not met or maintained. 
Executive Directors are required to hold shares valued at 200% of salary within five years of appointment.
Directors’ shareholdings and share interests as at 31 December 2024 are outlined in the table below:
Executive Director
Beneficially 
owned shares1
Conditional 
shares under 
PSP2
Unvested RSP 
options3
Unvested 
unconditional 
shares under 
DSBP4
Unconditional 
options under 
Sharesave5
Vested but 
unexercised 
options6
Total interests
Total interests 
which count 
towards 
shareholding 
requirement7
Shareholding 
(% of salary)8
Pete Redfern9
252,966
–
109,109
–
–
–
362,075
252,966
269%
Duncan Cooper
11,987
113,648
92,730
24,786
–
–
243,151
25,124
39%
Former Executive Directors
Nick Roberts
97,132
–
161,976
39,554
2,688
256,409
557,759
254,992
297%
 Alan Williams
297,217
–
175,379
31,959
–
106,134
610,689
370,406
540%
1	
Includes ordinary shares beneficially held at 31 December 2024 (or date of stepping down from the Board if earlier) by the executive and their spouse/partner.
2	 Includes buy-out replacement awards in respect of performance share awards forfeited on leaving the previous employer. Vesting is subject to the achievement of the original Crest Nicholson plc performance conditions in line with the original vesting and release schedule.
3	 Includes outstanding awards made under the Restricted Share Plan (RSP). Vesting of these awards may be scaled back if one or more of the performance underpins is not met, subject to Remuneration Committee discretion.
4	 Includes outstanding awards made under the Deferred Share Bonus Plan (DSBP), which are not subject to performance conditions. In the case of Duncan Cooper, this relates to buy-out replacement awards in respect of deferred share bonus awards forfeited on leaving his previous employer.
5	 Includes outstanding options under the Sharesave (Save As You Earn) plan.
6	 Includes outstanding awards under PSP and CIP which have vested but have not yet been exercised. No PSP and CIP awards have been granted since 2020.
7	 Interests qualifying towards the shareholding requirement comprise ordinary shares beneficially held at 31 December 2024 (or date of stepping down from the Board if earlier) by the executive and their spouse/partner and the post tax value (53%) of outstanding DSBP awards and any other share options which 
have vested but have not been exercised. 
8	 Shareholding as a % of salary is calculated based on the Executive Director’s salary as at 31 December 2024 (or date of stepping down from the Board if earlier).
9	 Pete Redfern stepped down from the Board and ceased employment on 10 March 2025.

110
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
During 2024 the following awards were exercised:
Nick Roberts
Exercise date
Number of 
shares
Price per share
2019 Performance Share Plan
20 September 2024
83,882
£9.274
Director’s shareholding and share interests – Non-executive Directors
Non-executive Director
Beneficial shareholding
(as at 28 February 2025)
Beneficial shareholding
(as at 31 December 2024 
or stepping down from the 
Board if earlier)
Beneficial shareholding
(as at 31 December 2023)
Geoff Drabble
31,109
31,109
–
Jasmine Whitbread
–
6,660
6,660
Coline McConville
–
–
4,003
Pete Redfern
252,966
252,966
10,012
Marianne Culver
728
728
728
Heath Drewett
–
–
–
Jora Gill
–
–
–
Louise Hardy
–
–
–
Jez Maiden
1,000
1,000
1,000
There were no material changes in Directors’ share ownership between 31 December 2024 and 28 February 2025. 

111
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Unaudited information
Service contracts
Each of the Executive Directors has a service contract, which will be available for inspection at the Annual General Meeting or at the Group’s registered office. These contracts provide for six months’ notice from the Directors 
and 12 months’ notice from the Group. They do not specify any particular level of compensation in the event of termination or change of control. Details of the Group’s policy on payments in respect of loss of office are provided 
in the Directors’ remuneration policy.
The dates Executive Directors service contracts were entered into are as follows:
•	 Pete Redfern (stepped down from the Board and ceased employment on 10 March 2025) – 16 September 2024
•	 Duncan Cooper – 9 January 2024
Non-executive Directors do not have a service contract, but each has received a letter of appointment which will be available for inspection at the Annual General Meeting or at the Group’s registered office.
Non-executive Directors’ and the Chair’s letters of appointment do not have expiry dates, however, other than in the most exceptional circumstances, Non-executive Directors and the Chair of the Board will not serve for more 
than nine years.
Director
Expiry of appointment letter
Geoff Drabble
October 2034
Marianne Culver
November 2028
Heath Drewett
May 2030
Jora Gill
August 2030
Louise Hardy
January 2032
Jez Maiden
June 2032
In accordance with best practice, the Non-executive Directors stand for re-election annually.
No compensation is payable on termination of the employment of Non-executive Directors, which may be with or without notice.
Funding of equity awards
Both executive incentive arrangements and entitlements under the HMRC approved all-colleague Sharesave scheme are satisfied by shares purchased in the market. Shares purchased in the market are held by a trust and the 
voting rights relating to the shares are exercisable by the Trustees in accordance with their fiduciary duties. As at 31 December 2024, the trust held 1,192,183 shares.

112
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
Total shareholder return performance graph
For comparative purposes the FTSE 350 index has been selected as this is the index of which the Group was a member during the reporting year.
Total shareholder return
200
150
100
50
0
Jan 15
Dec 24
Dec 14
Dec 16
Dec 17
Dec 18
Dec 19
Dec 20
Dec 21
Dec 22
Dec 23
Travis Perkins plc
FTSE 350
TSR is rebased to 100 from 1 January 2015.
Historical CEO pay
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
Single figure remuneration (£000)
£2,360
£2,575
£2,532
£2,258
£2,622
£696
£4,446
£1,905
£1,091
£802
Annual bonus payout (% of maximum)
32%
24%
72%
35%
89%
–
97%
0%
0%
0%
Vesting of Restricted Share Plan (% of maximum)
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
100%
0%
Vesting of Performance Share Plan (% of maximum)
97%
54%
40%
40%
46%
40%
94%
65%
–
–
Vesting of Co-Investment Plan (% of maximum)
44%
97%
100%
100%
100%
100%
100%
100%
–
–
Data for 2015-2018 relates to John Carter. Date for 2019 relates to both John Carter and Nick Roberts reflecting their tenure in the role of CEO during the year. Data for 2020-2023 relates to Nick Roberts. Data for 2024 relates 
to both Nick Roberts and Pete Redfern reflecting their tenure in the role of CEO during the year.

113
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CEO to all-employee pay ratio
The following table provides pay ratio data in respect of the CEO’s total remuneration compared to the 25th, 50th and 75th percentile employees.
Year
Method
25th percentile 
pay ratio
Median 
pay ratio
75th percentile 
pay ratio
2024
Option A
30
27
22
2023
Option A
45
39
32
2022
Option A
79
69
56
2021
Option A
206
168
134
2020
Option A
37
30
23
2019
Option A
133
109
81
The employees used for the purposes of the table above were identified on a full-time equivalent basis as at 31 December 2024. Option A was chosen as it is considered to be the most accurate way of identifying the relevant 
employees. Employee pay includes salary, allowances, overtime, bonus, commission, benefits and share plan proceeds. For the purpose of the calculation employee pay has been standardised to the equivalent of a 40-hour 
working week and mid-year joiners and leavers have been excluded to ensure a like-for-like comparison from one year to the next. 
The following table provides salary and total remuneration information in respect of the employees at each quartile:
Year
Element of pay
25th percentile 
employee
Median 
employee
75th percentile 
employee
2024
Salary
£25,355
£28,007
£32,654
Total remuneration
£27,019
£30,144
£35,841
The ratio is consistent with the Group’s wider policies on employee pay, reward and progression. There is a decrease in the CEO pay ratio for 2024. This reflects the fact that there was no bonus payout for 2024 and no long-
term incentive value reported under the 2022 RSP award. There are no changes attributable to changes in the Group’s employment model nor in the methodology used to calculate the ratio.

114
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
Change in remuneration of Directors
The following table sets out the year-on-year percentage change in remuneration for the Executive and Non-executive Directors relative to the wider workforce.
Percentage change in salary/fee earned
Percentage change in bonus earned
Percentage change in taxable benefits received
2024
2023
2022
2021
2020
2024
2023
2022
2021
2020
2024
2023
2022
2021
2020
Comparative employee group1
5.9%
5.8%
5.2%
1.5%
1.7%
(10.8%)
(72.9%)
(74.8%) 
69.0%
(38.0%)
5%
4%
13%
(8.5%)2
8.4%
Executive Directors
CEO – Pete Redfern5
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
CFO – Duncan Cooper5
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Former Executive Directors
CEO – Nick Roberts3
(28.0%)
3.7%
2.4%
5.3%
(4.0%)
–
–
(100.0%)
97.0%
(89.0%)
(29.6%)
4.3%
1.1%
1.4%
0.0%
CFO – Alan Williams3
(91.6%)
3.8%
2.1%
5.3%
(3.5%)
–
–
(100.0%)
97.0%
(89.0%) 
(90.5%)
(39.8)%
–
(6.9%)
(5.0%)
Non-executive Directors
Jasmine Whitbread4
(58.4%)
–
32.8%
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Geoff Drabble5
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Marianne Culver
–
4.9%
1.7%
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Heath Drewett4
1.2%
2.5%
71.7%
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Jora Gill
1.3%
7.0%
184.0%
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Louise Hardy5
27.7%
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Jez Maiden6
386.7%
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
1	
The comparator group is all colleagues within the Merchanting and Toolstation businesses and central functions. Travis Perkins plc is a non-employing entity and so is not used for comparative purposes.
2	 During 2021, the Group began to replace the company car fleet with a cash allowance. The reduction reflects the difference between the P11d value and the cash allowance.
3	 During 2020 Nick Roberts and Alan Williams took a pay cut of 20% for a period of three months. The increase in 2021 reflects the reinstatement of this temporary reduction in salary. They received no underlying salary increase in 2021.
4	 Jasmine Whitbread, Heath Drewett and Jora Gill were appointed during 2021, and therefore the higher fees received in 2023 reflect the comparison of a full year to a part year.
5	 Geoff Drabble, Pete Redfern and Duncan Cooper were appointed during 2024, and therefore no prior year comparison is shown for these Directors. Pete Redfern stepped down from the Board and ceased employment on 10 March 2025.
6	 Jez Maiden was appointed Interim Chair for part of 2024 and the increase in his fees for 2024 reflects that appointment.

115
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Relative importance of spend on pay
Capital expenditure is shown, for comparison, as an indicator of investment by the Group in future growth. It includes funds invested in the purchase of property, plant and equipment. Corporation tax is included as an indicator 
of wider societal contribution facilitated by the Group’s operations and is the actual amount of corporation tax paid in the relevant reporting periods.
2024
2023
Distribution to shareholders
23
82
Capital expenditure
76
142
Corporation tax
21
41
Employee remuneration
640
665
Governance
During the year the Committee comprised Louise Hardy, Marianne Culver and Heath Drewett, all of whom are independent Non-executive Directors, and Jasmine Whitbread, Chair of the Board, and Jez Maiden, Interim Chair of 
the Board, who were independent on appointment.
Deloitte was appointed by the Committee in December 2015, following an interview process, to provide independent advice on executive remuneration. Deloitte are founding members of the Remuneration Consultants Code of 
Conduct and adhere to this Code in its dealings with the Committee. The Committee is satisfied that the advice provided by Deloitte is objective and independent. The Committee is comfortable that the Deloitte engagement 
partner and team that provides remuneration advice to the Committee do not have connections with the Group or its Directors that may impair their independence. The Committee reviewed the potential for conflicts of interest 
and judged that there were appropriate safeguards against such conflicts.
Deloitte provided additional services to the Group in relation to remuneration including support in developing and implementing remuneration proposals, compensation benchmarking and other tax and consulting services. Fees 
are charged on a time and materials basis. During the year Deloitte was paid £74,400 for advice provided to the Committee. For the 2025 financial year Deloitte was appointed as the Group’s external auditors. Deloitte therefore 
stepped down as advisers to the Committee on 31 December 2024. Korn Ferry has subsequently been appointed as the new advisers to the Committee.
In addition Pete Redfern, Nick Roberts, Duncan Cooper, Alan Williams, Robin Miller, Emma Rose (Chief Human Resources Officer), Jane Davies (Chief Human Resources Officer) and Leonie Clarke (Group Reward Director) have 
assisted the Committee in its work and attended Committee meetings where appropriate. No individual is involved in the setting of their own remuneration.
Responsibilities
The Remuneration Committee is responsible for developing and implementing the remuneration policy within the Group. It determines and agrees with the Board the policy for the remuneration and benefits of the Chair, 
Executive Directors and Group Leadership Team members and other senior executives. The Committee also oversees the administration of the Group’s share plans. The Committee’s terms of reference are available on the 
Travis Perkins plc website (www.travisperkinsplc.co.uk) or on request from the Company Secretary.

116
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED
Key items discussed in 2024 meetings
The Remuneration Committee held three routinely scheduled meetings during the year, with four additional meetings. The Remuneration Committee discussed the following matters:
Date
Key issues considered
25 January
•	 Approval of annual salary review for Executive Directors and the Group Leadership Team
•	 Review of annual bonus design and targets for 2024
•	 Review of interim RSP awards for key talent below the Group Leadership Team
26 February
•	 Approval of remuneration policy ahead of 2024 AGM
•	 Approval of 2023 Directors’ remuneration report
•	 Approval of recruitment award for the Chief Financial Officer
•	 Approval of annual bonus targets for 2024
•	 Approval of outturn of 2023 annual bonus scheme and 2024 deferred share bonus plan awards
•	 Approval of vesting of 2021 long-term incentive awards (RSP)
•	 Approval of grant of 2024 RSP awards, including consideration of windfall gains
•	 Review of shareholding vs requirement for the Group Leadership Team
26 April
•	 Approval of remuneration for a member of the Group Leadership Team
14 May
•	 Approval of remuneration for a member of the Group Leadership Team
16 September
•	 Review of outstanding RSP awards made in 2022, 2023 and 2024
•	 Approval of RSP leaver treatment for a senior leader (below the Group Leadership Team)
25 October
•	 Review vesting outlook for outstanding RSP awards
12 December
•	 Review of annual bonus design for 2025
•	 Review of long-term incentives
•	 Review of 2024 Directors’ remuneration report
•	 Context and considerations for the 2025 annual salary review for the wider workforce
•	 Performance update on the 2024 annual bonus scheme

117
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Shareholder voting
The following resolutions in relation to remuneration were put to the Group’s AGM (2023 Directors’ remuneration report and 2023 Policy):
Resolution
Votes for
For (%)
Votes against
Against (%)
Votes withheld
To receive and approve the 2023 Directors’ remuneration report (2024 AGM)
136,424,127
82.12%
29,703,631
17.88%
4,192
To receive and approve the Directors’ remuneration policy (2024 AGM)
131,336,551
79.06%
34,790,676
20.94%
4,723
The Directors’ Remuneration report has been approved by the Board of Directors and is signed on its behalf by:
Louise Hardy
Chair of the Remuneration Committee
31 March 2025

118
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
The Directors present their annual 
report and audited accounts of Travis 
Perkins plc and its subsidiaries  
(the “Group”) for the year ended  
31 December 2024. The report  
sets out information required to be 
included by the Companies Act 
2006 (the “Act”), and the applicable 
Financial Conduct Authority (“FCA”) 
UK Listing Rules (UKLR 6.6) and 
Disclosure Guidance and Transparency 
Rules (the “DTR”). Certain information 
is incorporated into this report by 
reference and can be located in the 
sections outlined below.
Disclosure 
Page
Corporate Governance report 
74-77
Directors’ details 
72-73
Directors’ interests 
90-117
Future business developments 
10-20
Greenhouse gas emissions 
15
Climate change risk management  
and governance 
48-56
Principal risks and uncertainties 
59-69
Financial risk management 
24-25
Employee engagement 
41 
Employee share plans 
169-170
Long-term incentive schemes 
90-117
Dividend waivers 
157
Number of employees and related costs 
168
Business review
A review of the Group’s position, developments, 
activities in the field of research and development 
and a review of the key events affecting the Group in 
the last financial year can be found on pages 2 to 70 
and is also incorporated into this report by reference. 
The Group operates predominantly in the UK with 
Toolstation branches also trading in Belgium and The 
Netherlands. The Group also has a sourcing office 
in China and a branch in the Republic of Ireland. 
During 2024 the Group also had 51 Toolstation 
stores in France, all of which were either sold or 
closed in the year.
Articles of Association
The Company’s Articles of Association (the 
“Articles”) may only be amended by special 
resolution at a general meeting of the Shareholders. 
The Articles can be viewed on the Group’s 
website at: www.travisperkinsplc.co.uk/about-us/
governance/.
Board of Directors
The names, biographies and committee 
memberships of all Directors as at the date of this 
Annual Report are provided in the biographies on 
pages 72 to 73 and details of the Directors that held 
office during the 2024 financial year are set out 
within the Corporate governance report in the table 
on page 76. The powers and responsibilities of the 
Directors are set out in the Corporate governance 
report on page 75. The appointment and removal 
of Directors is regulated by the Articles, the Act, 
the UK Corporate Governance Code (the “Code”) 
and related legislation. Under Article 83 of the 
Articles all Directors are required to retire and seek 
re-election annually and accordingly all will do so 
at the Annual General Meeting. All Directors as at 
the date of the Annual report and Accounts are 
recommended for re-election on the basis of their 
skills, experience and the value of their contributions 
to the Board and the Company’s long-term 
sustainable success.
Details of the service agreements for Executive 
Directors and letters of appointment for Non-
executive Directors and the Chair of the Board are 
set out in the Director’s remuneration report on 
pages 90 to 117 and are available for inspection at 
the Company’s registered office. Executive Directors 
have rolling 12-month notice periods in their 
contracts.
Directors’ conflicts of interest
Directors have a statutory duty to avoid a situation 
where they have or may have a direct or indirect 
interest that conflicts or may conflict with the 
Company’s interests. The Articles permit Directors 
to authorise a potential conflict of interest to 
the extent permitted by law. During the year, no 
Director had any material interest in any contract 
of significance of the Group’s business. The 
disclosable interests of Directors at 31 December 
2024, including holdings, if any, of persons 
closely associated are provided in the Director’s 
remuneration report on pages 90 to 117.
Directors’ indemnities
Article 143 of the Articles permits the Company 
to indemnify any person who is or was a Director, 
or a Director of any associated company against 
any loss or liability in relation to the Company or 
associated company, to the extent permitted by law. 
The Company has granted such indemnities to its 
Directors and directors of associated companies 
and these remain in force in the year ending 31 
December 2024. The Company maintains Directors’ 
and Officers’ liability insurance cover in respect of 
potential legal action brought against its Directors 
and directors of associated companies.

119
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Major shareholdings
Information received by the Company pursuant to DTR 5.3.1(1) is published on a Regulatory Information 
Service and the Company’s website. As at 31 December 2024, the Company has received notification of the 
following holdings of voting rights in its shares (based on the most recent notification received in the case of 
multiple notifications). The information provided below was correct at the date of notification, however that date 
of notification may not have been during 2024. These holdings are likely to have changed since the Company 
was notified, however further notification is not required until the next notifiable threshold is crossed.
Direct/Indirect
Number of voting 
rights held
Voting Rights (%)
Pzena Investment Management, Inc
Indirect
15,587,458
6.9%
Ameriprise Financial, Inc
Indirect
11,121,830
5.2%
Schroders Plc
Indirect
11,136,777
5.2%
BlackRock, Inc. 
Indirect 
11,133,331
5.2%
Sprucegrove Investment Management Ltd
Indirect
10,664,077
5.0%
Artemis Investment Management LLP
Direct/Indirect
10,751,952
4.6%
Pursuant to UKLR 6.6.6R(2), the Company confirms that between 31 December 2024 and 17 March 2025 
there have been no further disclosures made to the Company in accordance with DTR 5. 
Results and dividend
The Group’s results for the year ending 31 December 2024 are set out in the income statement on page 131 
and dividends for the year ending 31 December 2024 are set out in note 21. The Directors recommend a 
final dividend of 9.0 pence per share for approval at the Company’s Annual General Meeting. If approved 
by shareholders, the final dividend will be paid on 29 May 2025 to those shareholders on the register at the 
close of business on 22 April 2025.
Balance sheet and post-balance sheet events
The balance sheet on page 133 shows the Group’s financial position.
Employees
A full statement on employee matters can be found in the Sustainability report on pages 36 to 42 and 
an overview of the Company’s approach to diversity can be found in the Sustainability report and the 
Nominations Committee report on pages 38 and 81. The Group’s Encouraging Equal Treatment Policy 
aims to ensure recruitment, employment and promotion decisions are based solely on an individual’s 
ability and potential, regardless of their gender, race, colour, ethnic origin, sexual orientation, religious belief, 
age, disability, marital status (including civil partnership), pregnancy, maternity or gender reassignment. In 
particular, applications for employment by disabled persons are always fully and fairly considered, bearing 
in mind the aptitudes of the person concerned. In the event of a member of staff becoming disabled, every 
effort is made to ensure that their employment with the Group continues, including making any reasonable 
adjustments to their role, and that appropriate training is arranged. It is the policy of the Company that the 
training, career development and promotion of disabled persons should, as far as possible, be identical to 
that of other employees.
The Group’s practices are designed to keep employees informed on matters relevant to them, including 
the Group’s financial performance and strategy, through regular meetings and communications. In October 
2024 the Group conducted its latest “Your Voice Our Future” colleague engagement survey to enable 
colleagues to give feedback on issues affecting them. Your Voice Our Future provides valuable insight 
into colleague priorities and concerns. Areas for improvement are identified and action plans to improve 
are developed with colleagues and implemented accordingly. The results of the survey are used to inform 
the Group’s approach to policies, the working environment, working practices and diversity and inclusion, 
amongst other matters. The Company has a designated workforce engagement Non-executive Director, 
Louise Hardy, to bring the colleague voice into the Boardroom. The majority of colleagues with more than 
three months consecutive service are eligible to join the Group’s Sharesave scheme, enabling them to 
benefit from the Group’s growth and success. Full details of employee share plans are available in the 
Directors’ remuneration report on pages 90 to 117.
Modern slavery
The Group recognises the harmful impact that Modern Slavery and human trafficking has on society and is 
committed to ensuring its business and supply chain is free from this criminal activity. The Group produces 
a slavery and human trafficking statement each financial year. The latest statement can be found on the 
Company’s website at: www.travisperkinsplc.co.uk/modern-slavery-statement/.

120
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ REPORT CONTINUED
Political donations
The Group’s policy is not to make donations to political parties. The Group did not give any money for 
political purposes nor did it make any donations to political organisations or independent candidates or  
incur any political expenditure during the year.
Statement on disclosure of information to the external auditor
Each of the persons who is a Director at the date of approval of this report confirms that:
•	 so far as the Director is aware, there is no relevant audit information of which the Company’s auditor is 
unaware; and
•	 the Director has taken all reasonable steps that they ought to have taken as a Director in order to make 
themselves aware of any relevant audit information and to establish that the Company’s auditor is aware  
of that information.
This confirmation is given and should be interpreted in accordance with the provisions of s418 of the Act.
Share capital and change of control
As at 31 December 2024 the Company had an allotted and fully paid share capital of 212,509,334 ordinary 
shares of 11.205105 pence each with voting rights and an aggregate nominal value of £23,811,894.01, 
including shares owned by the Travis Perkins Employee Share Ownership Trust. The ordinary shares are 
listed on the London Stock Exchange and all shares rank pari passu. As at 31 December 2024, there were no 
ordinary shares of the Company held in treasury. There are no restrictions on voting rights attached to the 
Company’s ordinary shares. The Company is not aware of any agreements between holders of securities 
that may result in restrictions on the transfer of securities or on voting rights. The rights and obligations 
attaching to its shares are set out in the Articles. Fully paid shares in the Company are freely transferable. 
There are no persons that hold securities carrying special rights with regard to the control of the Company. 
Details of the structure of the Company’s share capital and changes in the share capital during the year 
are also included in the notes to the financial statements on page 156. As at 31 December 2024 the Travis 
Perkins Employee Share Ownership Trust owned 1,192,183 shares in the Company (0.56% of issued share 
capital) for use in connection with the Company’s share schemes. Any voting or other similar decisions 
relating to those shares would be taken by the trustees, who may take account of any recommendation of 
the Company. There are no rights attached to shares under employee share schemes, save for the right to 
acquire shares pursuant to options granted under those schemes in accordance with and subject to their 
rules. There are a number of agreements to which the Company is a party that may take effect, alter or 
terminate upon a change of control following a takeover bid. None of these agreements are considered 
significant in the context of the Company as a whole. The Company does not have agreements with any 
Director or any employee that would provide compensation for loss of office or employment resulting from 
a takeover except for that provisions of the Company’s share schemes and plans may cause options and 
awards granted to employees under such schemes and plans to vest on a takeover.
The Directors’ Report has been approved by the Board of Directors and is signed on its behalf by:
Robin Miller
General Counsel & Company Secretary
31 March 2025

121
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
DIRECTORS’ STATEMENT OF RESPONSIBILITIES
The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report and the Group and Parent Company financial 
statements in accordance with applicable law and regulations. Company law requires the Directors to prepare 
Group and Parent Company financial statements for each financial year. Under that law they are required to 
prepare the Group financial statements in accordance with UK-adopted international accounting standards and 
applicable law and have elected to prepare the Parent Company financial statements in accordance with UK 
accounting standards and applicable law, including FRS 101 Reduced Disclosure Framework. Under company 
law, the Directors must not approve the financial statements unless they are satisfied that they give a true 
and fair view of the state of affairs of the Group and Parent Company and of the Group’s profit or loss for that 
period. In preparing each of the Group and Parent Company financial statements, the Directors are required to:
•	 Select suitable accounting policies and then apply them consistently.
•	 Make judgements and estimates that are reasonable, relevant, and reliable and, in respect of the Parent 
Company financial statements only, prudent.
•	 For the Group financial statements, state whether they have been prepared in accordance with UK-adopted 
international accounting standards.
•	 For the Parent Company financial statements, state whether applicable UK accounting standards have been 
followed, subject to any material departures disclosed and explained in the Parent Company financial 
statements.
•	 Assess the Group and Parent Company’s ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, 
matters related to going concern.
•	 Use the going concern basis of accounting unless they either intend to liquidate the Group or the Parent 
Company or to cease operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so.
The Directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting records that are sufficient to show and 
explain the Parent Company’s transactions and disclose with reasonable accuracy at any time the financial 
position of the Parent Company and enable them to ensure that its financial statements comply with the 
Companies Act 2006. They are responsible for such internal control as they determine is necessary to 
enable the preparation of financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to 
fraud or error and have general responsibility for taking such steps as are reasonably open to them to 
safeguard the assets of the Group and to prevent and detect fraud and other irregularities.
Under applicable law and regulations, the Directors are also responsible for preparing a Strategic report, 
Directors’ report, Directors’ remuneration report and Corporate governance statement that complies with 
that law and those regulations. 
The Directors are responsible for the maintenance and integrity of the corporate and financial information 
included on the Company’s website. Legislation in the UK governing the preparation and dissemination of 
financial statements may differ from legislation in other jurisdictions. 
In accordance with Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rule (“DTR”) 4.1.14R, the financial statements 
will form part of the Annual financial report prepared under DTR 4.1.17R and 4.1.18R. The auditor’s report 
on these financial statements provides no assurance over whether the annual financial report has been 
prepared in accordance with those requirements.
Responsibility statement of the Directors in respect of the annual financial report 
We confirm that to the best of our knowledge:
•	 The financial statements, prepared in accordance with the applicable set of accounting standards, give a true 
and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial position and profit or loss of the Company and the 
undertakings included in the consolidation taken as a whole.
•	 The Strategic report includes a fair review of the development and performance of the business and the 
position of the issuer and the undertakings included in the consolidation taken as a whole, together with a 
description of the principal risks and uncertainties that they face.
We consider the Annual Report and Accounts, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and 
provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s position and performance, 
business model and strategy.
The Statement of Directors’ responsibilities has been approved by the Board and is signed on its behalf by: 
Geoff Drabble	
	
	
	
Duncan Cooper
Chair	
	
	
	
	
Chief Financial Officer
31 March 2025	
	
	
	
31 March 2025

122
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Contents
123	 Independent Auditor’s report
131	
Consolidated income statement
132	 Consolidated statement of comprehensive income
133	 Consolidated balance sheet
134	 Consolidated statement of changes in equity
135	 Consolidated cash flow statement
136	 Notes to the consolidated financial statements
172	 Company balance sheet
173	 Company statement of changes in equity
174	
Notes to the Company’s financial statements
181	
Five-year summary

123
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT
to the members of Travis Perkins plc
1.  Our opinion is unmodified
We have audited the financial statements of Travis Perkins plc (“the Company”) for the year ended  
31 December 2024 which comprise the Consolidated Income Statement, the Consolidated Statement of 
Comprehensive Income, the Consolidated and Company Balance Sheets, the Consolidated and Company 
Statements of Changes in Equity, the Consolidated Cash Flow Statement, and the related notes, including 
the accounting policies included within the respective note to the financial statements.
In our opinion:
•	 the financial statements give a true and fair view of the state of the Group’s and of the Parent Company’s 
affairs as at 31 December 2024 and of the Group’s loss for the year then ended;
•	 the Group financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with UK-adopted international 
accounting standards;
•	 the Parent Company financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with UK accounting 
standards, including FRS 101 Reduced Disclosure Framework; and
•	 the financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006.
Basis for opinion
We conducted our audit in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK) (“ISAs (UK)”) and 
applicable law. Our responsibilities are described below. We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained 
is a sufficient and appropriate basis for our opinion. Our audit opinion is consistent with our report to the 
Audit Committee.
We were first appointed as auditor by the shareholders on 28 May 2015. The period of total uninterrupted 
engagement is for the ten financial years ended 31 December 2024. We have fulfilled our ethical 
responsibilities under, and we remain independent of the Group in accordance with, UK ethical requirements 
including the FRC Ethical Standard as applied to listed public interest entities. No non-audit services 
prohibited by that standard were provided.
Overview
Materiality:
Group financial 
statements as a whole
£9.5m (2023: £10.0m)
4.8% (2023: 4.4%) of adjusted normalised Group profit before tax from  
continuing operations
Key audit matters vs 2023
Recurring risks
Accounting for inventory 
Parent Company’s key audit matter: Recoverability of parent 
Company’s investment in Travis Perkins Group Holdings Limited 
New risks
Recoverability of goodwill in respect of the Travis Perkins 
General Merchant (TPGM) and Toolstation Benelux groups  
of cash generating units
General ledger migration
2.  Key audit matters: our assessment of risks of material misstatement
Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional judgement, were of most significance in the 
audit of the financial statements and include the most significant assessed risks of material misstatement 
(whether or not due to fraud) identified by us, including those which had the greatest effect on: the overall 
audit strategy; the allocation of resources in the audit; and directing the efforts of the engagement team. 
We summarise below the key audit matters, in decreasing order of audit significance, in arriving at our audit 
opinion above, together with our key audit procedures to address those matters and, as required for public 
interest entities, our results from those procedures. These matters were addressed, and our results are 
based on procedures undertaken, in the context of, and solely for the purpose of, our audit of the financial 
statements as a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon, and consequently are incidental to that opinion, 
and we do not provide a separate opinion on these matters.

124
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT CONTINUED
to the members of Travis Perkins plc
The risk
Our response
General ledger 
migration
(Included within trade 
and other payables of 
£836 million)
Refer to page 84 (Audit 
Committee report).
Data processing
On 1 July 2024, as part of the groups ongoing Finance Transformation programme certain 
material components of the group migrated to a new ERP system. Following implementation 
those businesses experienced a number of challenges associated with the processing of 
transactions through the system. This primarily impacted the processing of supplier invoices 
in a timely manner. These issues increase the risk of errors in the completeness and accuracy 
of the impacted accounts associated with the purchase to pay and related processes, 
including the direct sales accrual.
We performed the tests below rather than seeking to rely on any of the Group’s controls because the inherent 
nature of the challenges associated with the implementation of the new ERP system indicated that we would 
expect to obtain audit evidence primarily through the detailed procedures described.
Our procedures included:
•	 Tests of detail: For a risk-based selection of suppliers we obtained reconciliations of the outstanding balance 
as stated by the supplier to amounts recognised in the general ledger. We corroborated the accuracy of the 
reconciling items on a sample basis by agreeing to supporting documentation.
We verified the accuracy of the year end cash position by obtaining independent confirmation of the balances. 
We critically assessed the appropriateness of reconciling items and where relevant obtained supporting 
documentation. 
We performed a search for unrecorded liabilities test for a sample of items settled by the Group after the year 
end to validate that they were appropriately accrued in the year end balance sheet.
Our results:
The results of our testing were satisfactory, and we found the supplier liabilities recognised to be acceptable.
Recoverability of 
goodwill in respect 
of the Travis Perkins 
General Merchant 
(TPGM) and 
Toolstation Benelux 
groups of cash 
generating units
(£540 million;  
2023: £542million)
Refer to page 86 (Audit 
Committee report) and 
page 165 (accounting 
policy and financial 
disclosures).
Forecast based assessment
The TPGM group of CGUs is at significant risk of impairment due to suppressed demand 
arising from the challenging economic environment in the UK, including the impact of 
sustained elevated interest rates and a reduction in the construction of new housing stock. 
The estimated recoverable amount of TPGM is subjective due to the inherent uncertainty 
involved in forecasting and discounting future cash flows. There is also a fraud risk as the 
directors may be incentivised to overstate the forecast cashflows in order to avoid an 
impairment given the significance of this CGU to the Group.
The recoverable amount is sensitive to changes in key assumptions, principally relating to 
revenue growth, operating profit margin and discount rates. Changes to these key 
assumptions could have a material impact on the carrying value of the associated goodwill. 
The Toolstation Benelux group of CGUs is an immature business and during 2024 was 
subject to a change in strategy to focus on short term profitability rather than long term 
growth. The estimated recoverable amount of Toolstation Benelux is subjective due to the 
inherent uncertainty involved in forecasting and discounting future cash flows, particularly 
in an immature business.
The recoverable amount is sensitive to changes in key assumptions, principally relating to 
revenue growth, and discount rates. Changes to these key assumptions could have a 
material impact on the carrying value of the associated goodwill.
The effect of these matters is that, as part of our risk assessment, we determined that the 
recoverability of the TPGM and Toolstation Benelux goodwill has a high degree of 
estimation uncertainty, with a potential range of reasonable outcomes greater than our 
materiality for the financial statements as a whole, and possibly many times that amount. 
The financial statements (note 29) disclose the sensitivity estimated by the Group.
We performed the tests below rather than seeking to rely on any of the Group’s controls because the nature of the 
balance is such that we would expect to obtain audit evidence primarily through the detailed procedures described.
Our procedures included:
•	 Assessing methodology: We assessed whether the principles and integrity of the cash flow models used to 
estimate the recoverable amounts is in accordance with the relevant accounting standards;
•	 Sensitivity analysis: We performed sensitivity analysis using reasonably possible downside scenarios on the 
key assumptions , being those that were most sensitive to a change and assessed the impact on recoverable 
amount;
•	 Challenging assumptions: We challenged the key assumptions for each group of CGUs by benchmarking to 
third party sources;
•	 Our valuation experience: We independently determined an appropriate range of discount rates to be applied 
to the impairment model using our own valuation specialists;
•	 Historical comparisons: We evaluated the track record of historical assumptions used against actual results 
achieved; and
•	 Assessing transparency: We assessed whether the Group’s disclosures about the sensitivity of the outcome 
of the impairment assessments to a reasonably possible change in key assumptions reflected the risks 
inherent in the recoverable amount of goodwill.
Our results:
We found the Group’s conclusion that there is no impairment of the goodwill related to TPGM and Toolstation 
Benelux to be acceptable (2023: acceptable).

125
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
The risk
Our response
Accounting for 
inventory
(£649 million;  
2023: £728 million)
Refer to page 84 (Audit 
Committee report) and 
page 148 (accounting 
policy and financial 
disclosures).
Accounting for inventory (quantities and cost)
The Group holds a significant amount of inventory across its large branch network and a 
number of warehouses. The Group’s inventory is comprised of a very large number of 
products, typically held in large quantities, with high inventory turnover. The Group conducts 
periodic inventory counts and updates its inventory records to reflect the results of the 
counts. Cost is based on a weighted average purchase price. Whilst inventory is not 
considered to represent a significant risk of material misstatement, it is one of the matters 
that has the greatest effect on our overall audit strategy; the allocation of resources in the 
audit; and directing the efforts of the engagement team in order to conclude.
We performed the detailed tests below rather than seeking to rely on any of the Group’s controls because our 
knowledge of the design and implementation of these controls indicated that we would not be able to obtain the 
required evidence to support reliance on controls.
Our procedures included:
•	 Tests of detail: We counted a sample of inventory lines across a sample of the Group’s branches and 
warehouses and compared the results of our counts to the Group’s inventory records. Where our counts were 
performed prior to or just after the year-end date, we obtained evidence for any significant movements in 
inventory quantities to the year-end date.
We evaluated the results of our count procedures using statistical routines.
•	 Independent reperformance: We recalculated the net purchase prices attributed to a sample of individual 
inventory lines. This procedure included the use of a data and analytics procedure for certain inventory lines 
and substantive tests of detail for others.
Our results:
We found the accounting for inventory to be acceptable (2023: acceptable).
Recoverability of 
Parent Company’s 
investment in Travis 
Perkins Group 
Holdings Limited
(£2,417 million;  
2023: £1,922 million)
Refer to page 175 
(accounting policy and 
financial disclosures).
Low risk, high value
The parent company holds an investment in Travis Perkins Group Holdings Limited which 
in turn owns a significant majority of the Group’s trading businesses. This balance 
represents 99.8% (2023: 99.8%) of the parent Company’s total assets.
The recoverability of the investment is not at a high risk of material misstatement or  
subject to significant judgement. However, due to its materiality in the context of the parent 
Company financial statements, this is considered to be the area that had the greatest effect 
on our overall parent Company audit.
We performed the tests below rather than seeking to rely on any of the Group’s controls because the nature of the 
balance is such that we would expect to obtain audit evidence primarily through the detailed procedures described.
Our procedures included:
•	 Comparing valuations: Comparing the sum of the recoverable amounts prepared for the purposes of 
goodwill impairment testing to the carrying value of the investment to assess the recoverability;
•	 Comparing valuations: Comparing the enterprise value of the group implied by the market capitalisation to 
the carrying value of the investment to assess the recoverability and considered the possible explanations for 
the difference; and
•	 Comparing valuations: We compared the share price implied by the carrying value of the investment to the 
forward looking share price forecasts in stock market analyst reports.
Our results:
We found the parent Company’s conclusion that there is no impairment of its investment in subsidiaries to be 
acceptable (2023: acceptable)
We continue to perform procedures over gross defined benefit obligations. However, following changes in our overall assessment of the audit risks, we have not assessed this as one of the areas of most significance to our 
current year audit and, therefore, it is not separately identified in our report this year.

126
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
In total, we identified 6 components, having considered our evaluation of the existence of common risk profile 
across entities, the presence of key audit matters and our ability to perform audit procedures centrally.
Of those, we identified 5 quantitatively significant components which contained the largest percentages of 
either total revenue or total assets of the Group, for which we performed audit procedures.
Additionally, having considered qualitative and quantitative factors, we selected 1 component with accounts 
contributing to the specific RMMs of the Group financial statements.
Accordingly, we performed audit procedures on 6 components, of which we involved component auditors in 
performing the audit work on 2 components.
We performed audit procedures on the items excluded from the normalised Group profit before tax used as 
the benchmark for our materiality.
We set the component materialities, ranging from £4.8m to £7.6m, having regard to the mix of size and risk 
profile of the Group across the components.
Our audit procedures covered 95% of Group revenue. We performed audit procedures in relation to 
components that accounted for 97% of Group profit before tax and 94% of Group total assets.
For the remaining components for which we performed no audit procedures, no component represented 
more than 2.7% of Group total revenue, Group profit before tax or Group total assets. We performed analysis 
at an aggregated Group level to re-examine our assessment that there is not a reasonable possibility of a 
material misstatement in these components.
Impact of controls on our group audit
We identified the main Enterprise Resource Planning (‘ERP’) finance systems as the key IT systems relevant 
to our Group audit.
The Group has operated four ERP systems during the course of the current year across the in-scope 
components of the Group, which are managed from a centralised IT function primarily in the UK. With the 
assistance of our IT auditors, we obtained an understanding of these IT systems.
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT CONTINUED
to the members of Travis Perkins plc
3.  Our application of materiality and an overview of the scope of our audit
Our application of materiality
Materiality for the Group financial statements as a whole was set at £9.5m (2023: £10.0m), determined with 
reference to a benchmark of adjusted normalised Group profit before tax from continuing operations (2023: 
adjusted normalised Group profit before tax from continuing operations) of £194m (2023: £229m) of which it 
represents 4.8% (2023: 4.4%). In 2024 we normalised the benchmark by adding back adjusting items that do 
not represent the normal, continuing operations of the Group, and by averaging the benchmark over 4 years. 
The items we adjusted for were Administrative expenses- adjusting items disclosed in note 3. We selected 4 
years to average the benchmark to account for the fluctuations in the business Group’s performance driven by 
temporary macro economic factors that have had impact on the overall profitability of the Group.
Materiality for the parent Company financial statements as a whole was set at £7.6m (2023: £8.0m), 
determined with reference to a benchmark of the Parent Company total assets, of which it represents 0.3% 
(2023: 0.3%).
In line with our audit methodology, our procedures on individual account balances and disclosures were 
performed to a lower threshold, performance materiality, so as to reduce to an acceptable level the risk that 
individually immaterial misstatements in individual account balances add up to a material amount across the 
financial statements as a whole.
Performance materiality was set at 65% (2023: 65%) of materiality for the financial statements as a whole, 
which equates to £6.2m (2023: £6.5m) for the Group and £4.9m (2023: £5.2m) for the parent Company. 
We applied this percentage in our determination of performance materiality based on the level of identified 
misstatements in prior periods and our knowledge of the Group’s control environment.
We agreed to report to the Audit Committee any corrected or uncorrected identified misstatements 
exceeding £0.5m (2023: £0.4m), in addition to other identified misstatements that warranted reporting on 
qualitative grounds.
Overview of the scope of our audit
This year, we applied the revised group auditing standard in our audit of the consolidated financial 
statements. The revised standard changes how an auditor approaches the identification of components, and 
how the audit procedures are planned and executed across components.
In particular, the definition of a component has changed, shifting the focus from how the entity prepares 
financial information to how we, as the group auditor, plan to perform audit procedures to address group 
risks of material misstatement (“RMMs”). Similarly, the group auditor has an increased role in designing the 
audit procedures as well as making decisions on where these procedures are performed (centrally and/or at 
component level) and how these procedures are executed and supervised. As a result, we assess scoping 
and coverage in a different way and comparisons to prior period coverage figures are not meaningful. In this 
report we provide an indication of scope coverage on the new basis.
We performed risk assessment procedures to determine which of the Group’s components are likely to 
include risks of material misstatement to the Group financial statements and which procedures to perform 
at these components to address those risks.
Normalised Group profit before tax
£194m (2023: £229m)
Group materiality
£9.5m (2023: £10.0m)
£9.5m
Whole financial statements  
materiality (2023: £10.0m)
£6.2m
Whole financial statements performance 
materiality (2023: £6.5m)
£7.6m
Range of materiality at 6 components 
(£4.8m-£7.6m) (2023: £1.8m to £8.0m)
£0.5m
Misstatements reported to the audit 
committee 2023: £0.4m
Normalised PBT
Group materiality

127
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
The ERP that accounts for the majority of the Group’s transactions has transitioned from a legacy ERP to a 
new ERP in the current year as referenced in page 87 of the Audit Committee report. Due to the timing of 
the transition in the current year and the implementation challenges faced with processing transactions, we 
did not plan to rely on IT controls for the legacy and new ERP system. Our key audit matter in section 2 on 
general ledger migration explains the work we performed in response to the implementation challenges.
In addition to the primary ERP, the Group has two further ERPs that are used by smaller components where 
we performed audit procedures in our Group audit. Due to the relative size of these components, we deemed 
a fully substantive approach was most efficient and effective for gaining the appropriate audit evidence for 
in-scope components using these systems.
For most areas of the audit, given we did not rely on the related IT controls, we took a predominantly 
substantive audit approach and accordingly increased the extent of our substantive procedures. We 
considered this to be the most efficient and effective for gaining the appropriate audit evidence. We adopted 
a data-oriented approach to testing journals and used data and analytical routines to test revenue across a 
majority of components and inventory costing in some components.
We planned to rely on the operating effectiveness of manual controls over certain data inputs used in 
our revenue audit routines, but we were unable to due to certain deficiencies being identified. As a result, 
and given we did not rely on the related IT controls, a manual testing approach was performe dover the 
completeness and accuracy of data used in these routines and in respect of system data used in our 
substantive testing on other transactional areas. Refer to our key audit matter in section 2 in relation to 
inventory and the impact of controls on our approach.
Our audit procedures covered 
the following percentage of 
Group revenue:
We performed audit procedures in relation to components 
 that accounted for the following percentages of 
 Group profit before tax and Group total assets:
Group revenue
95%
95
Group total assets
94%
94
Group profit before tax
97%
97
Group auditor oversight
As part of establishing the overall Group audit strategy and plan, we conducted the risk assessment 
and planning discussion meetings with component auditors to discuss Group audit risks relevant to the 
components including the key audit matter in respect of accounting for inventory with a particular focus on 
stock costing and branch inventory accounts.
We issued Group audit instructions to component auditors on the scope and nature of their work, including 
specifying the minimum procedures to perform in their audit of inventory, pensions, cash and purchases.
All in scope components are based in the UK. We have held in- person, video and telephone conference 
meetings with the component auditors throughout the audit to discuss the results of planning procedures 
and further audit procedures.
We inspected the work performed by the component auditors for the purpose of the Group audit and evaluated 
the appropriateness of conclusions drawn from the audit evidence obtained and consistencies between 
communicated findings and work performed with a particular focus on stock costing and branch inventory counts.
4.  The impact of climate change on our audit
We have considered the potential impacts of climate change on the financial statements as part of planning 
our audit.
As the Group has set out on page 46, climate change has the potential to significantly impact the 
construction sector during the transition to a low carbon environment. The Group has stated their 
commitment to help the industry to decarbonise and has set out its own commitments to reduce carbon.
The areas of financial statements that are most likely to be potentially affected by climate related changes and 
initiatives are balances subject to forward looking assessments such as those subject to impairment tests and those 
being depreciated or amortised over an estimated useful life of assets. The Group considered the impact of climate 
change and the Group’s targets in the preparation of the financial statements, as described on page 146 in relation to 
the estimated useful economic life of property, plant and equipment and 165 in relation to impairment.
We performed a risk assessment, taking into account climate change risks and the commitments made 
by the Group. This included enquiries of key personnel and those charged with governance, consideration 
of the Group’s processes for assessing the potential impact of climate change risk on the Group’s financial 
statements, assessing the TCFD scenario analysis performed by the Group and reading the Group’s Carbon 
Disclosure Project submission.
Based on our risk assessment we determined that, taking into account the extent of headroom on goodwill 
and the nature and estimated useful economic life of property, plant and equipment, there are no significant 
risks of material misstatement in relation to climate change.
There was limited impact of climate change on our key audit matters included in section 2.
We have read the Group’s disclosure of climate related information in the front half of the annual report as set 
out on pages 43 to 58 and considered consistency with the financial statements and our audit knowledge.
5.  Going concern
The directors have prepared the financial statements on the going concern basis as they do not intend to 
liquidate the Group or the Company or to cease their operations, and as they have concluded that the Group’s 
and the Company’s financial position means that this is realistic. They have also concluded that there are no 
material uncertainties that could have cast significant doubt over their ability to continue as a going concern  
for at least a year from the date of approval of the financial statements (“the going concern period”).

128
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
5.  Going concern continued
We used our knowledge of the Group, its industry, and the uncertain economic environment to identify the 
inherent risks to the Group’s business model and analysed how those risks might affect the Group’s and 
Parent Company’s financial resources or ability to continue operations over the going concern period. The 
risk that we considered most likely to adversely affect the Group’s and parent Company’s available financial 
resources and metrics relevant to debt covenants over this period was adverse macroeconomic conditions 
resulting in lower than expected trading volumes.
We considered whether these risks could plausibly affect the liquidity or covenant compliance in the going 
concern period by comparing severe, but plausible downside scenarios that could arise from these risks 
individually and collectively against the level of available financial resources and covenants indicated by the 
Group’s financial forecasts.
Our procedures also included:
•	 Evaluating how the Group’s risk assessment process identifies business risks relating to events and 
conditions that may cast significant doubt on the ability to continue as a going concern and evaluating the 
models the Group uses in its assessment.
•	 Critically assessing the assumptions in the base case and downside scenarios relevant to liquidity and 
covenant metrics and the impacts of historical trends in severe economic situations and overlaying 
knowledge of the entity’s plans based on approved budgets and our knowledge of the entity and the sector 
in which it operates.
•	 Challenged the reasonableness of the Group’s budgets and forecasts and evaluated whether the growth 
targets are within a reasonable range.
•	 We considered whether the going concern disclosure in the ‘General Information’ section in the notes to the 
financial statements set out on page 136 gives a full and accurate description of the directors’ assessment of 
going concern, including the identified risks and dependencies.
Our conclusions based on this work:
•	 we consider that the directors’ use of the going concern basis of accounting in the preparation of the financial 
statements is appropriate;
•	 we have not identified, and concur with the directors’ assessment that there is not, a material uncertainty 
related to events or conditions that, individually or collectively, may cast significant doubt on the Group’s or 
Company’s ability to continue as a going concern for the going concern period;
•	 we have nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to the directors’ statement in the ‘General 
Information’ section on page 136 to the financial statements on the use of the going concern basis of 
accounting with no material uncertainties that may cast significant doubt over the Group and Company’s use 
of that basis for the going concern period, and we found the going concern disclosure in note 1 to be 
acceptable; and
•	 the related statement under the UK Listing Rules set out on page 77 is materially consistent with the financial 
statements and our audit knowledge.
However, as we cannot predict all future events or conditions and as subsequent events may result in 
outcomes that are inconsistent with judgements that were reasonable at the time they were made, the above 
conclusions are not a guarantee that the Group or the Company will continue in operation.
6.  Fraud and breaches of laws and regulations – ability to detect
Identifying and responding to risks of material misstatement due to fraud
To identify risks of material misstatement due to fraud (“fraud risks”) we assessed events or conditions that 
could indicate an incentive or pressure to commit fraud or provide an opportunity to commit fraud.
Our risk assessment procedures included:
•	 Enquiring of directors, the audit committee and internal audit and inspection of policy documentation as to 
the Group’s high-level policies and procedures to prevent and detect fraud, including the internal audit 
function, and the Group’s channel for “whistleblowing”, as well as whether they have knowledge of any 
actual, suspected or alleged fraud.
•	 Reading Board, audit committee, remuneration committee and nomination committee minutes.
•	 Considering remuneration incentive schemes and performance targets for Directors.
•	 Our forensic specialists assisting us in identifying key fraud risks. This included holding a discussion with the 
engagement partner and team and assisting with designing relevant audit procedures to respond to the 
identified fraud risks.
•	 Using analytical procedures to identify any unusual or unexpected relationships.
We communicated identified fraud risks throughout the audit team and remained alert to any indications of 
fraud throughout the audit. This included communication from the Group audit team to component audit teams 
of relevant fraud risks identified at the Group level and request to component audit teams to report to the 
Group audit team any instances of fraud that could give rise to a material misstatement at the Group level.
As required by auditing standards, and taking into account possible pressures, our overall knowledge of 
the control environment, to meet profit targets, we perform procedures to address the risk of management 
override of controls, in particular the risk that Group and component management may be in a position 
to make inappropriate accounting entries. On this audit we do not believe there is a fraud risk related 
to revenue recognition because sales are individually low value (high volume) across a high number of 
independently managed branches and there is no judgement in applying the revenue recognition criteria.
We identified a fraud risk related to the recoverability of goodwill in response to the weak economic 
environment within the construction sector and suppressed results of the business. Further detail is set out 
in section 2.
We performed procedures including:
•	 Identifying journal entries and other adjustments to test for all quantitatively significant components based 
on risk criteria and comparing the identified entries components to supporting documentation. These 
included those posted to unusual accounts.
•	 Assessing whether the judgements made in making accounting estimates are indicative of a potential bias.
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT CONTINUED
to the members of Travis Perkins plc

129
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Identifying and responding to risks of material misstatement due to non-compliance with laws and 
regulations
We identified areas of laws and regulations that could reasonably be expected to have a material effect on 
the financial statements from our general commercial and sector experience through discussion with the 
directors and other management (as required by auditing standards), and discussed with the directors and 
other management the policies and procedures regarding compliance with laws and regulations. As the 
Group is regulated, our assessment of risks involved gaining an understanding of the control environment 
including the entity’s procedures for complying with regulatory requirements.
We communicated identified laws and regulations throughout our team and remained alert to any 
indications of non-compliance throughout the audit. This included communication from the Group audit 
team to component audit teams of relevant laws and regulations identified at the Group level, and a request 
for component auditors to report to the Group audit team any instances of non-compliance with laws and 
regulations that could give rise to a material misstatement at the Group level.
The potential effect of these laws and regulations on the financial statements varies considerably.
Firstly, the Group is subject to laws and regulations that directly affect the financial statements including 
financial reporting legislation (including related companies legislation), distributable profits legislation, 
taxation legislation and pensions legislation and we assessed the extent of compliance with these laws and 
regulations as part of our procedures on the related financial statement items.
Secondly, the Group is subject to many other laws and regulations where the consequences of non-
compliance could have a material effect on amounts or disclosures in the financial statements, for instance 
through the imposition of fines or litigation. We identified the following areas as those most likely to have 
such an effect: health and safety, anti-bribery, employment law, climate change, responsible sourcing and 
import compliance. Auditing standards limit the required audit procedures to identify non-compliance with 
these laws and regulations to enquiry of the directors and other management and inspection of regulatory 
and legal correspondence, if any. Therefore if a breach of operational regulations is not disclosed to us or 
evident from relevant correspondence, an audit will not detect that breach.
Context of the ability of the audit to detect fraud or breaches of law or regulation
Owing to the inherent limitations of an audit, there is an unavoidable risk that we may not have detected 
some material misstatements in the financial statements, even though we have properly planned and 
performed our audit in accordance with auditing standards. For example, the further removed non-
compliance with laws and regulations is from the events and transactions reflected in the financial 
statements, the less likely the inherently limited procedures required by auditing standards would identify it.
In addition, as with any audit, there remained a higher risk of non-detection of fraud, as these may involve 
collusion, forgery, intentional omissions, misrepresentations, or the override of internal controls. Our audit 
procedures are designed to detect material misstatement. We are not responsible for preventing non-
compliance or fraud and cannot be expected to detect non-compliance with all laws and regulations.
7.  We have nothing to report on the other information in the Annual Report
The directors are responsible for the other information presented in the Annual Report together with the financial 
statements. Our opinion on the financial statements does not cover the other information and, accordingly, we do 
not express an audit opinion or, except as explicitly stated below, any form of assurance conclusion thereon.
Our responsibility is to read the other information and, in doing so, consider whether, based on our financial 
statements audit work, the information therein is materially misstated or inconsistent with the financial 
statements or our audit knowledge. Based solely on that work we have not identified material misstatements 
in the other information.
Strategic report and directors’ report
Based solely on our work on the other information:
•	 we have not identified material misstatements in the strategic report and the directors’ report;
•	 in our opinion the information given in those reports for the financial year is consistent with the financial 
statements; and
•	 in our opinion those reports have been prepared in accordance with the Companies Act 2006.
Directors’ remuneration report
In our opinion the part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report to be audited has been properly prepared in 
accordance with the Companies Act 2006.
Disclosures of emerging and principal risks and longer-term viability
We are required to perform procedures to identify whether there is a material inconsistency between the 
directors’ disclosures in respect of emerging and principal risks and the viability statement, and the financial 
statements and our audit knowledge.
Based on those procedures, we have nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to:
•	 the directors’ confirmation within the viability assessment on page 25 that they have carried out a robust 
assessment of the emerging and principal risks facing the Group, including those that would threaten its 
business model, future performance, solvency and liquidity;
•	 the Principal Risks disclosures describing these risks and how emerging risks are identified, and explaining 
how they are being managed and mitigated; and
•	 the directors’ explanation in the viability assessment of how they have assessed the prospects of the Group, 
over what period they have done so and why they considered that period to be appropriate, and their 
statement as to whether they have a reasonable expectation that the Group will be able to continue in 
operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due over the period of their assessment, including any related 
disclosures drawing attention to any necessary qualifications or assumptions.
We are also required to review the viability assessment, set out on page 25 under the UK Listing Rules. 
Based on the above procedures, we have concluded that the above disclosures are materially consistent with 
the financial statements and our audit knowledge.

130
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT CONTINUED
to the members of Travis Perkins plc
Our work is limited to assessing these matters in the context of only the knowledge acquired during our 
financial statements audit. As we cannot predict all future events or conditions and as subsequent events 
may result in outcomes that are inconsistent with judgements that were reasonable at the time they were 
made, the absence of anything to report on these statements is not a guarantee as to the Group’s and 
Company’s longer-term viability.
Corporate governance disclosures
We are required to perform procedures to identify whether there is a material inconsistency between the 
directors’ corporate governance disclosures and the financial statements and our audit knowledge.
Based on those procedures, we have concluded that each of the following is materially consistent with the 
financial statements and our audit knowledge:
•	 the directors’ statement that they consider that the annual report and financial statements taken as a whole 
is fair, balanced and understandable, and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the 
Group’s position and performance, business model and strategy;
•	 the section of the annual report describing the work of the Audit Committee, including the significant issues 
that the audit committee considered in relation to the financial statements, and how these issues were 
addressed; and
•	 the section of the annual report that describes the review of the effectiveness of the Group’s risk 
management and internal control systems.
We are required to review the part of the Corporate Governance Statement relating to the Group’s 
compliance with the provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code specified by the UK Listing Rules for 
our review. We have nothing to report in this respect.
8.  We have nothing to report on the other matters on which we are required to report by exception
Under the Companies Act 2006, we are required to report to you if, in our opinion:
•	 adequate accounting records have not been kept by the parent Company, or returns adequate for our audit 
have not been received from branches not visited by us; or
•	 the parent Company financial statements and the part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report to be audited 
are not in agreement with the accounting records and returns; or
•	 certain disclosures of directors’ remuneration specified by law are not made; or
•	 we have not received all the information and explanations we require for our audit.
We have nothing to report in these respects.
9.  Respective responsibilities
Directors’ responsibilities
As explained more fully in their statement set out on page 121, the directors are responsible for: the 
preparation of the financial statements including being satisfied that they give a true and fair view; such 
internal control as they determine is necessary to enable the preparation of financial statements that are 
free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error; assessing the Group and parent Company’s 
ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, matters related to going concern; and 
using the going concern basis of accounting unless they either intend to liquidate the Group or the parent 
Company or to cease operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so.
Auditor’s responsibilities
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements as a whole are 
free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue our opinion in an auditor’s 
report. Reasonable assurance is a high level of assurance, but does not guarantee that an audit conducted 
in accordance with ISAs (UK) will always detect a material misstatement when it exists. Misstatements can 
arise from fraud or error and are considered material if, individually or in aggregate, they could reasonably be 
expected to influence the economic decisions of users taken on the basis of the financial statements.
A fuller description of our responsibilities is provided on the FRC’s website at www.frc.org.uk/
auditorsresponsibilities.
The Company is required to include these financial statements in an annual financial report prepared under 
Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rule 4.1.17R and 4.1.18R. This auditor’s report provides no assurance 
over whether the annual financial report has been prepared in accordance with those requirements.
10.  The purpose of our audit work and to whom we owe our responsibilities
This report is made solely to the Company’s members, as a body, in accordance with Chapter 3 of Part 16 
of the Companies Act 2006. Our audit work has been undertaken so that we might state to the Company’s 
members those matters we are required to state to them in an auditor’s report and for no other purpose. 
To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone other than the 
Company and the Company’s members, as a body, for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions  
we have formed.
James Tracey (Senior Statutory Auditor)
for and on behalf of KPMG LLP, Statutory Auditor
Chartered Accountants 
One Snowhill 
Snow Hill Queensway 
Birmingham 
B4 6GH 
31 March 2025

131
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT
For the year ended 31 December 2024
£m
Notes
 2024
 2023 
(re-presented1)
Revenue
1
4,607.4
4,837.1
Gross profit
1,203.7
1,298.8
Charge for impairment losses for trade receivables
14
(16.7)
(16.8)
Selling and distribution
(779.2)
(823.2)
Administrative expenses – other
(271.3)
(284.9)
Profit on disposal of properties
11.3
15.1
Other operating income
4
4.0
9.1
Adjusted operating profit
151.8
198.1
Administrative expenses – adjusting items
3
(139.1)
(26.9)
Administrative expenses – amortisation of acquired intangible 
assets
(10.4)
(10.5)
Operating profit
2
2.3
160.7
Finance income
6
11.1
12.1
Finance costs
6
(51.8)
(51.4)
(Loss)/profit before tax
(38.4)
121.4
Tax
7
(2.2)
(31.9)
(Loss)/profit from continuing operations
(40.6)
89.5
Loss from discontinuing operations
8
(36.8)
(51.4)
(Loss)/profit for the year
(77.4)
38.1
All (loss)/profit for the year is attributable to the owners of the Company.
Earnings per share (note 20):
 2024
 2023 
(re-presented1)
Adjusted basic earnings
36.6p
54.4p
Basic earnings
– from continuing operations
(19.2)p
42.5p
– total
(36.6)p
18.1p
Diluted earnings
– from continuing operations
(19.2)p
41.8p
– total
(36.6)p
17.8p
1	
Figures for the year ended 31 December 2023 have been re-presented to exclude the results of the Toolstation Europe France business, which is 
now presented as a discontinued operation.
The accompanying notes form an integral part of these financial statements.

132
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
For the year ended 31 December 2024
£m
Notes
2024
2023
(Loss)/profit for the year
(77.4)
38.1
Items that will not be reclassified subsequently to profit and loss:
Actuarial gain/(loss) on defined benefit pension schemes
18
35.1
(41.0)
Deferred tax relating to other comprehensive income
7
(9.5)
10.2
Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit and loss:
Foreign exchange differences on retranslation of foreign operations
(2.3)
(1.2)
Fair value gain/(loss) on cash flow hedges
27
0.4
(1.4)
Deferred tax on cash flow hedges
7
(0.1)
0.4
Total other comprehensive profit/(loss) for the year net of tax
23.6
(33.0)
Total comprehensive (loss)/income for the year
(53.8)
5.1
Total comprehensive (loss)/income for the year attributable to the owners of the Company arises from:
Continuing operations
(16.9)
57.0
Discontinued operations
(36.9)
(51.9)
(53.8)
5.1
All other comprehensive income is attributable to the owners of the Company.

133
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
As at 31 December 2024
£m
Notes
2024
2023
Assets
Non-current assets
Goodwill
9
821.3
847.9
Other intangible assets
9
86.9
99.9
Property, plant and equipment
10
771.1
848.4
Right-of-use assets
11
545.4
530.4
Non-current prepayments
14
15.3
14.2
Deferred tax asset
16
17.5
18.0
Derivative financial instruments
28
3.3
2.9
Retirement benefit asset
18
116.9
100.6
Total non-current assets
2,377.7
2,462.3
Current assets
Inventories 
12
648.6
727.6
Trade and other receivables
14
760.5
689.6
Tax debtor
–
14.5
Cash and cash equivalents, excluding bank overdrafts
23
244.4
131.5
Total current assets
1,653.5
1,563.2
Total assets
4,031.2
4,025.5
Equity and liabilities
Capital and reserves
Issued share capital
23.8
23.8
Share premium account
545.6
545.6
Cash flow hedge reserve
27
2.5
2.9
Merger reserve
326.5
326.5
Revaluation reserve
9.5
10.8
Own shares
(7.2)
(14.1)
Foreign exchange reserve
6.1
8.4
Capital redemption reserve
1.4
1.4
Retained earnings
1,065.9
1,135.0
Total equity
19
1,974.1
2,040.3
£m
Notes
2024
2023
Non-current liabilities
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
22
421.8
445.1
Lease liabilities
11
560.1
518.8
Deferred tax liabilities
16
68.3
92.8
Long-term provisions
15
21.6
3.8
Total non-current liabilities
1,071.8
1,060.5
Current liabilities
Lease liabilities
11
94.5
89.6
Overdraft
22
13.2
–
Derivative financial instruments
28
–
0.4
Trade and other payables
17
838.2
795.4
Short-term provisions
15
39.4
39.3
Total current liabilities
985.3
924.7
Total liabilities
2,057.1
1,985.2
Total equity and liabilities
4,031.2
4,025.5
The financial statements of Travis Perkins plc, registered number 824821, were approved by the Board of 
Directors on 31 March 2025 and signed on its behalf by:
Geoff Drabble	
	
Duncan Cooper
Chair	
	
	
Director 

134
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY
For the year ended 31 December 2024
£m
Share  
capital
Share  
premium
Cash flow  
hedge reserve
Merger 
reserve
Revaluation 
reserve
Own  
shares
Foreign 
exchange 
reserve
Other
Retained 
earnings
Total  
equity
At 1 January 2023
23.8
545.6
4.3
326.5
12.1
(34.3)
9.6
1.4
1,213.2
2,102.2
Profit for the year
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
38.1
38.1
Other comprehensive income for the year net of tax
–
–
(1.4)
–
–
–
(1.2)
–
(30.4)
(33.0)
Total comprehensive income for the year
–
–
(1.4)
–
–
–
(1.2)
–
7.7
5.1
Dividends paid
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
(82.1)
(82.1)
Adjustments in respect of revalued fixed assets net of tax
–
–
–
–
(1.3)
–
–
–
1.8
0.5
Own shares movement
–
–
–
–
–
20.2
–
–
(20.2)
–
Equity-settled share-based payments net of tax
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
14.6
14.6
At 1 January 2024
23.8
545.6
2.9
326.5
10.8
(14.1)
8.4
1.4
1,135.0
2,040.3
Loss for the year
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
(77.4)
(77.4)
Other comprehensive income for the year net of tax
–
–
0.3
–
–
–
(2.3)
–
25.6
23.6
Total comprehensive loss for the year
–
–
0.3
–
–
–
(2.3)
–
(51.8)
(53.8)
Dividends paid
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
(23.2)
(23.2)
Adjustments in respect of revalued fixed assets net of tax
–
–
–
–
(1.3)
–
–
–
1.5
0.2
Sale of own shares
–
–
–
–
–
0.1
–
–
–
0.1
Own shares movement
–
–
–
–
–
6.8
–
–
(6.8)
–
Exercise of options over non-controlling interest
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
(1.2)
(1.2)
Equity-settled share-based payments net of tax
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
11.7
11.7
Reclassification
–
–
(0.7)
–
–
–
–
–
0.7
–
At 31 December 2024
23.8
545.6
2.5
326.5
9.5
(7.2)
6.1
1.4
1,065.9
1,974.1

135
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOW STATEMENT
For the year ended 31 December 2024
£m
2024
2023 
(re-presented)
Cash flows from operating activities
Operating profit
2.3
160.7
Adjustments for:
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment
79.8
79.1
Depreciation of right-of-use assets
96.8
88.9
Amortisation of other intangibles
3.6
4.6
Amortisation of acquisition-related intangibles
10.4
10.5
Share-based payments
11.7
14.6
Gain on disposal of property, plant and equipment
(11.3)
(15.1)
Purchase of tool hire assets
(3.8)
(7.8)
Decrease / (increase) in inventories
63.6
(0.4)
(Increase) / decrease in receivables
(76.1)
36.9
Increase / (decrease) in payables
18.0
(59.1)
Adjusting items payments less than/(greater than) the charge
119.2
16.3
Cash generated from operations
314.2
329.2
Interest paid and debt arrangement fees
(25.3)
(31.0)
Interest on lease liabilities
(29.6)
(25.6)
Income taxes paid
(20.9)
(40.7)
Net cash inflow from continuing operating activities 
238.4
231.9
Net cash outflow from discontinued operating activities
(15.9)
(14.3)
Net cash from operating activities
222.5
217.6
£m
2024
2023 
(re-presented)
Cash flows from investing activities
Interest received
5.8
6.0
Proceeds on disposal of property, plant and equipment
63.0
69.1
Purchases of land and buildings
(12.3)
(33.2)
Purchases of other property, plant and equipment
(55.8)
(96.5)
Purchase/development of computer software
(4.1)
(2.9)
Net cash outflow from continuing investing activities 
(3.4)
(57.5)
Net cash outflow from discontinued investing activities 
–
(1.4)
Net cash outflow from investing activities
(3.4)
(58.9)
Cash flows from financing activities
Sale of own shares
0.1
–
Repayment of lease liabilities
(93.8)
(82.4)
Payments to pension scheme
–
(3.8)
Dividends paid
(23.2)
(82.1)
Drawdown of borrowings
–
100.0
Repayment of bonds
–
(180.0)
Net cash outflow used in continuing financing activities 
(116.9)
(248.3)
Net cash outflow used in discontinued financing activities 
(2.5)
(2.1)
Net cash used in financing activities
(119.4)
(250.4)
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
99.7
(91.7)
Cash and cash equivalents at 1 January
131.5
223.2
Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December (note 22)
231.2
131.5

136
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
GENERAL INFORMATION
Overview
Travis Perkins plc is a Company incorporated in the United Kingdom under the Companies Act 2006. 
The address of the registered office is given on page 174. The nature of the Group’s operations and its 
principal activities are set out in the Strategic Report on pages 6 to 25.
These financial statements are presented in pounds sterling, the currency of the primary economic environment 
in which the Group operates, and presented rounded to the nearest £100,000 unless otherwise stated.
Basis of accounting
The Group financial statements have been prepared in accordance with UK-adopted international 
accounting standards.
The Company has elected to prepare its Parent Company financial statements in accordance with FRS 101; 
these are presented on pages 172 to 180.
Basis of preparation
The financial statements have been prepared on the historical cost basis, except that derivatives, other 
financial instruments and contingent consideration arising from business combinations are stated at fair 
value through profit and loss and designated financial instruments are stated at fair value through other 
comprehensive income. The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and 
all entities controlled by the Company (its subsidiaries, together referred to as “the Group”) from the date 
control commences until the date that control ceases. Control is achieved where the Company:
•	 Has power over the investee.
•	 Is exposed or has rights to a variable return from the involvement with the investee.
•	 Has the ability to use its power to affect its returns.
As such, the results of subsidiaries acquired are included in the consolidated income statement from the 
effective date of acquisition.
Foreign currencies
Transactions denominated in foreign currencies are recorded at the rates ruling on the date of the transaction.
At the balance sheet date, monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are translated at 
the rate of exchange ruling at that date. Foreign exchange differences arising on translation are recognised in 
the income statement.
Going concern
After reviewing the Group’s forecasts and risk assessments and making other enquiries, the Board 
has formed the judgement at the time of approving the financial statements that there is a reasonable 
expectation that the Group has adequate resources to continue in operational existence for the 12 months 
from the date of signing this Annual Report and Accounts. For this reason the Board continues to adopt the 
going concern basis in preparing the financial statements.
In arriving at their opinion the Directors considered:
•	 The Group’s cash flow forecasts and revenue projections.
•	 The impact on trading performance of severe but plausible downside scenarios. Key assumptions include 
significant reductions in revenue, removal of property profits and limited reductions in fixed overheads, as well 
as mitigating actions such as delayed capital expenditure, reduced overhead investment and dividend reduction.
•	 The committed debt facilities available to the Group and the covenants thereon.
•	 The Group’s debt maturity profile and the successful issuance of £125m of new debt in March 2025.
•	 The Group’s robust policy towards liquidity and cash flow management.
•	 The Group’s ability to successfully manage the principal risk and uncertainties outlined on pages 59 to 69 
during periods of uncertain economic outlook and challenging macroeconomic conditions.
The downside scenarios tested, outlining the impact of severe but plausible adverse scenarios based on 
a severe recession and housing market weakness, show that there is sufficient headroom for liquidity and 
covenant compliance purposes for at least the next 12 months from the date of approval of these financial 
statements. The going concern assessment is not sensitive to estimates on inflation.
Significant accounting policies
The principal accounting policies adopted in preparing the financial statements are provided throughout the 
notes to the financial statements.
Key judgements and estimates
The preparation of financial statements requires the Directors to make estimates and assumptions about 
future events that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent 
assets and liabilities. Future events and their effects cannot be determined with certainty. Therefore, 
the determination of estimates requires the exercise of judgement based on various assumptions and 
other factors such as historical experience and current and expected economic conditions. The Directors 
frequently re-evaluate these significant factors and make adjustments as facts and circumstances dictate. 
During the year the Group implemented Oracle as its new finance system in three of its Merchanting 
businesses. This will reduce the level of estimation previously necessitated by these businesses’ use 
of finance systems first implemented by the Group over 30 years ago. The anticipated challenges of 
implementing a new finance system means that there is a greater amount of estimation in the preparation 
of the 2025 financial statements than is anticipated to be the case in future reporting periods, particularly in 
respect of accrued revenue and related liabilities. None of these areas are considered to have a significant 
risk of a material adjustment to the carrying value of assets and liabilities within the next financial year. 

137
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Key judgements and estimates, including those that have a significant risk of resulting in a material 
adjustment to the carrying amount of assets and liabilities within the next financial year, are found in the 
following notes:
Page
Note
Description
144
8
Classification of Toolstation France as a discontinued operation
154
18
Pension liability assumptions
166
29
Impairment reviews
The notes are organised into the following sections:
Income and expenses: Provides a breakdown of individual line items in the income statement and 
summarises the accounting policies, judgements and estimates relevant to understanding these items.
Assets and liabilities: Provides a breakdown of individual line items in the balance sheet and summarises 
the accounting policies, judgements and estimates relevant to understanding these items.
Capital: Provides information about the capital management practices of the Group and shareholder returns 
for the year.
Risks: Discusses the Group’s impairment testing and the exposure to various financial risks, explains how 
these affect the Group’s financial position and performance and what the Group does to manage these risks.
Group structure: Explains aspects of the Group structure and how changes have affected the financial 
position and performance of the Group.
People: Provides information about the number of people employed by the Group and associated costs.
Other: Provides information on items which require disclosure, but are not considered critical in 
understanding the financial performance or position of the Group.
INCOME AND EXPENSES
1.  Revenue
Accounting policy
Revenue recognition
Revenue is recognised when the Group has satisfied its performance obligations to the customer and 
the customer has obtained control of the goods or services being transferred. Performance obligations to 
the customer in respect of sales of goods are satisfied on delivery or collection by customer. Payments 
are typically due from credit customers not later than the last day of the month following the month of 
delivery. Revenue is measured at the transaction price received or receivable and represents amounts 
receivable for goods and services provided in the normal course of business, net of discounts and value 
added tax. For the Group sale of services revenue comprises tool hire. Tool hire revenue is recognised on 
a straight-line basis over the period of hire. 
Customer rebates
Where the Group has rebate agreements with its customers, the value of variable income with respect 
to customer rebates is calculated in accordance with the agreements in place so that the amount 
recognised as revenue in the year is based on the amount which is highly probable not to reverse.
a.  Revenue
£m
2024
 2023 
(re-presented)
Sale of goods
4,439.9
4,668.3
Sale of services
167.5
168.8
4,607.4
4,837.1
All revenue arose in the UK except for £109.1m (2023: £107.3m) arising in Europe.

138
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
INCOME AND EXPENSES CONTINUED
1.  Revenue continued
b.  Revenue reconciliation and like-for-like sales
£m
Merchanting
Toolstation
Total
2023 revenue (re-presented)
4,035.8
801.3
4,837.1
Network change
(62.5)
(12.7)
(75.2)
Trading days
49.5
2.4
51.9
2023 like-for-like revenue (re-presented)
4,022.8
791.0
4,813.8
Like-for-like change
(271.9)
15.3
(256.6)
2024 like-for-like revenue
3,750.9
806.3
4,557.2
Network change
35.4
14.8
50.2
2024 revenue
3,786.3
821.1
4,607.4
Like-for-like revenue growth
(6.8%)
1.9%
(5.3%)
Total revenue growth
(6.2%)
2.5%
(4.7%)
Like-for-like sales are a measure of underlying sales performance for two successive periods. Branches 
and stores contribute to like-for-like sales once they have been trading for more than 12 months. Revenue 
included in like-for-like is for the equivalent times in both years being compared. When branches close, 
revenue is excluded from the prior year figures for the months equivalent to the post-closure period in the 
current year.
2.  Profit
a.  Operating profit
£m
2024
2023  
(re-presented)
Revenue
4,607.4
4,837.1
Cost of sales
(3,403.7)
(3,538.3)
Gross profit
1,203.7
1,298.8
Charge for impairment losses for trade receivables
(16.7)
(16.8)
Selling and distribution
(779.2)
(823.2)
Administrative expenses – other
(271.3)
(284.9)
Profit on disposal of properties
11.3
15.1
Other operating income
4.0
9.1
Adjusted operating profit
151.8
198.1
Administrative expenses – adjusting items
(139.1)
(26.9)
Administrative expenses – amortisation of acquired intangible assets
(10.4)
(10.5)
Operating profit
2.3
160.7
Adjusted operating profit before property disposals
140.5
183.0
During the year the Group recognised a gain on the disposal of plant and equipment of £0.8m (2023: nil).
b.  Adjusted profit
£m
2024
2023  
(re-presented)
(Loss)/profit before tax
(38.4)
121.4
Adjusting items (note 3)
139.1
26.9
Amortisation of acquired intangible assets
10.4
10.5
Adjusted profit before tax
111.1
158.8
Total tax
(2.2)
(31.9)
Tax on adjusting items 
(29.0)
(9.7)
Tax on amortisation of acquired intangible assets
(2.6)
(2.6)
Adjusted profit after tax
77.3
114.6
Adjusted profit excludes adjusting items and amortisation of acquired intangible assets.

139
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
3.  Adjusting items
Accounting policy
Adjusting items are those items of income and expenditure that, individually or in aggregate, by reference 
to the Group, are material in size and unusual in nature or incidence and that in the judgement of the 
Directors should be disclosed separately on the face of the financial statements (or in the notes in the 
case of a segment) to ensure both that the reader has a clear understanding of the Group’s underlying 
financial performance and that there is comparability of financial performance between periods.
Items of income or expense that are considered by the Directors for designation as adjusting items 
include, but are not limited to, significant one-year or multi-year restructuring programmes, onerous 
contracts, write-downs or impairments of assets, the costs of acquiring and integrating businesses, gains 
or losses on disposals of businesses and investments, re-measurement gains or losses arising from 
changes in the fair value of derivative financial instruments to the extent that hedge accounting is not 
achieved or is not effective, pension scheme curtailment gains and the effect of changes in corporation 
tax rates on deferred tax balances.
£m
2024
2023  
(re-presented)
Restructuring
37.0
16.8
Staircraft impairment (note 29)
32.7
–
Branch impairments (note 29)
62.7
–
Benchmarx branch closures
6.7
10.1
139.1
26.9
Restructuring
In the second half of 2023, in response to the continued weakness in the construction market, the Group 
commenced a restructuring of its support functions and its supply chain. This programme concluded in 2024.
The 2024 costs associated with this programme are:
•	 £26.2m of costs from the consolidation of the Group’s supply chain, including £9.3m of dilapidations 
costs and other property-related items, £12.9m of stock impairments and £4.0m of other associated costs. 
Of these items, £4.7m of stock impairments, £1.4m property costs and £1.3m of other associated costs 
relate to the Toolstation UK business.
•	 Redundancy and other associated costs of £10.8m in respect of central and regional restructuring.
Costs of £16.8m were incurred in 2023 in respect of this restructuring activity.
Impairment
A full branch-level impairment review was conducted and identified 209 Merchanting branches where 
the carrying value of the branch assets was above the value of the discounted future cash flows generated 
from these assets. The total impairment recognised in respect of Travis Perkins General Merchant and CCF 
branches is £57.0m and reflects the under-utilisation of these assets within the review period as a result of 
cyclically depressed market volumes. A charge of £5.7m has been recognised in respect of other branch 
assets. Additionally, an impairment of £32.7m has been recognised in respect of the annual impairment 
review of the Staircraft business. Refer to note 29 for more details on the Group’s impairment reviews.
Benchmarx branch closures
In 2023 a charge of £10.1m was recognised in respect of the impairment of tangible fixed assets and right-
of-use assets and the recognition of property-related provisions for 39 standalone Benchmarx branches. 
These branches were closed in 2024 and an additional charge of £6.7m recognised in respect of closure 
costs.
4.  Other operating income and auditor’s remuneration
a.  Other operating income
£m
2024
2023 
(re-presented)
Rental income
3.8
4.4
Transitional Service Agreement income
0.2
4.7
4.0
9.1
The Transition Service Agreement income represented amounts received in respect of specific services provided 
to businesses the Group had sold or demerged in order to maintain business continuity in those businesses.

140
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
INCOME AND EXPENSES CONTINUED
4.  Other operating income and auditor’s remuneration continued
b.  Auditor’s remuneration
During the year the Group incurred the following costs for services provided by the Company’s auditor:
£m
2024
2023
Fees payable to the Company’s auditor for audit services:
Audit of the Company’s annual accounts
0.5
0.3
Auditor for the audit of the Company’s subsidiaries
2.2
1.7
Additional fees payable for the prior period audit
0.4
0.1
Fees paid to the Company’s auditor for other services:
Audit-related assurance services
0.1
0.1
3.2
2.2
A description of the work of the Audit Committee is set out in the Audit Committee report on pages 84 
to 89 and includes an explanation of how auditor objectivity and independence is safeguarded when the 
auditor provides non-audit services.
5.  Business segments
The operating segments are identified on the basis of internal reports about components of the Group that 
are regularly reviewed by the Chief Operating Decision Maker (“CODM”), which is considered to be the 
Board, to assess performance and allocate capital.
Segmental operating profit represents the result of each segment without allocation of certain central costs, 
finance costs and tax. Segmental adjusted operating profit is the result of each segment before adjusting 
items, the amortisation of acquired intangible assets and property profits. Unallocated segment assets and 
liabilities comprise financial instruments, current and deferred tax, cash, borrowings and pension scheme 
assets and liabilities.
Both operating segments sell building materials to a wide range of customers, none of which are dominant, 
and operate predominantly in the United Kingdom. The Toolstation segment sells building materials at a 
fixed price, with a fixed range in each store. The Merchanting segment sells building materials at prices 
specifically negotiated with customers, with variation in the products offered in each branch.
a.  Segment information
£m
2024
Merchanting
Toolstation
Unallocated
Consolidated
Revenue
3,786.3
821.1
–
4,607.4
Operating profit
19.5
12.0
(29.2)
2.3
Amortisation of acquired intangible assets
7.6
2.8
–
10.4
Adjusting items
132.6
6.5
–
139.1
Less property profits
(11.3)
–
–
(11.3)
Segmental adjusted operating profit
148.4
21.3
(29.2)
140.5
Adjusted operating margin
3.9%
2.6%
­–
3.0%
Average capital employed
2,232.5
564.3
12.4
2,809.2
Segment assets
2,888.0
726.6
416.6
4,031.2
Segment liabilities
(1,165.3)
(380.9)
(510.9)
(2,057.1)
Consolidated net assets
1,722.7
345.7
(94.3)
1,974.1
Capital expenditure excluding property
51.4
12.6
–
64.0
Depreciation of fixed assets and software amortisation
75.3
18.5
–
93.8
Depreciation of right-of-use assets
67.4
29.4
–
96.8

141
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
£m
2023 (re-presented)
Merchanting
Toolstation
Unallocated
Consolidated
Revenue
4,035.8
801.3
–
4,837.1
Operating profit
198.9
(4.8)
(33.4)
160.7
Amortisation of acquired intangible assets
7.6
2.9
–
10.5
Adjusting items
20.9
5.2
0.8
26.9
Less property profits
(15.1)
–
–
(15.1)
Adjusted operating profit excluding property profits
212.3
3.3
(32.6)
183.0
Adjusted operating margin
5.3%
0.4%
–
3.8%
Average capital employed
2,250.7
596.0
6.1
2,852.8
Segment assets
2,943.4
764.6
317.5
4,025.5
Segment liabilities
(1,070.6)
(375.1)
(539.5)
(1,985.2)
Consolidated net assets
1,872.8
389.5
(222.0)
2,040.3
Capital expenditure excluding property
89.5
17.8
–
107.3
Depreciation of fixed assets and software amortisation
67.8
15.9
–
83.7
Depreciation of right-of-use assets
56.8
32.1
–
88.9
b.  Unallocated segment assets and liabilities
Unallocated segment assets and liabilities comprise the following:
£m
2024
2023
Assets
Financial instruments
3.3
2.9
Property, plant and equipment
16.5
17.5
Cash and cash equivalents
244.4
131.5
Retirement benefit surplus
116.9
118.7
Unallocated corporate assets
18.0
14.4
Tax asset
–
14.5
Deferred tax asset
17.5
18.0
416.6
317.5
Liabilities
Deferred tax liabilities
(68.3)
(92.8)
Interest-bearing loans, borrowings and loan notes
(435.0)
(445.1)
Unallocated corporate liabilities
(7.6)
(1.6)
(510.9)
(539.5)
Non-current assets with a carrying value of £101.8m (2023: £111.7m) owned by the Toolstation Europe 
businesses are located in foreign countries.

142
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
INCOME AND EXPENSES CONTINUED
6.  Net finance costs
£m
2024
2023  
(re-presented)
Items in the nature of interest:
Interest on bonds and other loans
(17.1)
(20.6)
Interest on bank facilities and overdrafts
(2.0)
(1.5)
Pension scheme SPV interest
(1.8)
(1.7)
Other finance costs:
Amortisation of issue costs of bank loans
(1.3)
(1.5)
Unwinding of discounts – property provisions
–
(0.1)
Remeasurement:
Net loss on remeasurement of derivatives at fair value
–
(0.2)
Loss on remeasurement of foreign exchange 
–
(0.2)
Lease interest:
Interest on lease liabilities – property
(26.5)
(24.7)
Interest on lease liabilities – equipment
(3.1)
(0.9)
Finance costs
(51.8)
(51.4)
Items in the nature of interest:
Interest receivable
6.0
5.7
Remeasurement:
Net gain on remeasurement of derivatives at fair value
0.8
–
Other finance income – pension scheme
4.3
6.4
Finance income
11.1
12.1
Net finance costs
(40.7)
(39.3)
The Group’s interest cover covenants are calculated using those items of finance income and finance cost 
that are in the nature of interest, including interest on lease liabilities. In 2024 these were in total £44.5m 
(2023: £43.7m).
Net finance costs relating to discontinued operations are £0.4m (2023: £0.6m).
7.  Tax
Accounting policy
The tax expense represents the sum of the tax currently payable and deferred tax.
The tax currently payable is based on taxable profit for the year. Taxable profit differs from net profit as reported 
in the income statement because it excludes items of income and expense that are taxable or deductible in other 
years and it further excludes items which are never taxable or deductible. The Group’s liability for current tax is 
calculated using tax rates that have been enacted or substantially enacted by the balance sheet date.
Deferred tax is the tax expected to be payable or recoverable on differences between the carrying 
amounts of assets and liabilities in the financial statements and the corresponding tax bases used in the 
computation of taxable profit. This is accounted for using the balance sheet liability method.
Deferred tax liabilities are generally recognised for all taxable temporary differences and deferred tax assets 
are recognised to the extent that it is probable that taxable profits will be available against which deductible 
temporary differences can be utilised. Such assets and liabilities are not recognised if the temporary 
difference arises from goodwill or from the initial recognition of other assets and liabilities in a transaction 
(other than in a business combination) that affects neither the taxable profit nor the accounting profit.
Deferred tax is calculated at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the period when the liability is settled 
or the asset realised based on tax laws and rates that have been enacted or substantially enacted at the 
balance sheet date. Deferred tax is charged or credited in the income statement, except when it relates to 
items charged or credited directly to equity, in which case the deferred tax is also dealt with in equity.
a.  Tax charge in the income statement
£m
2024
2023  
(re-presented)
Current tax:
Current year
34.9
33.0
Prior year
0.6
(6.1)
Total current tax
35.5
26.9
Deferred tax:
Current year
(32.8)
(1.4)
Prior year
(0.5)
6.4
Total deferred tax
(33.3)
5.0
Total tax charge
2.2
31.9
The total tax charge in 2024 includes a credit of £29.0m relating to costs recognised as adjusting items 
(2023: £9.7m).

143
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
The differences between the total tax charge and the amount calculated by applying the standard rate of UK 
corporation tax to the profit before tax for the Group is as follows:
2024
2023 (re-presented)
£m
%
£m
%
(Loss)/profit before tax
(38.4)
121.4
Tax at the UK corporation tax rate
(9.6)
25.0
28.6
23.5
Tax effect of expenses/credits that are not 
deductible/taxable
1.2
(2.1)
Depreciation of non-qualifying property
3.4
3.3
Share-based payments
2.7
2.0
Losses
1.8
1.1
Property profits
(3.0)
(1.2)
Current period deferred tax rate differential
–
(0.1)
Impairment
5.6
–
Prior period adjustment
0.1
0.3
Tax expense and effective tax rate for the year
2.2
(5.7)
31.9
26.3
For accounting periods beginning after 31 December 2024 the Group will be required to comply with the 
OECD Pillar Two model rules which will require the Group to pay a minimum level of tax on income arising 
in the jurisdictions in which it operates. The Group’s current analysis of these rules and their application 
in jurisdictions relevant to the Group indicate that no material additional tax liability will arise. The Group 
has applied the mandatory temporary exception to the accounting for deferred taxes arising from the 
implementation of the Pillar Two model rules.
b.  Tax charge in the statement of comprehensive income
The following amounts relating to tax have been recognised in other comprehensive income:
£m
2024
2023
Items that may be reclassified:
Deferred tax (credit)/charge on cash flow hedge
(0.1)
0.4
Items that may not be reclassified:
Deferred tax (credit)/charge on actuarial movement
(9.5)
10.2
Income tax relating to other comprehensive income
(9.6)
10.6
c.  Tax credited directly to equity
The following amounts of tax have been recognised in equity:
£m
2024
2023
Deferred tax:
Revaluation reserve
0.2
0.5
Share-based payments
0.1
0.1
0.3
0.6
8.  Discontinued operations
Key judgement on the classification of Toolstation France as a discontinued operation
During the year ended 31 December 2024 the Group ceased the operations of its Toolstation France 
business. As this business represented a separate geographical area of operation and was a major 
proportion of the Group’s loss for the year of £77.4m in 2024 and its profit for the year of £38.1m in 
2023, the Group concluded that it met the definition of a discontinued operation in IFRS 5 – Non-current 
Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations. Accordingly its results are presented as those of 
discontinued operations and the results for the year ended 31 December 2023 have been re-presented.
a.  Results of discontinued operations
£m
 2024
 2023 
(re-presented)
Revenue
16.3
24.8
Gross profit
8.2
6.3
Operating expenses
(44.6)
(57.1)
Net finance costs
(0.4)
(0.6)
Loss before tax
(36.8)
(51.4)
Tax
–
–
Loss from discontinuing operations
(36.8)
(51.4)
The loss before tax of £36.8m includes costs of £22.2m relating to the closure of the business. The loss 
for the year ended 31 December 2023 from discontinued operations includes £33.1m which was previously 
presented as an adjusting item. 

144
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
INCOME AND EXPENSES CONTINUED
8.  Discontinued operations continued
b.  Cash flows relating to discontinued operations 
£m
Year ended 
31 December 
2024 
Year ended
31 December 
2023 
(re-presented)
Net cash outflow from operating activities 
(15.9)
(14.3)
Net cash outflow from investing activities 
–
(1.4)
Net cash used in financing activities 
(2.5)
(2.1)
Net cash flows for the year for discontinued operations
(18.4)
(17.8)
ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
9.  Goodwill and other intangible assets
Accounting policy
Goodwill arising on acquisition represents the excess of the cost of acquisition over the share of the 
aggregate fair value of identifiable net assets (including intangible assets) of a business or a subsidiary at 
the date of acquisition. All material intangible fixed assets obtained on acquisition have been recognised 
separately in the financial statements. Goodwill is initially recognised as an asset and allocated to cash-
generating units or groups of cash-generating units that are expected to benefit from the synergies of 
the combination and is then reviewed at least annually for impairment. Any impairment is recognised 
immediately in the income statement and is not reversed. Goodwill is accordingly stated in the balance 
sheet at cost less any provisions for impairment in value. Intangible assets identified as part of the assets 
of an acquired business are capitalised separately from goodwill if the fair value can be measured reliably 
on initial recognition.
Goodwill arising on acquisitions before the date of transition to IFRS (1 January 2004) has been retained 
at the previous UK GAAP carrying value subject to being tested for impairment at that date. Goodwill 
written off to reserves prior to 1998 under UK GAAP has not been reinstated and would not be included 
in determining any subsequent profit or loss on disposal.
a.  Goodwill by reportable segment
£m
Merchanting
Toolstation
Total
At 1 January 2023
684.8
174.2
859.0
Impairment
–
(9.6)
(9.6)
Effect on movement in exchange rates
–
(1.5)
(1.5)
At 1 January 2024
684.8
163.1
847.9
Impairment
(23.8)
–
(23.8)
Effect on movement in exchange rates
–
(2.8)
(2.8)
At 31 December 2024
661.0
160.3
821.3
b.  Other intangible assets
Accounting policy
Intangible assets are amortised to the income statement on a straight-line basis over a maximum of 20 
years except where they are considered to have an indefinite useful life. In the latter instance, they are 
reviewed annually for impairment.
The directly attributable costs incurred for the development of computer software controlled by and for 
use within the business are capitalised and written off over their estimated useful life, which ranges from 
three to ten years. Interfaces are amortised over the lower of the remaining estimated useful lives of the 
systems they operate between. Costs relating to research, maintenance and training are expensed as 
they are incurred.
Amounts paid to third parties in respect of the development of software and other intangible assets not 
controlled by the Group are expensed over the period where the Group receives the service. The cost 
of configuring and customising software is treated as a prepayment and recognised over the period the 
Group benefits from the implemented software only if the configuration and customisation service is not 
distinct from the provision of the software itself. Licence fees for using third-party software are expensed 
over the period the software is in use.
Acquired customer relationships are amortised over their estimated useful lives, which range from 5 to 
15 years. The remaining lives of amortised customer relationships range from one to seven years. No 
amortisation is charged on computer software under construction.

145
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
£m
Brand
Computer 
software
Customer 
relationships
Assets under 
construction
Total
Cost or valuation
At 1 January 2023
150.4
110.7
151.6
0.7
413.4
Additions
–
1.1
–
2.0
3.1
Impairments
(1.9)
–
–
–
(1.9)
Derecognition
–
–
–
(2.1)
(2.1)
At 1 January 2024
148.5
111.8
151.6
0.6
412.5
Additions
–
3.9
–
0.2
4.1
Transfers from property, plant & 
equipment
–
0.6
–
–
0.6
Reclassification
–
0.5
–
(0.5)
–
Disposals
–
(0.5)
–
–
(0.5)
At 31 December 2024
148.5
116.3
151.6
0.3
416.7
Amortisation
At 1 January 2023
73.7
98.1
125.7
–
297.5
Charged on acquired intangibles
2.3
–
8.2
–
10.5
Charged on internally generated 
intangibles
–
4.6
–
–
4.6
At 1 January 2024
76.0
102.7
133.9
–
312.6
Charged on acquired intangibles
2.3
–
8.1
–
10.4
Charged on internally generated 
intangibles
–
3.6
–
–
3.6
Impairment
–
–
3.4
–
3.4
Disposals
–
(0.2)
–
–
(0.2)
At 31 December 2024
78.3
106.1
145.4
–
329.8
Net book value
At 31 December 2023
72.5
9.1
17.7
0.6
99.9
At 31 December 2024
70.2
10.2
6.2
0.3
86.9
Where a brand has not been established for a significant period of time the Directors do not have sufficient 
evidence to support a contention that it will have an indefinite useful life. Accordingly for Toolstation and 
certain product-related brands the Directors have decided it is appropriate to amortise their brand costs over 
their estimated useful lives. The useful lives of those brands being amortised range from 10 to 20 years. 
The Directors consider that the BSS brand, which is a leading brand in its sector with significant history and 
significant growth prospects, has an indefinite useful life. It is reviewed annually for impairment; details of 
impairment tests are shown in note 29.
c.  Cash-generating units
The Directors consider that each branch or distribution network in the Group is an individual cash-generating 
unit (“CGU”). Goodwill and intangible fixed assets with indefinite useful lives have been allocated for 
impairment testing purposes to groups of individual CGUs within the same brand. The following table 
analyses goodwill and intangible fixed assets with indefinite useful lives by CGU grouping.
£m
CGU grouping
2024
2023
Intangibles
Goodwill
Total
Intangibles
Goodwill
Total
Merchanting
Travis Perkins
–
482.6
482.6
–
482.6
482.6
Keyline
–
100.2
100.2
–
100.2
100.2
CCF
–
43.6
43.6
–
43.6
43.6
BSS Industrial
49.3
26.8
76.1
49.3
26.8
76.1
Staircraft
–
–
–
–
23.8
23.8
TF Solutions
–
7.8
7.8
–
7.8
7.8
Toolstation
Toolstation UK
–
103.4
103.4
–
103.4
103.4
Toolstation Benelux
–
56.9
56.9
–
59.7
59.7
49.3
821.3
870.6
49.3
847.9
897.2

146
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
ASSETS AND LIABILITIES CONTINUED
10.  Property, plant and equipment
Accounting policy
Property, plant and equipment is stated at cost or deemed cost less accumulated depreciation and any 
impairment in value. Assets are depreciated to their estimated residual value on a straight-line basis over 
their estimated useful lives as follows:
•	 Buildings – 50 years or, if lower, the estimated useful life of the building or the life of the lease
•	 Leasehold improvements – the life of the lease
•	 Plant and equipment – 4 to 10 years
•	 Freehold land is not depreciated
The estimated useful lives are estimated taking into consideration the potential impact of climate change. 
The gain or loss arising on the disposal or retirement of an asset is determined as the difference between 
the sale proceeds net of expenses and the carrying amount of the asset in the balance sheet and is 
recognised in the income statement. Where appropriate, the attributable revaluation reserve remaining in 
respect of properties revalued prior to the adoption of IFRS is transferred directly to retained earnings.
£m
Freehold
Long 
 leasehold
Leasehold 
improvements
Plant and 
equipment
Total
Cost or deemed cost
At 1 January 2023 
531.3
29.6
215.0
732.9
1,508.8
Additions
4.7
22.1
35.0
80.7
142.5
Disposals
(46.6)
(0.5)
(6.0)
(74.0)
(127.1)
Impairments
–
–
(12.5)
(10.5)
(23.0)
Reclassifications
(2.4)
–
(10.0)
12.4
–
Effect of movements in exchange rates
–
–
–
(0.6)
(0.6)
At 1 January 2024
487.0
51.2
221.5
740.9
1,500.6
Additions
9.6
–
32.5
28.4
70.5
Disposals
(15.8)
(4.7)
(11.4)
(45.4)
(77.3)
Reclassifications
30.5
2.2
(45.1)
18.4
6.0
Effect of movements in exchange rates
–
–
–
(0.7)
(0.7)
At 31 December 2024
511.3
48.7
197.5
741.6
1,499.1
£m
Freehold
Long 
 leasehold
Leasehold 
improvements
Plant and 
equipment
Total
Accumulated depreciation 
At 1 January 2023
61.0
12.6
82.2
505.7
661.5
Charged in the year 
7.0
0.8
14.6
57.9
80.3
Disposals
(6.4)
–
(6.6)
(63.2)
(76.2)
Impairments
–
–
(5.2)
(8.0)
(13.2)
Reclassifications
0.3
–
(0.3)
–
–
Effect of movements in exchange rates
–
–
–
(0.2)
(0.2)
At 1 January 2024
61.9
13.4
84.7
492.2
652.2
Charged in the year 
6.7
1.0
12.6
59.5
79.8
Disposals
(5.1)
(1.4)
(1.9)
(42.1)
(50.5)
Impairments
–
–
11.9
27.7
39.6
Reclassifications
14.8
0.3
5.5
(14.6)
6.0
Write offs
–
–
1.5
–
1.5
Effect of movements in exchange rates
–
–
–
(0.6)
(0.6)
At 31 December 2024
78.3
13.3
114.3
522.1
728.0
Net book value
At 31 December 2023
425.1
37.8
136.8
248.7
848.4
At 31 December 2024
433.0
35.4
83.2
219.5
771.1
Included within freehold property is land with a value of £227.5m (2023: £215.6m) which is not depreciated. 
No assets are pledged as security for the Group’s liabilities. Included within leasehold improvements is 
£17.5m (2023: £21.4m) in respect of assets under construction which are not depreciated.

147
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
11.  Leases
Accounting policy
Identifying a lease
At the inception of a contract, the Group assesses whether a contract contains a lease. At inception the 
Group allocates the consideration in the contract to each lease component on the basis of their relative 
stand-alone prices except for fleet leases for which the Group does not separate non-lease components 
and accounts for the lease and non-lease components as a single lease component.
Recognition exceptions
The Group takes the lease recognition exemption for leases with a lease term of 12 months or less 
and containing no purchase options and leases where the underlying asset has a low value when new. 
Payments associated with short-term leases and leases of low-value assets are recognised on a straight-
line basis as an expense in profit or loss. Short-term leases are leases with a lease term of 12 months or 
less. Low-value assets comprise mainly IT equipment, vending machines and paint-mixing machines.
Lease terms
Extension and termination options are included in a number of property and equipment leases across 
the Group. These terms are used to maximise operational flexibility. The Group has applied judgement 
to determine the lease term for some lease contracts that includes renewal options and break clauses. In 
determining the lease term, management considers all facts and circumstances that create an economic 
incentive to exercise an extension option, or not exercise a termination option. Extension options (or 
periods after termination options) are only included in the lease term if the lease is reasonably certain to 
be extended (or not terminated).
For property leases the most relevant is normally the profitability of the leased branch or warehouse and 
future plans for the business. If there are significant penalties to terminate or not extend, the Group is 
typically reasonably certain to not terminate or extend.
Lessee accounting
Initial measurement
The right-of-use asset is initially measured at cost, which comprises the initial amount of the lease 
liability adjusted for any lease payments made at or before the commencement date and any initial direct 
costs incurred, less any lease incentives received.
The lease liability is initially measured at the present value of the lease payments payable over the lease 
term, discounted at the rate implicit in the lease if that can be readily determined and otherwise at the 
incremental borrowing rate. 
Subsequent measurement
After lease commencement, the Group measures right-of-use assets at cost less accumulated 
depreciation and accumulated impairment.
The lease liability is subsequently remeasured to reflect changes in the lease term, the assessment 
of a purchase option and future lease payments resulting from a change in an index or a rate used to 
determine those payments. The remeasurements are matched by adjustments to the right-of-use asset. 
Lease modifications may also prompt remeasurement of the lease liability unless they are determined to 
be separate leases.
Depreciation
The right-of-use asset is subsequently depreciated using the straight-line method to the earlier of the end 
of the useful life of the right-of-use asset or the end of lease term. Estimated useful lives are determined 
on the same basis as those of property, plant and equipment. In addition, the right-of-use asset is 
reduced by impairment losses, if any, and adjusted for certain remeasurements of the lease liability.
Sale and leaseback transactions
If an asset transfer satisfies the requirements of IFRS 15 – Revenue from Contracts with Customers to 
be accounted for as a sale, the Group measures the right-of-use asset at the proportion of the previous 
carrying amount that relates to the right-of-use retained. Accordingly, the Group only recognises the 
amount of gain or loss that relates to the rights transferred to the buyer.
a.  Amounts recognised in the balance sheet 
All right-of-use assets relate to land and buildings except for £58.4m in respect of plant and equipment 
(2023: £29.6m). Additions to right-of-use assets in 2024 were £152.1m (2023: £182.4m).
Lease liability maturity analysis – contractual undiscounted cash flows:
£m
2024
2023
Less than one year
119.9
106.9
One to five years
369.3
337.8
More than five years
336.2
316.5
Total undiscounted lease liabilities at 31 December
825.4
761.2

148
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
ASSETS AND LIABILITIES CONTINUED
11.  Leases continued
b.  Amounts recognised in the statement of profit and loss
The statement of profit and loss shows the following amounts relating to leases:
£m
2024
2023  
(re-presented)
Expense relating to short-term leases
4.4
4.9
Expense relating to leases of low-value assets
3.5
3.1
Impairment/(reversal of impairment) of right-of-use assets
31.2
(1.7)
Gains on lease terminations
–
(2.5)
An impairment right-of-use assets has been recognised with respect to land and buildings of £17.9m 
and plant and equipment of £13.3m. Total depreciation of right-of-use assets of £96.8m (2023: £91.1m) 
represents £83.6m in respect of land and buildings (2023: £79.8m) and £13.2m in respect of plant and 
equipment (2023: £11.3m). The total cash outflow for leases in 2024 was £131.3m (2023: £116.2m).
c.  The Group’s leasing activities
The Group leases various properties, motor vehicles and equipment. Rental contracts are typically made for 
fixed periods but may have extension options. Lease terms are negotiated on an individual basis and contain 
a wide range of different terms and conditions. Extension and termination options are included in a number 
of property and equipment leases across the Group and are used to provide operational flexibility.
The Group routinely enters into sale and leaseback transactions as part of its property management and 
investment strategy. The requirement of IFRS 16 – Leases to, in transfers that are accounted for as a sale, 
only recognise the amount of any gain or loss that relates to the rights transferred to the buyer-lessor, results 
in differences between the recognition of cash proceeds from the disposal of property, plant and equipment 
and the recognition of profit from these disposals.
d.  The Group as lessor
The Group leases a number of ex-trading properties and surplus units in trade parks owned by the 
Group to third parties. Property rental income earned during the year in respect of these properties was 
£3.8m (2023: £4.4m). At the balance sheet date, the Group had contracts with lessees for the following 
undiscounted future minimum lease payments:
£m
2024
2023 
Within one year
4.7
4.6
One to five years
21.4
22.8
After five years
5.0
5.0
31.1
32.4
12.  Inventories
Accounting policy
Inventories, which consist of goods for resale, are stated at the lower of average weighted cost and net 
realisable value. Cost comprises direct materials and, where applicable, direct labour costs and those 
overheads that have been incurred in bringing the inventories to their present location and condition. Net 
realisable value is the estimated selling price less the estimated costs of disposal.
£m
2024
2023
Inventories
648.6
727.6
The cost of inventories recognised as an expense in 2024 was £3,328.9m (2023: £3,381.4m). A charge of 
£5.2m (2023: £2.0m) was recognised as a result of the movement of provisions against inventory. 
13.  Supplier income
Accounting policy
Supplier income comprises fixed price discounts, volume rebates and customer sales support.
Fixed price discounts and volume rebates received and receivable in respect of goods which have been sold 
are initially deducted from the cost of inventory and therefore reduce cost of sales in the income statement 
when the goods are sold. Where goods on which the fixed price discount or volume rebate has been earned 
remain in inventory at the year end, the cost of that inventory reflects those discounts and rebates.
The Group receives customer sales support payments that are made entirely at the supplier’s option, that 
are requested by the Group when a specific product is about to be sold to a specific customer and for 
which payment is only received after the sale has been completed. All customer sales support receipts 
received and receivable are deducted from cost of sales when the sale to the third party has been 
completed, i.e. when the customer sales support payment has been earned.
Supplier income receivable is netted off against trade payables when there is a legally binding 
arrangement in place and it is management’s intention to do so, otherwise amounts are included in other 
receivables in the balance sheet.
Supplier income balances included within the Group balance sheet are as follows:
£m
2024
2023
Other receivables 
99.0
104.0
Trade payables
73.0
82.0
Inventories
(53.0)
(52.0)
Net balance sheet position
119.0
134.0

149
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
14.  Trade and other receivables
Accounting policy
Trade and other receivables
The Group’s trade and other receivables at the balance sheet date comprise principally amounts 
receivable from the sale of goods, amounts due in respect of rebates in relation to unbilled work in 
progress and sundry prepayments. 
Impairment of financial assets
Trade receivables are subject to the expected credit loss model in IFRS 9 – Financial Instruments. The 
Group applies the IFRS 9 – Financial Instruments simplified approach to measuring expected credit 
losses. This uses a lifetime expected loss allowance for all trade receivables. To measure the expected 
credit losses trade receivables have been grouped based on shared credit risk characteristics and the 
days past due.
Trade receivables are written off when there is no reasonable expectation of recovery. Indicators that 
there is no reasonable expectation of recovery include the failure of a debtor to engage in a repayment 
plan with the Group and the commencement of legal proceedings.
£m
2024
2023
Current:
Trade receivables
598.1
547.1
Allowance for doubtful debts
(29.8)
(21.5)
568.3
525.6
Other receivables
111.8
129.2
Prepayments and accrued income
80.4
34.8
Total current trade and other receivables
760.5
689.6
Non-current:
Prepayments
15.3
14.2
Total non-current trade and other receivables
15.3
14.2
The Directors consider that the only class of asset containing material credit risk is trade receivables. The 
average credit term taken for sales of goods is 59 days (2023: 56 days). No interest is charged on the trade 
receivable from the date of the invoice until the date the invoice is classified as overdue according to the 
trading terms agreed between the Group and the customer. Thereafter, the Group retains the right to charge 
interest at 4% p.a. (2023: 4%) above the clearing bank base rate on the outstanding balance.
The increase in the non-current prepayments balance reflects supplier licence fees and implementation 
costs incurred in respect of the Group’s technology upgrade programmes. 
Movement in the allowance for doubtful debts
£m
2024
2023
At 1 January
21.5
17.7
Amounts written off and adjusted for during the year
(8.4)
(13.0)
Charge for impairment losses for trade receivables
16.7
16.8
At 31 December
29.8
21.5
Expected credit loss assessment
Loss rates are based on actual credit loss experience over the past seven years and existing market 
conditions, as well as forward-looking estimates at the end of each reporting period.
The following table provides information about the exposure to credit risk and expected credit losses for 
trade receivables as at 31 December 2024.
£m
Gross  
carrying  
amount
Weighted 
average  
loss rate
Net loss 
allowance
Credit 
impaired
Current (not past due)
530.7
0.8%
(3.7)
No
Days overdue:
1–30
24.2
7.2%
(1.5)
No
31–60
8.5
19.7%
(1.4)
No
61–90
3.9
28.0%
(0.9)
No
91–120
1.4
53.3%
(0.6)
No
More than 120
29.4
88.6%
(21.7)
Yes
598.1
(29.8)

150
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
ASSETS AND LIABILITIES CONTINUED
14.  Trade and other receivables continued
The following table provides information about the exposure to credit risk and expected credit losses for 
trade receivables as at 31 December 2023.
£m
Gross  
carrying  
amount
Weighted 
average  
loss rate
Net loss 
allowance
Credit 
impaired
Current (not past due)
506.8
0.8%
(3.5)
No
Days overdue:
1–30
10.6
6.8%
(0.6)
No
31–60
3.5
15.0%
(0.4)
No
61–90
1.5
25.0%
(0.3)
No
91–120
0.7
48.3%
(0.3)
No
More than 120
24.0
85.7%
(16.4)
Yes
547.1
(21.5)
15.  Provisions
Accounting policy
A provision is recognised in the balance sheet when the Group has a present legal or constructive 
obligation because of a past event, and it is probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be 
required to settle the obligation. Provisions are measured at the Directors’ best estimate of the 
expenditure required to settle the obligation at the balance sheet dates, and are discounted to present 
value.
Should a provision ultimately prove to be unnecessary then it is credited back into the income statement. 
Where the provision was originally established as an adjusting item, any significant release is shown as 
an adjusting credit.
The Group has a number of vacant and partly sublet leased properties. Where necessary a provision has 
been made for the residual commitments, after taking into account existing and anticipated subtenant 
arrangements. The Group recognises provisions for the cost of reinstating certain Group properties at the 
end of their lease term, based on the conditions set out in the terms of the individual leases. The timing 
of the outflows will match the ends of the relevant leases, which range from two to 25 years.
It is Group policy to self-insure using policies with a high excess against claims arising in respect of 
damage to third party assets, or due to employers or public liability claims. Whilst the Group does not 
have a contractual right to defer payment, the nature of insurance claims means they may take some 
time to be settled. The insurance claims provision represents management’s best estimate, based upon 
external advice of the value of outstanding claims against it where the final settlement date is uncertain, 
in line with IAS 37.
£m 
Property
Insurance
Restructuring
Total
At 1 January 2023
12.4
19.0
–
31.4
Charge to income statement
8.3
7.7
4.9
20.9
Utilisation of provision
(3.6)
(5.6)
–
(9.2)
At 31 December 2023
17.1
21.1
4.9
43.1
Charge to income statement
17.5
3.1
17.2
37.8
Utilisation of provision
(6.4)
(4.3)
(9.2)
(19.9)
At 31 December 2024
28.2
19.9
12.9
61.0
Included in current liabilities
6.6
19.9
12.9
39.4
Included in non-current liabilities
21.6
–
–
21.6
28.2
19.9
12.9
61.0

151
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
The restructuring provision relates to the support functions and supply chain restructuring activities treated 
as adjusting items and discussed note 3. It excludes property-related provisions and inventory amounts 
which are separately classified. 
The following table details the Group’s liquidity analysis of its provisions, based on the undiscounted net cash 
outflows. The impact of discounting is not material for the Group’s provisions.
£m
0–1 year
1–2 years
2–5 years
5+ years
Total
2024:
Property
6.6
7.5
5.9
8.2
28.2
Insurance
19.9
–
–
–
19.9
Restructuring
12.9
–
–
–
12.9
39.4
7.5
5.9
8.2
61.0
2023:
Property
13.3
1.4
1.2
1.2
17.1
Insurance
21.1
–
–
–
21.1
Restructuring
4.9
–
–
–
4.9
39.3
1.4
1.2
1.2
43.1
16.  Deferred tax
The following are the major deferred tax assets and liabilities recognised by the Group and movements 
thereon during the current and prior reporting periods.
£m
(Asset)/liability:
At 1 January 
2024
Recognised in 
income
Recognised in 
equity
Recognised 
in other 
comprehensive 
income
At 31 December 
2024
Trading losses
(18.0)
0.5
–
–
(17.5)
Deferred tax asset
(18.0)
0.5
–
–
(17.5)
Capital allowances
21.1
(9.7)
–
–
11.4
Revaluation of property
2.9
–
(0.2)
–
2.7
Share-based payments
(2.9)
0.8
(0.1)
–
(2.2)
Provisions
4.4
0.3
–
–
4.7
Property assets acquired in 
business combinations
8.8
(0.8)
–
–
8.0
Brand
21.8
(6.5)
–
–
15.3
Pension scheme asset 
25.1
(5.4)
–
9.5
29.2
Deferred gains on property 
disposals
29.3
(0.7)
–
–
28.6
IFRS 16 lease liability
(151.0)
(12.7)
–
–
(163.7)
IFRS 16 right-of-use asset
132.6
0.9
–
–
133.5
Cash flow hedge 
0.7
–
–
0.1
0.8
Deferred tax liability
92.8
(33.8)
(0.3)
9.6
68.3
Net deferred tax
74.8
(33.3)
(0.3)
9.6
50.8

152
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
ASSETS AND LIABILITIES CONTINUED
16.  Deferred tax continued
£m 
(Asset)/liability:
At 1 January 
2023
Recognised in 
income
Recognised in 
equity
Recognised 
in other 
comprehensive 
income
At 31 December 
2023
Trading losses
(15.0)
(3.0)
–
–
(18.0)
Deferred tax asset
(15.0)
(3.0)
–
–
(18.0)
Capital allowances
8.5
12.6
–
–
21.1
Revaluation of property
3.4
–
(0.5)
–
2.9
Share-based payments
(3.5)
0.7
(0.1)
–
(2.9)
Provisions
4.8
(0.4)
–
–
4.4
Property assets acquired in 
business combinations
9.3
(0.5)
–
–
8.8
Brand
25.0
(3.2)
–
–
21.8
Pension scheme asset 
33.9
1.4
–
(10.2)
25.1
Deferred gains on property 
disposals
31.1
(1.8)
–
–
29.3
IFRS 16 – Lease Liability
(130.5)
(20.5)
–
–
(151.0)
IFRS 16 – Right-of-Use Asset
112.9
19.7
–
–
132.6
Cash flow hedge 
1.1
–
–
(0.4)
0.7
Deferred tax liability
96.0
8.0
(0.6)
(10.6)
92.8
Net deferred tax
81.0
5.0
(0.6)
(10.6)
74.8
The deferred tax asset in respect of trading losses primarily relates to the Toolstation Netherlands business. 
An element of the deferred tax asset is recognised in respect of losses of £3.0m (2023: £7.0m) in the 
Group’s other European Toolstation businesses to offset a deferred tax liability of the same value arising 
in these businesses. No deferred tax asset has been recognised on the remaining losses of £21.7m (2023: 
£76.5m) in the Group’s other European Toolstation businesses as there is currently insufficient evidence that 
these losses would be utilised. The value of unrecognised losses has decreased from the position as at 31 
December 2023 following the cessation of the operations of the Group’s Toolstation France business.
The Group considers it is appropriate to recognise a deferred tax asset on unused trading losses in 
Toolstation Netherlands as forecasts, based on the existing Netherlands store network and the store 
maturity profile of Toolstation stores in the UK and the Netherlands, indicate that the business will be able to 
fully utilise these losses against future profits within a measurable time frame.
17.  Trade and other payables
Accounting policy
Trade and other payables principally comprise amounts outstanding for trade purchases and ongoing 
costs and are measured at amortised cost. The Directors consider that the carrying amount of trade 
payables approximates to their fair value. The Group has financial risk management policies in place to 
ensure that all payables are paid within the credit time frame.
£m
2024
2023
Trade payables
532.9
576.3
Other taxation and social security
79.0
48.6
Other payables
92.8
76.9
Accruals and deferred income
133.5
93.6
Trade and other payables
838.2
795.4
Included in trade payables at 31 December 2024 are amounts of £88.4m (2023: £91.3m) which are due for 
settlement under supplier financing arrangements with third-party banks, of which suppliers had received 
payments for £57.5m (2023: £55.3m). Suppliers choose to enter into these arrangements which provide 
access to the option of early settlement of invoices at interest rates based on Travis Perkins’ credit rating. 
If suppliers do not elect for early payment, invoices are settled on the date agreed in the existing payment 
terms. In some cases, Travis Perkins has agreed extensions to payment terms with suppliers who regularly 
access the scheme, with the longest payment terms 107 days (2023: 107 days), an extension of 45 days 
(2023: 45 days). The total net amount outstanding where terms have been extended at 31 December 2024 
was £9.7m (2023: £10.1m). Liabilities that are part of the arrangement had a range of payment dates of 52 
– 107 days with trade payables that are not part of an arrangement having a range of 45 – 75 days (2023: 
52 – 107 days compared to 45 – 75 days). These arrangements do not provide the Group with a significant 
benefit of additional financing and have been put in place for the benefit of the Group’s suppliers, providing 
them with access to cost-efficient third-party funding. As such, outstanding balances are classified as trade 
payables and form part of the operating cash flows movement in the consolidated cash flow statement. 
There were no non-cash transfers from trade payables to finance payables in 2024 (2023: none). There are 
no significant judgements applied in the calculation of supplier finance balances.

153
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
18.  Pension arrangements
The Group has a number of historical defined benefit pension schemes, all of which are closed to new 
members and future accruals. The Group operates four final salary schemes being The Travis Perkins 
Pensions and Dependants’ Benefit Scheme (“the TP DB scheme”), the BSS Defined Benefit Scheme (“the 
BSS DB Scheme”), the immaterial Platinum pension scheme and the immaterial BSS Ireland Defined 
Benefit Scheme. The reconciliations and disclosures are presented as an aggregation of all schemes as each 
scheme is subject to similar risk characteristics.
Accounting policy
The cost of providing benefits under defined benefit pension schemes is determined using the projected 
unit credit method with actuarial valuations being carried out at the end of each reporting period. 
Remeasurement comprising actuarial gains and losses, the effects of asset ceilings and minimum 
funding payments and the return on scheme assets (excluding interest) are recognised immediately in 
the balance sheet with a charge or credit to the statement of comprehensive income. Remeasurement 
recorded in the statement of comprehensive income is not recycled. Net interest is calculated by applying 
a discount rate to the net defined benefit liability or asset. Net interest expense or income is recognised 
within finance costs.
a.  Expected future cash flows
The Directors have agreed with the BSS DB Scheme’s Trustees and the TP DB Scheme’s Trustees that, 
following the elimination of the deficits in these schemes, no further contributions from the Group are 
currently required. Both schemes fund their management and administrative expenses.
b.  Balance sheet position and movements during the year
The amount included in the balance sheet arising from the Group’s obligations in respect of all of its defined 
benefit schemes and the movements during the year:
£m
2024
2023
Gross 
assets
Gross 
obligations
Net
Gross 
assets
Gross 
obligations
Net
Gross pension asset as  
at 1 January
1,096.9
(996.3)
100.6
1,097.4
(961.5)
135.9
Amounts recognised in income:
Current service costs and 
administration expenses 
(3.0)
(0.1)
(3.1)
(2.3)
–
(2.3)
Interest income/(interest cost)
48.7
(44.2)
4.5
51.5
(45.1)
6.4
Other movements:
Contributions from sponsoring 
companies
0.4
–
0.4
1.4
–
1.4
Foreign exchange
(0.5)
0.4
(0.1)
0.2
(0.1)
0.1
Withdrawal of assets
(23.2)
–
 (23.2)
–
–
–
Benefits paid
(49.8)
49.8
–
(44.1)
44.1
–
Balance sheet reclassifications
–
2.7
2.7
–
–
–
Amounts recognised in other 
comprehensive income:
Return on plan assets (excluding 
amounts in net interest)
(98.4)
–
(98.4)
(7.2)
–
(7.2)
Actuarial loss from changes in 
demographic assumptions
–
(4.7)
(4.7)
–
8.6
8.6
Actuarial gain from changes in 
financial assumptions
–
100.4
100.4
–
(20.4)
(20.4)
Actuarial gain from experience 
adjustments
–
37.8
37.8
–
(21.9)
(21.9)
Gross pension asset as  
at 31 December
971.1
(854.2)
116.9
1,096.9
(996.3)
100.6
The asset valuation of £971.1m (2023: £1,096.9m) at 31 December 2024 consists of the TP DB Scheme 
£738.2m (2023: £843.1m) and the BSS DB Scheme £232.9m (2023: £253.8m). The obligation valuation 
of £854.2m (2023: £996.3m) consists of the TP DB Scheme £645.1m (2023: £755.8m) and the BSS DB 

154
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Scheme £209.1m (2023: £240.5m).
ASSETS AND LIABILITIES CONTINUED
18.  Pension arrangements continued
b.  Balance sheet position and movements during the year continued
The actual loss on scheme assets of £49.7m (2023: gain of £44.3m) is represented by the interest income 
and ‘return on plan assets (excluding amounts net interest)’ figures above.
The withdrawal of assets represents the unwind of a Group-controlled special purpose vehicle (“SPV”) used 
to fund the historical deficit in the TP DB Scheme. See note 18(d)(i) for more information.
The deferred tax liability of £29.2m (2023: £25.1m) has been recognised at the standard rate of corporation 
tax, as this rate best reflects the rate at which the liability will unwind. The pension surplus, net of deferred 
tax, as at 31 December 2024 is £87.7m (2024: £75.5m).
There are no restrictions on the current realisability of the pension surplus. The Group has an explicit right 
to a surplus in respect of the TP DB Scheme and, based on the operation of trust law in a winding up of the 
BSS DB Scheme following a gradual settlement, has an unconditional right to receive any surplus in the BSS 
DB Scheme.
c.  Defined benefit scheme obligations
i.  Valuation of scheme obligations
Full actuarial valuations of the TP DB scheme and the BSS DB scheme have been carried out as at 30 
September 2023. The IAS 19 valuations have been based upon the results of the 30 September 2023 
valuations, updated to 31 December 2024 by a qualified actuary.
The defined benefit pension schemes expose the Group to actuarial risks such as investment risk, interest 
rate risk and longevity risk. A summary of the risks and the management of those risks is given below and 
continued overleaf.
Investment risk
The present value of the defined benefit liabilities of the schemes is calculated using a 
discount rate predetermined by reference to high-quality corporate bond yields. If the return 
on scheme assets is below this rate it may create a plan deficit.
Interest risk
A decrease in corporate bond yields will increase the schemes’ liabilities, but the effect will be 
partially offset by an increase in the return on the schemes’ bond and gilt assets.
Longevity risk
The present value of the liabilities of the schemes is calculated by reference to the best 
estimate of mortality of pension scheme members both during and after their employment. 
An increase in the life expectancy of the schemes’ members will increase the schemes’ 
liabilities.
ii.  Major actuarial assumptions
At 31 December 
2024
At 31 December 
2023
Rate of increase of pensions in payment (post 2006 entitlement)
2.95%
2.85%
Discount rate
5.50%
4.55%
Inflation assumption – RPI
3.05%
2.95%
Inflation assumption – CPI
2.55%
2.45%
The yield curve used in setting the discount rate, which includes bonds with an average AA rating and excludes 
bonds which are sub-sovereign or issued by universities to reflect the credit risk of the defined benefit schemes. 
In respect of longevity, the valuation adopts the S3PA year of birth tables with improvements in life expectancy 
to continue in the medium term, with base year appropriate to the member’s date of birth.
The weighted average life expectancy of 65-year-old members for the mortality tables used to determine 
pension liabilities at 31 December 2024 was 21.6 years for men and 23.8 years for women (2023: 21.1 years 
for men and 23.2 years for women).
iii.  Maturity profile of obligations
The weighted average duration of the obligations of the defined benefit pension schemes is 12.5 years, with 
approximately 90% of the obligations expected to mature by 2060 and the benefits to be paid on a broadly 
straight-line basis over the period to 2060.
iv.  Sensitivities
Key estimate over pension assumptions
The Group has chosen to adopt assumptions that the Directors believe are generally in line with 
comparable companies. If the difference between actual inflation is greater than assumed, or if long-term 
interest rates are lower than assumed, or if the average life expectancy of pensioners increases, then the 
pension surplus could be materially greater/lower than currently stated in the balance sheet.
The estimated effects of changing the key assumptions (discount rate, inflation and life expectancy) on the 
IAS 19 – Employee Benefits balance sheet position as at 31 December 2024 is given below.
£m
Assumption
TP & BSS Schemes 
Consolidated
Discount rate
Increase of 0.25%
(24.7)
Decrease of 0.25%
25.6
Inflation
Increase of 0.25%
14.8
Decrease of 0.25%
(15.0)
Longevity
Increase of 1 year
27.0
Decrease of 1 year
(27.7)

155
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
d.  Scheme assets
i.  Scheme assets and investment strategy
The assets of the TP DB Scheme and the BSS DB Scheme are held separately from those of the Group in 
funds under the control of the schemes’ Trustees.
In June 2010, an agreement was reached with the Trustees of the TP DB scheme to fund £34.7m of 
the funding deficit using a Group-controlled special purpose vehicle (“SPV”). The pension scheme is no 
longer in a funding deficit so in December 2024 the Trustees agreed to remove the SPV structure. The 
asset previously recognised as part of the TP DB scheme’s assets and the Group’s liability have both 
been derecognised as a result of this. The pension scheme continues to hold charges over certain of the 
properties previously held in the SPV structure.
The investment strategy for the UK schemes are controlled by the Trustee in consultation with the Company. 
The scheme assets do not include any of the Group’s own financial instruments. In accordance with the 
schemes’ derisked investment strategy, a high proportion of the largest two pension schemes’ assets are 
invested in gilts and corporate bonds (“liability-driven investments”).
All fair values are provided by the fund managers. Where available, the fair values are quoted prices (e.g. 
listed equity, sovereign debt and corporate bonds). Unlisted investments are included at values provided 
by the fund manager in accordance with relevant guidance. Other significant assets are valued based on 
observable inputs such as yield curves. The liability-driven investments, which comprise fixed-interest and 
index-linked gilts, futures, interest and inflation rate swaps, repurchase agreements and liquidity funds, are 
all daily priced and traded.
In June 2023, the High Court handed down a decision in the case of Virgin Media Limited v NTL Pension 
Trustees II Limited and others relating to the validity of certain historical pension changes due to the lack 
of actuarial confirmation required by law. In July 2024, the Court of Appeal dismissed the appeal brought 
by Virgin Media Ltd against aspects of the June 2023 decision. The conclusions reached by the court in 
this case may have implications for other UK defined benefit plans. The Company and pension trustees 
are currently considering the implications of the case for the TP DB Scheme and the BSS DB scheme. 
The defined benefit obligation has been calculated on the basis of the pension benefits currently being 
administered, and at this stage the directors do not consider it necessary to make any adjustments as a 
result of the Virgin Media case.
ii.  Fair value of scheme assets
The major categories and fair values of scheme assets at the end of the reporting period for each category 
are as follows:
£m
At 31 December 
2024
At 31 December 
2023
Level 1:
Cash
71.8
36.3
Level 2:
Equities
0.9
0.8
Secured finance
34.1
37.9
Corporate bonds
522.6
510.5
Diversified growth fund
1.4
1.5
Liability driven investments
876.6
870.4
Repurchase agreements
(633.8)
(500.7)
Level 3:
SPV asset
–
23.2
Secured finance income fund
97.5
117.0
971.1
1,096.9
e.  Defined contribution schemes
The Group operates two defined contribution schemes for all qualifying colleagues. The pension cost, which 
represents contributions payable by the Group, amounted to £19.0m in the year (2023: £19.9m).
f.  Pension scheme contributions for the year
The total charge to the income statement disclosed in note 32 of £22.1m (2023: £21.9m) comprises defined 
benefit scheme current service costs of £3.1m (2023: £2.3m) and £19.0m (2023: £19.9m) of contributions 
payable to the defined contribution schemes.

156
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CAPITAL
19.  Share capital and reserves
Accounting policy
Equity instruments represent the ordinary share capital of the Group and are recorded at the proceeds 
received, net of directly attributable incremental issue costs.
Consideration paid by the Group for its own shares is deducted from total shareholders’ equity. Where 
such shares vest to colleagues under the terms of the Group’s share incentive schemes or the Group’s 
Sharesave schemes or are sold, any consideration received is included in shareholders’ equity.
a.  Share capital
Ordinary shares 
Authorised, issued and fully paid
No.
£m
At 1 January and 31 December 2024
212,509,334
23.8
The Company has one class of ordinary share that carries no right to fixed income. The holders of ordinary 
shares are entitled to receive dividends as declared and are entitled to one vote per share at meetings of the 
Company. All shares rank equally with regard to the Company’s residual assets.
b.  Own shares 
No.
2024
2023
At 1 January
1,668,682
2,596,684
Reissued
(476,499)
(928,002)
At 31 December
1,192,183
1,668,682
The own shares are held by the Employee Share Ownership Trust to satisfy options under the Group’s share 
option schemes. None of the own shares have been allocated to grants of executive options and all rights 
attaching to the shares are suspended until the shares are reissued.
c.  Reserves
A description of the nature and purpose of each reserve is given below:
•	 The share premium represents the amounts above the nominal value received for shares sold.
•	 The cash flow hedge reserve represents the cumulative gain or loss on the fair value of effective hedging 
instruments used in cash flow hedges which have not yet been reclassified to profit or loss. 
•	 The merger reserve represents the premium on equity instruments issued as consideration for the 
acquisition of BSS.
•	 The revaluation reserve represents the revaluation surplus that arose from property revaluations in 1999 and 
prior years.
•	 The own shares reserve represents the cost of shares purchased in the market and held by the Employee 
Share Ownership Trust to satisfy options under the Group’s share option schemes.
•	 The foreign exchange reserve represents the exchange differences recognised on translation of the assets 
and liabilities of the operations that have a functional currency different from the Group.
•	 Other reserves relates to a capital redemption reserve arising as a result of the share buybacks and the 
subsequent cancellation of shares.
•	 Retained earnings represents cumulative results for the Group less cumulative dividends paid.

157
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
20.  Earnings per share
a.  Basic and diluted earnings per share
£m
2024
2023 
(re-presented)
Profit/(loss) attributable to the owners of the parent
– from continuing operations
(40.6)
89.5
– from discontinued operations
(36.8)
(51.4)
Weighted average number of shares for the purposes of basic earnings per 
share
211,106,493
210,530,726
Dilutive effect of share options on potential ordinary shares
3,794,915
3,616,786
Weighted average number of ordinary shares for the purposes of diluted 
earnings per share
214,901,408
214,147,512
Earnings/(loss) per share
– from continuing operations
(19.2)p
42.5p
– from discontinued operations
(17.4)p
(24.4)p
– total
(36.6)p
18.1p
Diluted earnings/(loss) per share
– from continuing operations
(19.2)p
41.8p
– from discontinued operations
(17.4)p
(24.0)p
– total
(36.6)p
17.8p
A total of 159,768 share options (2023: 620,310 share options) had an exercise price in excess of the 
average market value of the shares during the year. As a result, these share options were excluded from the 
calculation of diluted earnings per share.
b.  Adjusted earnings per share
Adjusted earnings per share is calculated by excluding the effect of adjusting items, the amortisation of 
acquired intangible assets from earnings and the loss from discontinued operations.
£m
2024
2023
(re-presented)
(Loss)/earnings for the purposes of earnings per share
(77.4)
38.1
Adjusting items
139.1
26.9
Amortisation of acquired intangible assets
10.4
10.5
Tax on adjusting items
(29.0)
(9.7)
Tax on amortisation of acquired intangible assets
(2.6)
(2.6)
Loss from discontinued operations
36.8
51.4
Earnings for adjusted earnings per share
77.3
114.6
Adjusted earnings per share
36.6p
54.4p
21.  Dividends
Accounting policy
Dividends proposed by the Board of Directors and unpaid at the period end are not recognised in the 
financial statements until they have been approved by shareholders at the Annual General Meeting.
Amounts were recognised in the financial statements as distributions to equity shareholders as follows:
£m
2024
2023
Final dividend for the year ended 31 December 2023 of 5.5 pence 
(2022: 26.5 pence) per ordinary share
11.6
55.8
Interim dividend for the year ended 31 December 2024 of 5.5 pence 
(2023: 12.5 pence) per ordinary share
11.6
26.3
Total dividend recognised during the year
23.2
82.1
The Directors are recommending a final dividend of 9.0 pence in respect of the year ended 31 December 
2024. The anticipated cash payment in respect of the proposed final dividend is £19.1m (2023: £11.7m).

158
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CAPITAL continued
22.  Borrowings
Accounting policy
Interest-bearing bank loans and overdrafts, loan notes and other loans are recognised in the balance 
sheet at amortised cost. Finance charges associated with arranging non-equity funding are recognised in 
the income statement over the life of the facility. All other borrowing costs are recognised in the income 
statement in accordance with the effective interest rate method.
A summary of the Group’s objectives, policies, procedures and strategies with regard to financial 
instruments and capital management can be found in the Strategic Report on page 24. At 31 December 
2024, all borrowings were denominated in sterling (2023: sterling).
a.  Summary
£m
2024
2023
Liability to pension scheme 
–
24.6
Bonds
250.0
250.0
Term loan
75.0
75.0
Senior unsecured notes
100.0
100.0
Overdraft
13.2
–
Finance charges netted off borrowings
(3.2)
(4.5)
435.0
445.1
Current liabilities
13.2
–
Non-current liabilities
421.8
445.1
435.0
445.1
The Group’s term loan, senior unsecured notes and committed revolving credit facility are subject to two 
financial covenants:
•	 Leverage: Net debt/Adjusted EBITDA < 4.0x.
•	 Interest cover: Adjusted operating profit/Net interest payable > 2.0x.
b.  Analysis of other borrowings
£m
2024
2023
Borrowings repayable:
On demand or within one year
13.2
–
More than one year, but not more than five years
325.0
325.0
More than five years
100.0
124.6
Gross borrowings
438.2
449.6
Unamortised fees
(3.2)
(4.5)
435.0
445.1
c.  Facilities
At 31 December 2024, the following facilities were available:
£m
2024
2023
Drawn facilities:
£250m bond 
250.0
250.0
£75m term loan
75.0
75.0
£100m senior unsecured notes
100.0
100.0
425.0
425.0
Undrawn facilities:
Five-year committed revolving credit facility
375.0
375.0
Bank overdrafts
15.0
15.0
390.0
390.0
The disclosures in note 22(c) do not include leases or the effect of finance charges netted off bank debt.
The overdraft balance of £13.2m on 31 December 2024 formed part of the Group’s notional cash pool and 
its aggregate cash position of £231.2m. The Group’s £15.0m overdraft facility and the Group’s £375.0m 
revolving credit facility were undrawn as at 31 December 2024.

159
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
d.  Interest
The weighted average interest rates received on assets and paid on liabilities were as follows:
%
2024
2023
Assets:
Short-term deposits
5.0
4.7
Liabilities:
2026 £250m bond 
3.8
3.8
£75m term loan 
4.6
4.6
£100m senior unsecured notes
6.2
6.2
Bank loans and overdrafts
6.0
8.7
In respect of income earning financial assets and interest-bearing financial liabilities, the following table 
indicates their effective interest rates at the balance sheet date:
2024
2023
Effective  
interest rate
£m
Effective  
interest rate
£m
Assets:
Short-term deposits
4.4%
200.0
5.2%
101.5
Liabilities:
2026 £250m bond
3.8%
250.0
3.8%
250.0
Term loan
4.6%
75.0
4.6%
75.0
Senior unsecured notes
6.2%
100.0
6.2%
100.0
425.0
425.0
e.  Fair values
The book values of financial assets and liabilities have been determined based on amortised cost. For 
the majority of these, the fair values are not materially different from their carrying amounts. Significant 
differences were identified for the Group’s £250m of bonds as at 31 December 2024, where the assessed 
fair value based on quoted mid-market prices was £244.8m (2023: £250m of bonds with an assessed fair 
value of £236.9m).
Details of the fair values of derivatives are given in notes 27 and 28.
f.  Guarantees and security
There are cross guarantees on the overdrafts between Group companies.
Travis Perkins Trading Company Limited, Travis Perkins (Properties) Limited, TP Property Company 
Limited, CCF Limited, Keyline Civils Specialist Limited, Toolstation Limited and The BSS Group Limited are 
guarantors of the following facilities advanced to Travis Perkins plc:
•	 £250m bond.
•	 £75m term loan.
•	 £100m senior unsecured notes.
•	 £375m revolving credit facility (2023: £375m).
•	 Currency derivatives (note 28).
The Group companies have entered into other guarantee and counter-indemnity arrangements in respect 
of guarantees issued in favour of Group companies by several banks amounting to approximately £31.8m 
(2023: £31.8m).
The interest rate swap is guaranteed by Travis Perkins Trading Company Limited, Travis Perkins (Properties) 
Limited, CCF Limited and Keyline Civils Specialist Limited.

160
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CAPITAL CONTINUED
23.  Net debt
Accounting policy
Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash balances and cash deposits with an original maturity of three 
months or less held by the Group and Company, net of overdrafts. The carrying amount of these assets 
approximates to their fair value.
Movement in net debt
Net debt is defined as the sum of current and non-current debt, less cash and cash equivalents.
£m
Cash and cash 
equivalents, 
including 
overdraft
Leases
Term loan
Senior 
unsecured 
notes
Liability to 
pension 
scheme
Total
At 1 January 2023
(223.2)
512.6
73.4
429.0
26.7
818.5
Additions to leases 
–
185.5
–
–
–
185.5
Disposals of leases
–
(5.2)
–
–
–
(5.2)
Cash flow
91.7
(110.7)
–
(80.0)
(3.7)
(102.7)
Finance charges and fees
–
–
(1.9)
–
–
(1.9)
Discount unwind on liability 
to pension scheme
–
–
–
–
1.6
1.6
Discount unwind on lease 
liabilities
–
26.2
–
–
–
26.2
At 1 January 2024
(131.5)
608.4
71.5
349.0
24.6
922.0
Additions to leases 
–
152.1
–
–
–
152.1
Disposals of leases
–
(8.6)
–
–
–
(8.6)
Cash flow
(99.7)
(127.4)
–
–
–
(227.1)
Finance charges and fees
–
–
0.9
0.4
–
1.3
Loan Settlement 
–
–
–
–
(24.6)
(24.6)
Discount unwind  
on lease liabilities
–
30.1
–
–
–
30.1
31 December 2024
(231.2)
654.6
72.4
349.4
–
845.2
Cash and cash equivalents comprises short-term deposits of £200.0m (2023: £101.5m), cash of £44.4m 
(2023: £30.0m) and overdraft of £13.2m (2023: £nil). Net debt before lease liability was £190.6m (2023: 
£313.6m).
24.  Cash flow metrics
a.  Free cash flow
£m
2024
2023 
(re-presented)
Adjusted operating profit
151.8
198.1
Less: Profit on disposal of properties
(11.3)
(15.1)
Adjusted operating profit excluding property profit
140.5
183.0
Share-based payments
11.7
14.6
Other net interest paid
(19.5)
(25.0)
Interest on lease liabilities
(29.6)
(25.6)
Income tax paid
(20.9)
(40.7)
Movement on working capital
5.5
(22.6)
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment
79.8
79.1
Amortisation and impairment of internally-generated intangibles
3.6
4.6
Capital expenditure excluding freehold purchases
(63.8)
(107.2)
Disposal of plant and equipment
1.2
2.0
Free cash flow
108.5
62.2
b.  Cash conversion
£m
2024
2023 
(re-presented)
Adjusted operating profit excluding property profit
140.5
183.0
Movement on working capital
5.5
(22.6)
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment
79.8
79.1
Amortisation and impairment of internally-generated intangibles
3.6
4.6
Share-based payments
11.7
14.6
Capital expenditure excluding freehold purchases
(63.8)
(107.2)
177.3
151.5
Cash conversion
126%
83%

161
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
25.  Net debt to adjusted EBITDA
Net debt to adjusted EBITDA is defined as the ratio of net debt (note 23) to earnings before interest, tax, 
depreciation, amortisation and adjusting items (“adjusted EBITDA”) and is used in one of the Group’s debt 
covenants.
£m
2024
2023 
Operating profit
2.3
109.9
Depreciation and amortisation
190.5
186.5
Adjusting items 
139.1
60.0
Adjusted EBITDA 
331.9
356.4
Net debt 
845.2
922.0
Net debt to adjusted EBITDA
2.5x
2.6x
In accordance with the Group’s debt covenant definitions, the comparative year ended 31 December 2023 
has not been re-presented for this APM to exclude the result of the Toolstation France business.
26.  Return on capital ratios
Group return on capital employed is calculated as follows:
£m
2024
2023  
(re-presented)
Operating profit
2.3
160.7
Amortisation of acquired intangible assets
10.4
10.5
Adjusting items 
139.1
26.9
Adjusted operating profit
151.8
198.1
Opening net assets
2,040.3
2,102.2
Net pension surplus
(75.5)
(102.0)
Net debt 
922.0
818.5
Opening capital employed
2,886.8
2,818.7
Closing net assets
1,974.1
2,040.3
Net pension surplus
(87.7)
(75.5)
Net debt
845.2
922.0
Closing capital employed
2,731.6
2,886.8
Average capital employed
2,809.2
2,852.8
Group return on capital employed is calculated as follows:
£m
2024
2023 
(re-presented)
Adjusted operating profit
151.8
198.1
Average capital employed
2,809.2
2,852.8
Return on capital employed
5.4%
6.9%
RISK
27. Financial risk management
The overall aim of the Group’s financial risk management policies is to minimise potential adverse effects on 
financial performance and net assets. The Group manages the principal financial and treasury risks within a 
framework of policies and operating parameters reviewed and approved annually by the Board of Directors. 
The Group does not enter into speculative transactions. The Group’s risk management policy is further 
discussed on page 24. The Group’s accounting policy for its cash flow hedges is set out in note 28.
a.  Derivatives
During 2022 the Group obtained a 5-year term loan facility for £75m and at the same time entered into an 
equal interest rate swap arrangement to hedge the full variable component of the interest rate for the life of 
the instrument. The risk management objective is to hedge against the fair value of the variable interest rate 
element of the loan facility. The interest rate swap is a derivative measured at fair value and is designated in 
the hedging relationship in its entirety, therefore the hedging instrument is eligible for hedge accounting.
The Group has the following derivative financial instruments in the balance sheet:
£m
2024
2023
Non-current assets
Interest rate swap – cash flow hedge
3.3
2.9
Total non-current derivative financial instrument assets
3.3
2.9

162
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
RISK continued
27. Financial risk management continued
a.  Derivatives continued
The Group’s hedging reserve relates to the following hedge instrument:
£m
Interest rate swaps
At 1 January 2023.
3.2
Change in fair value of hedging instrument recognised in OCI 
(1.4)
Deferred tax
0.4
At 1 January 2024
2.2
Change in fair value of hedging instrument recognised in OCI 
0.4
Deferred tax
(0.1)
At 31 December 2024
2.5
A net gain of £0.8m (2023: loss £0.2m) on foreign currency forwards not qualifying as hedges was 
recognised in the Group’s profit and loss and included in other losses. Hedge effectiveness was determined 
at the inception of the swap arrangement and through prospective effectiveness assessments, to ensure that 
an economic relationship exists between the loan facility and the interest rate swap. As both the loan and 
interest rate swap have the same critical terms, with the value, term and payment timings aligned, there is no 
portion of the hedge which is considered to be ineffective.
Swaps currently in place cover 100% of the variable term loan principal outstanding. The fixed interest 
rate of the swap is 2.673%. The interest rate of the term loan consists of a variable element based on the 
Sterling Overnight Index Average (‘SONIA’) and a margin between 1.8% – 2.4%. The swap contracts require 
settlement of the net interest receivable or payable every 6 months and coincides with the dates on which 
payment is due on the underlying term loan.
The effects of the interest rate swaps of the Group’s financial position and performance are as follows: 
£m
2024
2023
Carrying amount (non-current assets)
3.3
2.9
Notional amount
75.0
75.0
Maturity date
15 August 2027
15 August 2027
Hedge ratio
1:1
1:1
Change in fair value of hedging instruments for the year 
0.4
(1.4)
Weighted average hedged rate for the year
5.1%
4.6%
28.  Financial instruments
Accounting policy
Investments and other financial assets classification
The Group classifies its financial assets in the following measurement categories:
•	 Those to be measured subsequently at fair value (either through Other Comprehensive Income ‘‘FVOCI’’, 
or through profit or loss “FVTPL”)
•	 Those to be measured at amortised cost
The classification depends on the business model for managing the financial assets and the contractual 
terms of the cash flows.
For assets measured at fair value, gains and losses will either be recorded in profit or loss or OCI. For 
investments in equity instruments that are not held for trading, this will depend on whether the Group 
has made an irrevocable election at the time of initial recognition to account for the equity investment at 
FVTPL or at FVOCI.
The Group reclassifies debt investments when and only when its business model for managing those 
assets changes.
Measurement
At initial recognition, the Group measures a financial asset at its fair value plus, in the case of a financial 
asset not at FVTPL, transaction costs that are directly attributable to the acquisition of the financial asset. 
Transaction costs of financial assets carried at FVTPL are expensed in profit or loss.
Debt instruments
Subsequent measurement of debt instruments depends on the Group’s business model for managing 
the asset and the cash flow characteristics of the asset. There are two measurement categories into 
which the Group classifies its debt instruments:
•	 Amortised cost: Assets that are held for collection of contractual cash flows where those cash flows 
represent solely payments of principal and interest are measured at amortised cost. Interest income 
from these financial assets is included in finance income using the effective interest rate method. Any 
gain or loss arising on derecognition is recognised directly in profit or loss and presented in finance 
income or finance costs, together with foreign exchange gains and losses. Impairment losses are 
presented as a separate line item in the income statement.
•	 FVTPL: Assets that do not meet the criteria for amortised cost or FVOCI are measured at FVTPL. A gain 
or loss on a debt instrument that is subsequently measured at FVTPL is recognised in profit or loss and 
presented net within other gains and losses in the period in which it arises.

163
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Equity instruments
The Group subsequently measures all equity investments at fair value. Where the Group’s management 
has elected to present fair value gains and losses on equity investments in OCI, there is no subsequent 
reclassification of fair value gains and losses to profit or loss following the derecognition of the 
investment. Dividends from such investments continue to be recognised in profit or loss when the 
Group’s right to receive payments is established.
Changes in the fair value of financial assets at FVTPL are recognised in finance income or finance costs 
in the income statement as applicable. Impairment losses (and the reversal of impairment losses) on 
equity investments measured at FVOCI are not reported separately from other changes in fair value.
Impairment
From 1 January 2018, the Group assesses on a forward-looking basis the expected credit losses 
associated with its debt instruments carried at amortised cost and FVOCI. The impairment methodology 
applied depends on whether there has been a significant increase in credit risk. For trade receivables, 
the Group applies the simplified approach permitted by IFRS 9 – Financial Instruments, which requires 
expected lifetime losses to be recognised from initial recognition of the receivables.
Derivative financial instruments
The Group uses derivative financial instruments to hedge its exposure to interest rate and foreign 
exchange risks arising from financing activities. The Group does not enter into speculative financial 
instruments. In accordance with its treasury policy, the Group does not hold or issue derivative financial 
instruments for derivative trading purposes.
Derivative financial instruments are stated at fair value. The fair value of derivative financial instruments 
is the estimated amount the Group would receive or pay to transfer to a market participant the derivative 
at the balance sheet date, taking into account current interest and exchange rates and the current 
creditworthiness of the counterparties.
Where derivatives do not qualify for hedge accounting, any gains or losses on re-measurement are 
immediately recognised in the Statement of Comprehensive Income. Where derivatives qualify for hedge 
accounting, recognition of any resultant gain or loss depends on the nature of the hedge relationship and 
the items being hedged.
In order to qualify for hedge accounting, the Company is required to document from inception, the 
relationship between the item being hedged and the hedging instrument. The Company is also required to 
document and demonstrate an assessment of the relationship between the hedged item and the hedging 
instrument, which shows that the hedge will be highly effective on an on-going basis. This effectiveness 
testing is performed at each reporting date to ensure that the hedge remains highly effective.
Derivative financial instruments are classified as cash flow hedges when they hedge the Company’s 
exposure to variability in cash flows that are either attributable to a particular risk associated with a 
recognised asset or liability, or a highly probable forecasted transaction. The effective element of any 
gain or loss from re-measuring the derivative instrument is recognised directly in equity.
The associated cumulative gain or loss is removed from equity and recognised in the Statement of 
Comprehensive Income in the same period during which the hedged transaction affects the Statement 
of Comprehensive Income. The classification of the effective portion when recognised in the Statement 
of Comprehensive Income is the same as the classification of the hedged transaction. Any element of 
the re-measurement criteria of the derivative instrument which does not meet the criteria for an effective 
hedge is recognised immediately in the Statement of Comprehensive income.
Hedge accounting is discontinued when the hedging instrument expires or is sold, terminated or 
exercised, or no longer qualifies for hedge accounting or is de-designated. At that point in time, any 
cumulative gain or loss on the hedging instrument recognised in equity is retained in equity until the 
forecasted transaction occurs or the original hedged item affects the Statement of Comprehensive 
Income. If a forecasted hedged transaction is no longer expected to occur, the net cumulative gain or loss 
recognised in equity is transferred to the Statement of Comprehensive Income.
Foreign currency forward contracts are marked-to-market at the balance sheet date, with any gains or 
losses being taken through the income statement. Derivatives embedded in commercial contracts are 
treated as separate derivatives when their risks and characteristics are not closely related to those of the 
underlying contracts, with unrealised gains or losses being reported in the income statement.
a.  The carrying value of categories of financial instruments
£m
2024
2023
Financial assets:
Mandatorily at FVTPL
0.5
–
Loans and receivables (including cash and cash equivalents) at amortised 
cost
911.3
786.3
Designated instrument-by-instrument as either FVTPL or FVOCI
3.3
2.9
915.1
789.2
Financial liabilities:
Mandatorily at FVTPL
–
0.4
Borrowings at amortised cost
435.0
445.1
Trade and other payables (including overdrafts) at amortised cost
625.7
653.2
1,060.7
1,098.7

164
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
c.  Interest risk management
The Group is exposed to interest rate risk as entities in the Group borrow funds at both fixed and floating 
interest rates. The risk is managed by the Group by maintaining an appropriate mix between fixed and 
floating rate borrowings and by the use of interest rate swap contracts and forward interest rate contracts 
when appropriate. Hedging activities are evaluated regularly to align with interest rate views and defined 
risk appetite, ensuring optimal hedging strategies are applied, by either positioning the balance sheet or 
protecting interest expense through different interest rate cycles.
In 2022 the Group entered into an interest rate swap arrangement to hedge the variable interest rate risk on 
a £75m 5-year loan facility. The risk management objective is to hedge against the fair value of the variable 
interest rate element of the loan facility. The interest rate swap is a derivative measured at fair value and is 
designated in the hedging relationship in its entirety.
d.  Currency forward contracts
The Group acquires goods for sale from overseas which, when not denominated in sterling, are paid for 
principally in US dollars and euros. The Group has entered into forward foreign exchange contracts (all of 
which are less than one year in duration) to buy US dollars and euros to hedge the exchange rate risk arising 
from these anticipated future purchases. At the balance sheet date the total notional value of contracts to 
which the Group was committed was €nil and US$24.0m (2023: €6.0m and US$21.5m). The fair value of 
these derivatives was £0.5m asset (2023: £0.4m liability). These contracts are not designated cash flow 
hedges and accordingly the fair value movement has been reflected in the income statement.
e.  Interest rate sensitivity analysis
A sensitivity analysis has been determined based on the exposure to interest rates for both derivatives 
and non-derivative financial instruments at the balance sheet date. For floating rate liabilities, the analysis 
is prepared assuming that the amount of liability outstanding at the balance sheet date was outstanding 
for the whole year. A 1.0% increase or decrease is used when reporting interest rate risk internally to key 
management personnel.
At 31 December 2024 the Group had no floating rate liabilities except for its £75m 5-year term loan facility 
for which the Group entered into an interest rate swap arrangement to hedge the full variable component 
of the interest rate for the life of the instrument. There was £200m on short-term deposit at 31 December 
2024 (2023: £101.5m). A 1.0% increase or decrease in interest rates, with all other variables held constant, 
would have the following impact on:
•	 Profit before taxation for the year ended 31 December 2024 would have increased or decreased by £2.0m 
(2023: increased or decreased by £1.0m) due to the short-term deposits.
•	 Net equity would have increased or decreased by £1.5m (2023: increased or decreased by £0.8m).
RISK CONTINUED
28.  Financial instruments continued
a.  The carrying value of categories of financial instruments continued
Loans and receivables exclude prepayments of £80.4m (2023: £34.8m). Trade and other payables exclude 
taxation and social security and accruals and deferred income totalling £212.5m (2023: £142.2m). The 
carrying amount of financial assets recorded in the financial statements, which is net of impairment losses, 
represents the Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk. The Group has considered the impact of credit risk 
on its financial instruments and because the counterparties are banks with strong credit ratings considers its 
impact to be immaterial. The issuer credit ratings of the banks where the Group’s deposits are held ranges 
from A to AA- (S&P), A1 to Aa2 (Moody’s), and A to AA- (Fitch).
b.  Fair value of financial instruments
Financial assets and financial liabilities designated as FVTPL comprise foreign currency forward contracts 
and are measured using quoted forward exchange rates.
The following table provides an analysis of financial instruments that are measured subsequent to initial 
recognition at fair value, grouped into levels 1 to 3 based on the degree to which the fair value is observable:
•	 Level 1 fair value measurements are those derived from quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for 
identical assets or liabilities.
•	 Level 2 fair value measurements are those derived from inputs other than quoted prices included within 
Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability either directly (i.e. as prices) or indirectly (i.e. derived from 
prices).
•	 Level 3 fair value measurements are those derived from valuation techniques that include inputs for the 
asset or liability that are not based on observable market data (unobservable inputs).
There were no transfers between levels during the year.
£m
2024
2023
Included in assets:
Level 2: Foreign currency forward contracts at fair value through profit and loss
0.5
–
Level 2: Interest rate swap
3.3
2.9
Included in liabilities:
Level 2: Foreign currency forward contracts at fair value through profit and loss
–
(0.4)

165
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
f.  Liquidity analysis
The following table details the Group’s liquidity analysis for its derivative financial instruments and other 
financial liabilities. The table has been drawn up based on the undiscounted net cash flows on the derivative 
instruments that settle on a net basis and the undiscounted gross cash flows on those derivatives that 
require gross settlement. When the amount payable or receivable is not fixed, the amount disclosed has 
been determined by reference to the projected interest and foreign currency rates as illustrated by the yield 
curves existing at the reporting date.
£m
2024
0–1 year
1–2 years
2–5 years
5+ years
Total
Total gross settled: Foreign exchange  
forward contracts
(18.7)
–
–
–
(18.7)
Total net settled: Interest rate swap – cash 
flow hedge
1.1
0.9
0.7
–
2.7
Total derivative financial instruments
(17.6)
0.9
0.7
–
(16.0)
Net settled:
Borrowings
(30.6)
(270.6)
(132.7)
(72.2)
(506.1)
Trade and other payables at amortised 
cost 
(625.7)
–
–
–
(625.7)
Leases 
(119.9)
(208.0)
(161.3)
(336.2)
(825.4)
Total financial instruments
(776.2)
(478.6)
(294.0)
(408.4)
(1,957.2)
£m
2023
0–1 year
1–2 years
2–5 years
5+ years
Total
Total gross settled: Foreign exchange  
forward contracts
(22.9)
–
–
–
(22.9)
Total net settled: Interest rate swap – cash 
flow hedge
1.9
1.9
3.1
–
6.9
Total derivative financial instruments
(21.0)
1.9
3.1
–
(16.0)
Net settled:
Borrowings
(24.9)
(24.9)
(366.2)
(143.9)
(559.9)
Trade and other payables at amortised 
cost 
(653.2)
–
–
–
(653.2)
Leases 
(108.9)
(101.1)
(237.8)
(316.6)
(764.4)
Total financial instruments
(787.0)
(126.0)
(604.0)
(460.5)
(1,977.5)
29.  Impairment
Accounting policy
Impairment of tangible and intangible assets
The carrying amounts of the Group’s tangible and intangible assets with a definite useful life are reviewed 
at each balance sheet date to determine whether there is any indication of impairment to their value. 
If such an indication exists, the asset’s recoverable amount is estimated and compared to its carrying 
value. Where the asset does not generate cash flows that are independent from other assets, the Group 
estimates the recoverable amount of the CGU to which the asset belongs. The Group’s CGUs are the 
branches of its Merchanting and Toolstation businesses and the Staircraft business. The recoverable 
amount of an asset is the greater of its fair value less disposal cost and its value-in-use (the present 
value of the future cash flows that the asset is expected to generate). In determining value in use the 
present value of future cash flows is discounted using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market 
assessments of the time-value of money in relation to the period of the investment and the risks specific 
to the asset concerned.
Where the carrying value exceeds the recoverable amount a provision for the impairment loss is 
established with a charge being made to the income statement. When the reasons for an impairment 
no longer exist the impairment is reversed in the income statement up to the net book value that the 
relevant asset would have had if it had not been impaired and if it had been depreciated, except in 
respect of goodwill for which impairments are not reversed.
For intangible assets that have an indefinite useful life the recoverable amount is estimated on an annual 
basis.
a. Measuring recoverable amounts
The recoverable amounts of the goodwill and other non-monetary assets with indefinite useful lives are 
determined for all CGUs and CGU groupings from value-in-use calculations, except for the Toolstation 
Benelux CGU grouping and the Staircraft CGU, where fair value less cost of disposal (“FVLCD”) calculations 
have been used. The Toolstation Benelux FVLCD model is a discounted cash flow model and the Staircraft 
FVLCD model is an EBITDA multiple model. The different FVLCD methods for Toolstation Benelux and 
Staircraft reflect Toolstation Benelux being a high-growth loss-making business and Staircraft being a 
relatively mature business. The valuations are considered to be level 3 in the fair value hierarchy due to 
unobservable inputs used in the valuation.
The key financial assumptions for the value-in-use models and the Toolstation Benelux discounted cash flow 
model are those regarding the discount rate and the terminal growth rate. The key operating assumptions for 
these models are sales growth and operating margin percentage. The key assumption for the Staircraft CGU 
calculation is that a market participant would use an EBITDA multiple of 8x. Management estimates pre-tax 
discount rates that reflect current market assessments of the time-value of money and the risks specific to 
the CGU groupings that are not reflected in the cash flow projections.

166
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
•	 Operating margin percentages are forecast in the context of the sales growth assumptions and are based on 
historical experience of operating margins, adjusted for the impact of changes to product costs and 
cost-saving initiatives.
For the less-mature Toolstation Benelux CGU grouping, the key operating assumption is future sales growth. 
This assumption is set in the context of the store opening profile and historical data from the Toolstation UK 
and Toolstation Benelux businesses on the store maturity profile.
Cash flows beyond the strategic plan periods (2029 and beyond for the UK CGUs and 2030 and beyond 
for the Toolstation Benelux CGU) have been determined using the terminal growth rate. The longer period 
used in the FVLCD model for the Toolstation Benelux CGU is consistent with market practice for valuing 
high-growth loss-making businesses. Corporate costs are allocated to CGUs on a pro-rata basis per each 
CGU’s sales.
Results
The recoverable amount of goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives was in excess of their 
book value in all CGUs and CGU groupings and therefore no impairments have been recognised in respect 
of these CGUs and CGU groupings, except for the Staircraft CGU in respect of which a £32.7m impairment 
charge has been recognised.
Indications of impairment were identified for some Merchanting branches, each of which is a CGU, and as a 
result of the impairment reviews performed for these branches an impairment charge of £62.7m has been 
recognised, principally in respect of certain Travis Perkins General Merchant and CCF branches. All these 
impairments relate to the Merchanting segment. The annual impairment reviews for branches in the Group’s 
other businesses did not result in any impairments.
In 2023 an impairment charge of £33.1m was recognised in respect of the Toolstation France CGU grouping 
and of £7.6m in respect of certain Benchmarx branches.
There are no reasonably possible changes in the key assumptions used in the impairment reviews that 
would cause the recoverable amounts to be lower than the carrying amounts except in respect of the 
Toolstation Benelux, Travis Perkins General Merchant and CCF CGU groupings. Sensitivity disclosures are 
provided for these CGU groupings.
Staircraft impairment
Following the annual impairment review of goodwill and intangible assets, an impairment of £32.7m has 
been recognised in respect of the Staircraft CGU. Trading conditions in its market have been challenging and 
as a consequence a lower EBITDA figure has been used in the FVLCD calculation. This impairment charge 
relates to £1.9m of right-of-use assets, £3.6m of tangible fixed assets, £23.8m of goodwill and £3.4m of 
other acquisition-related intangible fixed assets. The recoverable amount of these fixed assets relating to the 
Staircraft business is now £22.0m. There are no reasonably possible changes in the assumptions used in 
this impairment review that would result in a materially different impairment charge.
RISK CONTINUED
29.  Impairment continued
In developing these assumptions, management has considered the possible impacts of climate risks. This 
has included consideration of the impact of climate risks on the Group’s required capital expenditure, on 
energy costs directly in the business and the supply chain and the impact of the changes on the Group’s 
markets and customers.
Key financial assumptions
The key financial assumptions used in the estimation of the recoverable amount are set out below. The 
values assigned to the key financial assumptions represent management’s assessment of current market 
conditions and future trends and have been based on historical data from both external and internal sources.
2024
2023
Pre-tax discount rate
11.7% – 12.9%
12.1% – 13.3%
Terminal growth rate
1.6% – 2.0%
2.0%
The pre-tax discount rate used in the estimation of the recoverable amount for the Travis Perkins General 
Merchant and CCF CGU groupings was 12.9% and for the Toolstation Benelux CGU grouping was 11.7%.
Management determined the values assigned to these financial assumptions as follows:
•	 Pre-tax discount rates: These are calculated by reference to the weighted average cost of capital (“WACC”) of 
the Group and reflect specific risks relating to the Group’s industries and the countries in which the Group 
operates. The pre-tax discount rate is adjusted for risks not adjusted for in the cash flow forecasts, including 
risks related to the industry of each CGU. 
•	 Terminal growth rate: This is the weighted average growth rate used to extrapolate cash flows beyond the 
budget period. For the UK CGUs, this represents the forecast inflation growth for the final year considered in 
the Bank of England’s long-term inflation target. For Toolstation Benelux, this represents the GDP growth 
forecast for the Netherlands in the final available forecast year in the IMF’s World Economic Outlook Database.
Key operating assumptions
Cash flow forecasts are derived from the most recent Board-approved strategic plans, updated for changes 
in current trading conditions and adjusted for risks relevant to the cash flows. The key operating assumptions 
used in the estimation of future cash flows for the UK CGUs and CGU groupings are:
•	 Sales growth rates on which the approved corporate plans are based and which are derived from a variety of 
sources that provide market volume forecasts, including construction and consumer outlook reports, current 
and forecast housing-market transaction numbers and mortgage-approval levels. The Directors consider 
this to be the principal operating assumption as it determines management’s approach to the interlinked 
factors underlying the operating margin percentage.

167
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Branch impairments
The impairment reviews for branches in the Merchanting businesses have resulted in an impairment charge 
of £62.7m being recognised. This charge consists of £49.5m in respect of Travis Perkins General Merchant 
branches, £7.5m in respect of CCF branches and £5.7m in respect of other Merchanting CGUs. It reflects 
the challenging trading conditions and extended period of low market volumes in the UK construction sector. 
The impairment charge relates to £26.7m of right-of-use assets and £36.0m of tangible fixed assets. The 
remaining carrying value of assets related to the branches subject to an impairment charge is £308.7m.
Sensitivity disclosures
The recoverable amounts calculated in the impairment reviews of the Travis Perkins General Merchant, CCF 
and Toolstation Benelux CGU groupings exceeded the carrying amounts as below.
Carrying amount
Headroom
Travis Perkins General Merchant
1,188.4
182.5
CCF
113.1
46.8
Toolstation Benelux
126.1
25.4
Whilst the Directors believe the assumptions are realistic, there are reasonably possible changes in the 
key assumptions that would cause the recoverable amounts of these CGUs to be lower than the carrying 
amounts. The key variables applied to the value-in-use calculations for Travis Perkins General Merchant and 
CCF and the fair value less cost of disposal calculation for Toolstation Benelux, and the value at which the 
recoverable amount would be equal to the carrying amount for each CGU, were:
Travis Perkins  
General Merchant
CCF
Toolstation Benelux
Assumption
Sensitivity
Assumption
Sensitivity
Assumption
Sensitivity
Pre-tax discount rate
12.9%
14.5%
12.9%
16.7%
11.7%
13.2%
Average sales growth
3.5%
3.3%
7.4%
7.2%
13.8%
12.4%
Operating margin
6.0%
4.9%
3.3%
2.3%
n/a
n/a
The average sales growth assumptions, which are compound annual growth rates, reflect an expectation 
that the significant reduction in construction market volumes in the UK and in the Netherlands since 2021 
will be partially reversed over the forecast period. The operating margin figure disclosed is for the terminal 
year of the relevant model. The models are not sensitive to reasonably possible changes to the operating 
margin in years other than the terminal year. These impairment reviews are not sensitive to reasonably 
possible changes to the terminal growth rate. All other variables have been held equal.
There are no reasonably possible changes in the assumptions used in the impairment reviews of Staircraft 
and the Merchanting branches that would result in a materially different impairment charge.
Key estimates over assumptions used in value-in-use calculations
In testing for impairment, the recoverable amount of the Toolstation Benelux CGU has been determined 
by reference to the FVLCD of the CGU grouping. The recoverable amounts of the Travis Perkins General 
Merchant and CCF CGU groupings have been determined by reference to their value-in-use. In producing 
these estimates, the Directors have made certain estimates concerning discount rates, future cash flows 
and the future development of the businesses that are consistent with the 2024 strategic plans and the 
businesses’ 2025 budgets. Whilst the Directors consider the assumptions to be realistic, should actual 
results, including those for future sales growth, be different from expectations, for instance due to a 
worsening of the British economy (or the Dutch or Belgian economy in the case of the Toolstation Benelux 
CGU), then it is possible that the value of goodwill and other intangible and tangible assets included in the 
balance sheet could become impaired or the impairment charge could be different. The range of reasonably 
possible outcomes includes the impairment charges detailed in the scenarios in the table below.
CGU or CGU grouping
Carrying value of 
assets (£m)
Reasonably possible scenario
Impairment charge  
in the scenario (£m)
Toolstation Benelux
126.1
Pre-tax discount rate is 100bps 
higher and sales are cumulatively 
10% lower over the period of the 
modelled cash flows
18.2
Travis Perkins General 
Merchant
1,188.4
Post-tax discount rate is 100bps 
higher, sales are up to 5% lower 
during the period of the modelled 
cash flows and the operating 
margin in the terminal year is 
50bps lower
99.3
CCF
113.1
1.0
30.  Capital commitments
£m
2024
2023
Contracted for but not provided in the accounts
26.4
9.9

168
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
PEOPLE
32.  Staff costs
a.  Average number of persons employed
The average monthly number of persons employed (including Executive Directors):
No.
2024
2023
Sales and distribution
16,243
17,703
Administration
1,351
1,469
17,594
19,172
The average monthly number of persons employed (including Executive Directors) in 2023 excluding the 
discontinued operations was 18,831.
b.  Aggregate remuneration
£m
2024
2023 
(re-presented)
Wages and salaries
565.1
576.5
Social security costs
52.5
55.5
Pension costs (note 18)
22.1
21.9
Share-based payments (note 33)
11.7
14.6
651.4
668.5
Director’s remuneration, including pension contributions and Long-Term Incentive plan awards, is set out in 
the Single Total Figure of Remuneration table in the Directors’ Remuneration report on pages 101 to 102.
The total amounts received or receivable by Directors under long-term incentive schemes in respect of 
qualifying service in the year is £1,000 (2023: £81,000). The aggregate of gains made by the Directors in 
the year on the exercise of share options equated to £nil (2023: £nil). Details with respect to share options 
exercised in the year are set out on page 109.
RISK CONTINUED
31.  Business combinations and disposals
Accounting policy
All business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method. The consideration transferred 
for the acquisition of a subsidiary comprises the:
•	 Fair values of the assets transferred
•	 Liabilities incurred to the former owners of the acquired business
•	 Equity interests issued by the Group
•	 Fair value of any asset or liability resulting from a contingent consideration arrangement
•	 Fair value of any pre-existing equity interest in the subsidiary
The acquiree’s identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities that meet the conditions for 
recognition under IFRS 3 – Business Combinations are recognised at their fair value at the acquisition 
date except that:
•	 Deferred tax assets or liabilities and liabilities or assets related to employee benefit arrangements are 
recognised and measured in accordance with IAS 12 – Income Taxes and IAS 19 – Employee Benefits 
respectively
•	 Liabilities or equity instruments related to the replacement by the Group of an acquiree’s share-based 
payment awards are measured in accordance with IFRS 2 – Share-based Payments
Liabilities for contingent consideration are classified as fair value through profit and loss.
The excess of the consideration transferred, amount of any non-controlling interest in the acquired entity, 
and acquisition-date fair value of any previous equity interest in the acquired entity over the fair value of 
the net identifiable assets acquired is recorded as goodwill.
The Group recognises any non-controlling interest in the acquired entity on an acquisition-by-acquisition 
basis either at fair value or at the non-controlling interest’s proportionate share of the acquired entity’s 
net identifiable assets. Acquisition-related costs are expensed as incurred. Where a business combination 
is achieved in stages, the Group’s previously-held interest in the acquired entity is remeasured to fair 
value at the acquisition date and the resulting gain or loss, if any, is recognised in the income statement.

169
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
33.  Share-based payments
Accounting policy
The Group issues equity-settled share-based payments to colleagues: long-term incentives, executive 
share options and Save As You Earn (“SAYE”). These payments are measured at fair value at the date of 
grant using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model taking into account the terms and conditions upon 
which the options were granted. The cost of equity-settled awards is recognised on a straight-line basis 
over the vesting period, based on the Group’s estimate of the number of shares that will eventually vest.
a.  Fair value of options
The Black-Scholes option-pricing model is used to calculate the fair value of the options and the amount to 
be expensed. The probability of the performance conditions being achieved was included in the fair-value 
calculations. The inputs into the model for options granted in the year expressed as weighted averages are 
as follows:
2024
2023
SAYE
Nil-price
options
SAYE
Nil-price
options
Share price at grant date (pence)
729.0
729.0
828.6
828.6
Option exercise price (pence)
724.0
–
690.0
–
Volatility (%)
32.4%
37.7%
35.6%
40.4%
Option life (years)
3.3
2.6
3.4
3.0
Risk-free interest rate (%)
4.0%
4.4%
4.4%
3.4%
Expected dividends as a dividend yield 
(%)
2.1%
3.3%
4.4%
4.0%
Volatility is based on historic share prices over a period equal to the vesting period. Option life used in the 
model has been based on options being exercised in accordance with historical patterns. For executive share 
options the vesting period is three years.
If options remain unexercised after a period of ten years from the date of grant, these options expire. Options 
are forfeited if the colleague leaves the Group before options vest. SAYE options vest after three or five years 
and expire three and a half or five and a half years after the date of grant.
The risk-free interest rate of return is the yield on zero-coupon UK Government bonds on a term consistent 
with the vesting period. Dividends used are based on actual dividends where data is known and future 
dividends estimated using a dividend cover of three times (within the Board’s target range).
The expected life of options used in the model has been adjusted, based upon management’s best estimate, 
for the effect of non-transferability, exercise restrictions and behavioural considerations.
There are no cash-settled share schemes. All share schemes are equity-settled. 
b.  Income statement charge and shares granted
A description of the share schemes operated by the Group is contained in the remuneration report on page 90. 
The estimated fair values of the shares under option granted under the Group’s share schemes in 2024 are 
as follows:
Share scheme
Grant date
Fair value for the 
Group
£m
Restricted Share Plan (nil-price options)
16 April 2024
5.5
Buyout Award 
25 April 2024
1.0
Restricted Share Plan (nil-price options)
16 September 2024
1.4
Save As You Earn
26 September 2024
3.6
c.  Share options for the Group
The number and weighted average exercise price of share options is as follows:
In thousands of options
The Group
2024
2023
Weighted 
average 
exercise price 
(pence)
Number of 
options
Number of nil 
price options
Weighted 
average 
exercise price 
(pence)
Number of 
options
Number of nil 
price options
Outstanding at the 
beginning of the year
527
5,132
2,229
823
5,276
2,568
Forfeited during the year
542
(1,644)
(481)
652
(2,649)
(279)
Exercised during the year
706
(19)
(458)
747
(4)
(925)
Granted during the year
724
1,040
1,066
690
2,509
865
Outstanding at the end of 
the year
474
4,509
2,356
527
5,132
2,229
Exercisable at the end of  
the year
547
39
75
352
201
417
The weighted-average share price on the date of exercise of options exercised in the period was 896 pence 
(2023: 921 pence).

170
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
PEOPLE continued
33.  Share-based payment continued
Details of the options outstanding at 31 December are as follows:
2024
2023
Executive  
options
SAYE
Nil price 
options
Executive 
options
SAYE
Nil price 
options
Range of exercise  
prices (pence)
898 – 1,958.0 690 – 1,411.0
–
898 – 1,958
690 – 1,411
–
Weighted average 
exercise price (pence)
1,304
717
–
1,328
749
–
Number of shares 
(thousands)
14
4,530
2,349
3
5,132
2,226
Weighted average 
expected remaining  
life (years)
–
2.1
1.6
–
2.7
1.8
Weighted average 
contractual remaining 
life (years)
–
2.6
11.6
–
3.2
8.6
d.  Impact of vesting and exercise
If all SAYE shares are acquired on the first possible day, 4.5m of shares will be issued for a consideration of 
£32.1m in the years below:
2025
2026
2027
2028
2029
No. m
£m
No. m
£m
No. m
£m
No. m
£m
No. m
£m
Options
0.5
0.0
0.6
0.0
0.8
0.0
0.1
0.0
0.0
0.0
SAYE
1.5
10.5
1.4
9.9
1.1
8.2
0.4
2.6
0.1
0.9
The table above shows theoretical amounts. For the Group to receive the cash indicated in the periods 
shown, the following must occur:
•	 All performance conditions on executive share options must be fully met.
•	 Options must be exercised on the day they vest (option holders generally have a seven year period post 
vesting to exercise the option).
•	 The share price at the exercise date for SAYE options must exceed the exercise price and every holder must 
exercise.
•	 All option/SAYE holders must remain with the Group, or leave on good terms.
If none of the requirements are met then the Group will receive no consideration.
34.  Key management personnel
The remuneration of the key management personnel of the Group is set out below in aggregate for each of 
the categories specified in IAS 24 – Related Party Disclosures.
£m
2024
2023
Short-term employee benefits
10.9
9.9
Post-employment benefits
0.5
0.5
Share-based payments
3.8
5.2
15.2
15.6
35.  Related party transactions
The Group has a related party relationship with its subsidiaries, its Directors and with its pension schemes 
(note 18). Transactions between Group companies, which are related parties, have been eliminated on 
consolidation and are not disclosed in this note.

171
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
OTHER
36.  Impact of new standards and interpretations
A number of new or amended standards became applicable for the current reporting period and as a result 
the Group has applied the following standards:
•	 Classification of liabilities as current or non-current, and non-current Liabilities with covenants (amendments 
to IAS 1 – presentation of Financial Statements).
•	 Lease liability in a sale-and-leaseback (amendments to IFRS 16 – Leases).
•	 Supplier finance arrangements (amendment to IAS 7 – Statement of Cash Flows and IFRS 7 – Financial 
Instruments: Disclosures).
The above requirements did not have a material impact on the Group and have been adopted without 
restating comparatives. 
At the date of the approval of these financial statements, the following standards and interpretations, which 
have not been applied in these financial statements, were in issue, but not yet effective:
•	 IFRS 18 – Presentation and disclosure in financial statements.
•	 IFRS 19 – Subsidiaries without Public Accountability: Disclosures.
•	 Amendments to IAS 21 – Lack of exchangeability.
•	 Annual improvements to IFRS – Volume 11
•	 Amendments to IFRS 9 and IFRS 7 – Classification and measurement of financial instruments and contracts 
referencing nature-dependent electricity
Based on their initial assessment, the Directors anticipate that adoption of these standards and 
interpretations in future periods will not have a material impact on the financial statements of the Group.

172
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
COMPANY BALANCE SHEET
As at 31 December 2024
£m
Notes
2024
2023
Assets
Non-current assets
Tangible assets
–
0.1
Investment in subsidiaries
2
2,416.7
1,921.9
Derivative financial instruments
9
3.8
2.9
Total non-current assets
2,420.5
1,924.9
Current assets
Debtors
4
200.5
644.0
Cash and cash equivalents, excluding bank overdrafts
201.1
108.9
Total current assets
401.6
752.9
Total assets
2,822.1
2,677.8
Equity and liabilities
Capital and reserves
Issued capital
23.8
23.8
Share premium account
545.6
545.6
Cash flow hedge reserve
2.5
2.9
Merger reserve
326.5
326.5
Own shares
(7.2)
(14.1)
Other reserves
1.4
1.4
Accumulated profits
1,269.6
1,317.2
Total equity
5
2,162.2
2,203.3
Non-current liabilities
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
6
421.8
420.5
Total non-current liabilities
421.8
420.5
£m
Notes
2024
2023
Current liabilities
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
6
13.2
–
Derivative financial instruments
9
–
0.4
Amounts due to subsidiaries
7
209.2
36.1
Other creditors
10
15.7
17.5
Total current liabilities
238.1
54.0
Total liabilities
659.9
474.5
Total equity and liabilities
2,822.1
2,677.8
The Company’s profit for the year was £28.8m (2023: £297.1m), and total comprehensive income for the 
year was £28.5m (2023: £295.7m).
The accompanying notes form an integral part of these financial statements.
The financial statements of Travis Perkins plc, registered number 824821, were approved by the Board of 
Directors on 31 March 2025 and signed on its behalf by:
Geoff Drabble	
	
Duncan Cooper 
Chair	
	
	
Director

173
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
COMPANY STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY
For the year ended 31 December 2024
£m
Share 
capital
Share
premium
Merger
reserve
Hedging  
reserve
Own  
shares
Other
Retained  
earnings
Total  
equity
At 1 January 2023
23.8
545.6
326.5
4.3
(34.3)
1.4
1,107.8
1,975.1
Profit and total comprehensive income for the year
–
–
–
(1.4)
–
–
297.1
295.7
Dividends
–
–
–
–
–
–
(82.1)
(82.1)
Own shares movement
–
–
–
–
20.2
–
(20.2)
–
Equity-settled share-based payments net of tax
–
–
–
–
–
–
14.6
14.6
At 31 December 2023
23.8
545.6
326.5
2.9
(14.1)
1.4
1,317.2
2,203.3
Profit and total comprehensive income for the year
–
–
–
0.3
–
–
(28.8)
(28.5)
Dividends
–
–
–
–
–
–
(23.2)
(23.2)
Sale of own shares
–
–
–
–
0.1
–
–
0.1
Own shares movement
–
–
–
–
6.8
–
(6.8)
–
Equity-settled share-based payments net of tax
–
–
–
–
–
–
11.7
11.7
Exercise of options over non-controlling interest
–
–
–
–
–
–
(1.2)
(1.2)
Reclassifications
–
–
–
(0.7)
–
–
0.7
–
At 31 December 2024
23.8
545.6
326.5
2.5
(7.2)
1.4
1,269.6
2,162.2

174
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
NOTES TO THE COMPANY’S FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
For the year ended 31 December 2024
GENERAL INFORMATION
Overview
Travis Perkins plc is the ultimate parent of the Travis Perkins plc Group (“the Group”). The nature of the 
Group’s operations and its principal activities are set out in the Strategic report on pages 2 to 70. The 
Company is incorporated and is domiciled in the United Kingdom as a public limited company under the 
Companies Act 2006. The address of the registered office is Lodge Way House, Lodge Way, Harlestone 
Road, Northampton NN5 7UG.
These financial statements are presented in pounds sterling, the currency of the primary economic 
environment in which the Group operates.
Basis of accounting
The Company meets the definition of a qualifying entity under Financial Reporting Standard 100 and as 
such these financial statements have been prepared in accordance with Financial Reporting Standard 
101 Reduced Disclosure Framework (“FRS 101”). In preparing these financial statements, the Company 
applies the recognition, measurement and disclosure requirements of UK-adopted international accounting 
standards, but makes amendments where necessary in order to comply with Companies Act 2006 and has 
set out below where advantage of the FRS 101 disclosure exemptions has been taken.
As permitted by section 408 of the Companies Act 2006, the income statement of the Company has not 
been presented.
The Company has taken advantage of the following disclosure exemptions under FRS 101:
•	 The requirements of IFRS 2 “Share-based Payment” in respect of Group settled share-based payments;
•	 The requirements of IFRS 7 “Financial Instruments: Disclosures”.
•	 The requirements of paragraphs 91 to 99 of IFRS 13 “Fair Value Measurement”.
•	 The requirement in paragraph 38 of IAS 1 “Presentation of Financial Statements” to present comparative 
information in respect of paragraph 79(a)(iv) of IAS 1.
•	 The requirements of paragraphs 10(d), 10(f), 16, 38A, 38B, 38C, 38D, 40A, 40B, 40C, 40D, 111 and 134 to 
136 of IAS 1 “Presentation of Financial Statements”.
•	 The requirements of IAS 7 “Statement of Cash Flows”.
•	 The requirements of paragraphs 30 and 31 of IAS 8 “Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates 
and Error”.
•	 The requirements of paragraphs 17 and 18A of IAS 24 “Related Party Disclosures”.
•	 The requirements in IAS 24 “Related Party Disclosures” to disclose related party transactions entered into 
between two or more members of a group, provided that any subsidiary which is a party to the transaction is 
wholly owned by such a member.
•	 The requirements of paragraphs 130(f)(ii), 130(f)(iii), 134(d) to 134(f) and 135(c) to 135(e) of IAS 36 - 
Impairment of Assets.
Where required, equivalent disclosures are given in the consolidated financial statements of Travis Perkins plc.
Basis of preparation
The financial statements have been prepared on the historical cost basis, except that derivative and other 
financial instruments and contingent consideration arising from business combinations are stated at fair 
value through profit and loss and also designated financial instruments are stated at fair value through other 
comprehensive income.
Foreign currencies
Transactions denominated in foreign currencies are recorded at the rates ruling on the date of the transaction.
At the balance sheet date, monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are translated at 
the rate of exchange ruling at that date. Foreign exchange differences arising on translation are recognised in 
the income statement.
Going concern
After reviewing the Group’s forecasts and risk assessments and making other enquiries, the Board 
has formed the judgement at the time of approving the financial statements that there is a reasonable 
expectation that the Company has adequate resources to continue in operational existence for the 12 
months from the date of signing this Annual Report and Accounts. For this reason the Board continues to 
adopt the going concern basis in preparing the financial statements.
In arriving at their opinion the Directors considered:
•	 The Group’s cash flow forecasts and revenue projections.
•	 The impact on trading performance of severe but plausible downside scenarios. Key assumptions include 
significant reductions in revenue, removal of property profits and limited reductions in fixed overheads, as 
well as mitigating actions such as delayed capital expenditure, reduced overhead investment and dividend 
suspension. 
•	 The committed debt facilities available to the Group and the covenants thereon.
•	 The Group’s debt maturity profile and the successful issuance of £125m of new debt in March 2025.
•	 The Group’s robust policy towards liquidity and cash flow management.
•	 The Group’s ability to successfully manage the principal risk and uncertainties outlined on pages 59 to 69 
during periods of uncertain economic outlook and challenging macroeconomic conditions.
The downside scenarios tested, outlining the impact of severe but plausible adverse scenarios based on a severe 
recession and housing market weakness, show that there is sufficient headroom for liquidity and covenant 
compliance purposes for at least the next 12 months from the date of approval of these financial statements.

175
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Significant accounting policies
The principal accounting policies adopted in preparing the financial statements are provided throughout the 
notes to the financial statements.
Standards issued but not yet effective
New standards, amendments and interpretations which are in issue but not yet effective are not expected to 
have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.
1.  Income statements disclosures
The audit fee for the Company and the consolidated financial statements is disclosed in note 4(b) of the 
Group consolidated financial statements. Fees payable to KPMG LLP for audit and non-audit services to the 
Company are not required to be disclosed because the Group financial statements disclose such fees on a 
consolidated basis. Details of the Company’s policy on the use of auditors for non-audit services, the reasons 
why the auditor was used rather than another supplier and how the auditor’s independence and objectivity 
were safeguarded are set out in the Audit Committee Report
Staff costs (including Directors):
£m
2024
2023
Wages and salaries
5.7
6.5
Social security costs
0.7
0.9
Other pension costs 
0.2
0.2
Share-based payments (note 12)
4.3
5.4
10.9
13.0
The average monthly number of persons employed including Directors during the year was 50 (2023: 51).
2.  Investments in subsidiaries
Accounting policy
Investments in subsidiaries are carried at cost less impairment.
£m
2024
2023
Cost
At 1 January
3,147.8
3,003.6
Additions
494.8
144.2
At 31 December
3,642.6
3,147.8
Provision for impairment
At 1 January
(1,225.9)
(1,135.0)
Impairment charge
–
(90.9)
At 31 December 
(1,225.9)
(1,225.9)
Net book value at 31 December
2,416.7
1,921.9
The additions to investments in 2024 represent the capitalisation of intercompany loans as part of the 
Group’s ongoing project to simplify its legal structure.
The impairment charge in 2023 relates to the Company’s investment in Travis Perkins Finance Company 
Limited and followed the payment of intercompany dividends in 2023 which resulted in a reduction in the 
subsidiary’s net assets below the carrying amount of the investment held by the Company. Accordingly an 
impairment loss was recognised.
As the carrying amount of the net assets of the Company was more than its market capitalisation as at 
31 December 2024, the Directors have carried out an impairment review of the Company’s investments 
and concluded that the investments are not impaired. The investment balance principally relates to the 
Company’s investment in Travis Perkins Group Holdings Limited, which indirectly holds all of the Group’s 
operating businesses.
A full listing of all related undertakings is provided in note 11.

176
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
NOTES TO THE COMPANY’S FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
3.  Deferred tax
£m 
(Asset)/liability:
At 1 Jan 2024
Recognised 
in income
Recognised in 
equity
Recognised 
in other 
comprehensive 
income
At 31 Dec 2024
Share-based payments
(2.0)
0.6
(0.1)
–
(1.5)
Cash flow hedge
0.7
–
–
0.1
0.8
Other timing differences
(0.2)
–
–
–
(0.2)
(1.5)
0.6
(0.1)
0.1
(0.9)
£m 
(Asset)/liability:
At 1 Jan 2023
Recognised  
in income
Recognised in 
equity
Recognised 
in other 
comprehensive 
income
Share-based payments
(0.7)
(1.3)
–
–
Cash flow hedge
1.1
–
–
(0.4)
Other timing differences
(0.3)
0.1
–
–
0.1
(1.2)
–
(0.4)
4.  Debtors
Accounting policy
Debtors are originally recognised at fair value. Subsequent to the initial recognition they are measured at 
amortised cost using the effective interest rate method.
£m
2024
2023
Current:
Amounts owed by subsidiaries
155.9
572.4
Other financial assets – loan notes
1.7
1.7
Other debtors
42.9
69.9
200.5
644.0
Amounts owed by subsidiaries include loans and other balances. The loans are interest-free and repayable 
on demand. 
5.  Share capital and reserves
Accounting policy
Equity instruments represent the ordinary share capital of the Company and are recorded at the 
proceeds received, net of directly attributable incremental issue costs.
a.  Share capital
Ordinary shares of 11.2p (authorised, issued and fully paid)
No.
£m
At 1 January and December 2024
212,509,334
23.8
The Company has one class of ordinary share that carries no right to fixed income. The holders of ordinary 
shares are entitled to receive dividends as declared and are entitled to one vote per share at meetings of the 
Company. All shares rank equally with regard to the Company’s residual assets. See Group note 19 for the 
explanation of movements in share capital and own shares. 
b.  Own shares 
2024
2023
At 1 January
1,668,682
2,596,684
Reissued
(476,499)
(928,002)
At 31 December
1,192,183
1,668,682
The own shares held by the Employee Share Ownership Trust are to satisfy options under the Group’s share 
option schemes. None of the own shares have been allocated to grants of executive options and all rights 
attaching to the shares are suspended until the shares are reissued.
c.  Reserves
A description of the nature and purpose of each reserve is given below:
•	 The share premium represents the amounts above the nominal value received for shares sold.
•	 The cash flow hedge reserve represents the cumulative gain or loss on the fair value of effective hedging 
instruments used in cash flow hedges which have not yet been reclassified to profit or loss.
•	 The merger reserve represents the premium on equity instruments issued as consideration for the 
acquisition of BSS.
•	 The own shares reserve represents the cost of shares purchased in the market and held by the Employee 
Share Ownership Trust to satisfy options under the Group’s share option schemes.
•	 Retained earnings represents cumulative results for the Company.

177
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Distributable reserves
The distributable reserves accessible to the Company broadly approximate its accumulated profits. When 
required the Company can receive dividends from its subsidiaries to increase the available distributable 
reserves.
6.  Interest bearing loans and borrowings
Accounting policy
Interest-bearing bank loans and overdrafts, loan notes and other loans are recognised in the balance 
sheet at amortised cost. Finance charges associated with arranging non-equity funding are recognised in 
the income statement over the life of the facility. All other borrowing costs are recognised in the income 
statement in accordance with the effective interest rate method.
£m
2024
2023
Bonds
250.0
250.0
Finance charges netted off borrowings
(3.2)
(4.5)
Term loan
75.0
75.0
Senior unsecured notes
100.0
100.0
Overdrafts
13.2
–
435.0
420.5
Current liabilities
13.2
–
Non-current liabilities
421.8
420.5
435.0
420.5
£m
2024
2023
Borrowings repayable:
On demand or within one year
13.2
–
More than one year, but not more than five years
325.0
325.0
More than five years
100.0
100.0
Gross borrowings
438.2
425.0
Unamortised fees
(3.2)
(4.5)
435.0
420.5
At 31 December 2024 all borrowings were denominated in sterling (2023: sterling).
In respect of income-earning financial assets and interest-bearing financial liabilities, the following table 
indicates their effective interest rates at the balance sheet date.
2024
2023
Effective 
interest rate
£m
Effective 
interest rate
£m
Assets:
Short-term deposits
4.4%
200.0
5.2%
101.5
Liabilities:
2026 £250m bond
3.8%
250.0
3.8%
250.0
£75m term loan
4.6%
75.0
4.6%
75.0
£100m senior unsecured notes
6.2%
100.0
6.2%
100.0
425.0
425.0
Details of the bonds, term loan and senior unsecured notes are given in note 22 to the consolidated financial 
statements.
7.  Amounts due to subsidiary undertakings
£m
2024
2023
Amounts due to subsidiary undertakings – current
209.2
36.1
209.2
36.1
Amounts due to subsidiary undertakings relate to loans and other balances. These loans are interest-free.

178
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
NOTES TO THE COMPANY’S FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
8.  Financial risk management
For more details of the Group’s hedging instruments see notes 27 and 28 of the Group financial statements.
£m
2024
2023
Non-current assets
Interest rate swap – cash flow hedge
3.3
2.9
Total non-current derivative financial instrument assets
3.3
2.9
The Company’s hedging reserve relates to the following hedge instrument:
£m
Interest rate swaps
At 1 January 2023
3.2
Change in fair value of hedging instrument recognised in OCI
(1.4)
Deferred tax
0.4
At 1 January 2024
2.2
Change in fair value of hedging instrument recognised in OCI
0.4
Deferred tax
(0.1)
At 31 December 2024
2.5
The following amounts were recognised in the Group’s profit and loss:
£m
2024
2023
Net loss on foreign currency forwards not qualifying as hedges 
included in other gains
0.8
–
£m
2024
2023
Carrying amount (non-current assets)
3.3
2.9
Notional amount
75.0
75.0
Maturity date
15 August 2027
15 August 2027
Hedge ratio
1:1
1:1
Change in fair value of hedging instruments for the year
0.4
4.3
Weighted average hedged rate for the year
5.1%
4.6%
9.  Financial instruments
For the full details of the cash flow hedging instrument and the resulting accounting policy, see notes 27 and 
28 of the Group accounts.
a.  The carrying value of categories of financial instruments
£m
2024
2023
Financial assets:
Mandatorily at FVTPL
0.5
–
Loans and receivables (including cash and cash equivalents)  
at amortised cost
399.9
686.1
Designated instrument-by-instrument as either FVTPL or FVOCI
3.3
2.9
403.7
689.0
Financial liabilities:
Mandatorily at FVTPL
–
0.4
Borrowings (note 6)
435.0
420.5
Trade and other payables at amortised cost
220.2
44.2
655.2
465.1

179
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
b.  Liquidity analysis
The following table details the Company’s liquidity analysis for its derivative financial instruments and other 
external financial liabilities. The table has been drawn up based on the undiscounted net cash flows on the 
derivative instruments that settle on a net basis and the undiscounted gross cash flows on those derivatives 
that require gross settlement. When the amount payable or receivable is not fixed, the amount disclosed has 
been determined by reference to the projected interest and foreign currency rates as illustrated by the yield 
curves existing at the reporting date.
£m
2024
0–1 year
1–2 years
2–5 years
5+ years
Total
Total gross settled: Foreign 
exchange forward contracts
(18.7)
–
–
–
(18.7)
Total net settled: Interest rate 
swap – cash flow hedge
1.1
0.9
0.7
–
2.7
Total derivative financial 
instruments
(17.6)
0.9
0.7
–
(16.0)
Net settled:
Borrowings
(30.6)
(270.6)
(132.7)
(72.2)
(506.1)
Trade and other payables at 
amortised cost
(220.2)
–
–
–
(220.2)
Total financial instruments
(250.8)
(270.6)
(132.7)
(72.2)
(726.3)
£m
2023
0–1 year
1–2 years
2–5 years
5+ years
Total
Total gross settled: Foreign 
exchange forward contracts
(22.9)
–
–
–
(22.9)
Total net settled: Interest rate 
swap – cash flow hedge
1.9
1.9
3.1
–
6.9
Total derivative financial 
instruments
(21.0)
1.9
3.1
–
(16.0)
Net settled:
Borrowings
(20.9)
(20.8)
(353.5)
(143.9)
(539.1)
Trade and other payables at 
amortised cost
(47.4)
–
–
–
(47.4)
Total financial instruments
(68.3)
(20.8)
(353.5)
(143.9)
(586.5)
10.  Other creditors
Accounting policy
Other creditors are measured at amortised cost. The Company has financial risk management policies in 
place to ensure that all payables are paid within the credit time frame.
£m
2024
2023
Other creditors
11.0
8.1
Accruals
4.7
9.4
15.7
17.5
11.  Related undertakings
The registered office of all subsidiary undertakings is Lodge Way House, Lodge Way, Harlestone Road, 
Northampton NN5 7UG except for companies with a superscript where the registered office is given after the 
list of subsidiary companies and investments.
Active subsidiary companies (100% ownership and UK registered)
CCF Limited
TP Property Company Limited
Independent Construction Technologies Limited*3
Travis Perkins Group Holdings Limited
Keyline Civils Specialist Limited2
Travis Perkins (Properties) Limited
Staircraft Group Limited1
Travis Perkins Finance Company Limited*3
The BSS Group Limited
Travis Perkins Leasing Company Limited*3
The Cobtree Scottish Limited Partnership1
Travis Perkins P&H Group Holdings Limited
Tools & Fasteners Solutions Limited
Travis Perkins Trading Company Limited
Toolstation Holdings Limited
Wickes Properties Limited*3
Toolstation Limited1

180
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
NOTES TO THE COMPANY’S FINANCIAL STATEMENTS CONTINUED
For the year ended 31 December 2024
11.  Related undertakings continued
Dormant & non-trading subsidiary companies (100% ownership and UK registered)
Benchmarx Kitchens and Joinery Limited
Terant Supplies Limited
British Steam Specialties (International) Limited (The)
Tile It All (UK) Limited*3
BSS (UK) Limited
The BSS EBT Company Limited*3
BSS GPS Trustee Limited
Tile Giant Holdings Limited
Builders Mate Limited
TP Directors Ltd
Cobtree Nominees Limited
TP General Partner (Scotland) Limited1
E. East & Son Limited
TPG Management Services Limited
JS Towell Limited*3
Travis Group Limited
MD-DOR3 Limited*3
Travis & Arnold Limited
MD-DOR4 Limited
Travis Perkins Capital Partner Limited
Monteith Building Services Limited*4
Travis Perkins Financing Company No.3 Limited 
P. H. Properties Limited*3
Travis Perkins Merchant Holdings Limited
P.T.S. Plumbing Trade Supplies Limited*3
Tricom Group Limited*3
*	
companies in voluntary liquidation.
Other subsidiary companies (100% ownership and non-UK registered)
Company Name
Registered
% Ownership
Status
BSS (Ireland) Limited5
Ireland
100
Active
Toolexpert Benelux BV6
Netherlands
97
Active
Toolstation BV6
Netherlands
97
Active
Toolstation NV/SA7
Belgium
97
Active
Toolstation Europe BV6
Netherlands
97
Active
Toolstation Europe Limited
United Kingdom 97
Active
Toolstation Netherlands BV8
Germany
97
Dormant
Toolstation SAS9
Netherlands
97
Active
Travis Perkins Hong Kong Limited10
France
97
Active
Travis Perkins Sourcing (Shanghai) Ltd11
Hong Kong
100
Active
Investments
Company Name
Registered
% ownership
Status
Hermitage Park Management Company Limited12
United Kingdom 25
Active
Registered offices (not Lodge Way House)
1	
Ryehill House, Ryehill Close, Lodge Farm Industrial Estate, Northampton, England, NN5 7UA,  
United Kingdom
2	
50 Mauchline Street, Glasgow, G5 8HQ, United Kingdom
3	
C/O Forvis Mazars LLP, 1st Floor Two Chamberlain Square, Birmingham, B3 3AX, United Kingdom
4	
C/O Forvis Mazars LLP, Restructuring Services Apex 2, 97 Haymarket Terrace, Edinburgh, EH12 5HD,  
	
United Kingdom
5	
White Heather Industrial Estate, South Circular Road, Dublin, 8, Ireland
6	
Brandpuntlaan Zuid 12, 2665NZ, Bleiswijk, Netherlands
7	
Boomsesteenweg 58, 2630 Aarlselaar, Belgium
8	
Regus Building, Kranhaus 1, Business Centre GmbH Co KG, Im Zollhafen 18, 50678 Koln, Germany
9	
61 Route de Grenoble, 69800 Saint Priest, Lyon, France
10	 Suite 2401, 24/F, China Insurance Group Building, 141 Des Voeux Road, Central, Hong Kong
11	 Building No.17, No. 800 Changde Road, JingAn District, Shanghai 200040, China
12	 C/O Bruton Knowles LLP, 2 Paris Parklands, Railton Road, Guildford, Surrey, GU2 9JX, United Kingdom
12.  Share-based payments
The Company operates a number of share incentive plans. A description of the share schemes operated by 
the Group, including that of the Company, is contained in the remuneration report on pages 90 to 93 and 
page 106 to 110 and in note 33 to the consolidated financial statements.
13.  Related party transactions
The Company has a related party relationship with its subsidiaries, its Directors and with its pension 
schemes. In addition the remuneration of the Directors, and the details of their interests in the share capital 
of the Company are provided in the audited part of the remuneration report on pages 102 to 110. Other than 
the payment of remuneration there have been no related party transactions with Directors.
Details of balances outstanding with subsidiary companies are shown in notes 4 and 7 and in the balance 
sheet on page 172.

181
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FIVE-YEAR SUMMARY
CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT
2024
£m
2023
(re-presented)*
£m
2022
£m
2021
£m
2020
£m
Revenue
4,607.4
4,837.1
4,994.8
4,568.7
3,697.5
Operating profit before amortisation and adjusting items
151.8
198.1
295.3
352.8
128.3
Amortisation
(10.4)
(10.5)
(10.5)
(11.1)
(8.6)
Adjusting items – operating
(139.1)
(26.9)
–
6.8
(92.7)
Operating profit
2.3
160.7
284.8
348.5
27.0
Share of associates’ results
–
–
–
–
0.1
Net finance costs
(40.7)
(39.3)
(39.8)
(42.9)
(47.4)
(Loss)/profit before tax
(38.4)
121.4
245.0
305.6
(20.3)
Adjusting items – deferred tax
–
–
–
(4.7)
(9.0)
Income tax expense
(2.2)
(31.9)
(52.8)
(60.1)
(5.8)
Net (loss)/profit from continuing operations
(40.6)
89.5
192.2
240.8
(35.1)
Net (loss)/profit from discontinued operations
(36.8)
(51.4)
–
38.1
13.2
(Loss)/profit for the period
(77.4)
38.1
192.2
278.9
(21.9)
Basic (loss)/earnings per share from continuing operations
(19.2)p
42.5p
90.8p
103.9p
(14.3p)
Basis (loss)/earnings per share from discontinued operations
(17.4)p
(24.4)p
–
16.4p
5.3p
Adjusted earnings per share
36.6p
54.4p
94.6p
107.3p
21.0p
Dividend declared per ordinary share
14.5p
18.0p
39.0p
73.0p
–
Number of branches at 31 December (includes branches of associates)
1,421
1,507
1,484
1,513
1,389
Average number of colleagues 
17,594
18,831
19,956
18,833
17,512
*	
The comparative numbers prior to 2023 are not re-presented for discontinued operations related to Toolstation Europe France.

182
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FIVE-YEAR SUMMARY CONTINUED
CONSOLIDATED FREE CASH FLOW STATEMENT
£m
2024
£m
2023
(re-presented)*
£m
2022
£m
2021
£m
2020
£m
Adjusted operating profit
151.8
198.1
295.3
352.8
128.3
Less: Profit on disposal of properties
(11.3)
(15.1)
(25.3)
(48.9)
(9.2)
Adjusted operating profit excluding property profit
140.5
183.0
270.0
303.9
119.1
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment
79.8
79.1
73.6
69.2
60.0
Amortisation of internally generated intangibles
3.6
4.6
6.5
9.7
11.5
Share-based payments
11.7
14.6
17.0
19.1
12.2
Movement on working capital
5.5
(22.6)
(76.5)
(151.8)
197.4
Other net interest paid
(19.5)
(25.0)
(16.9)
(13.6)
(28.3)
Interest on lease liabilities
(29.6)
(25.6)
(21.5)
(21.2)
(21.3)
Income tax paid
(20.9)
(40.7)
(57.6)
(59.9)
(27.6)
Capital expenditure excluding freehold purchase
(63.8)
(107.2)
(110.0)
(95.0)
(87.1)
Disposal of plant and equipment
1.2
2.0
10.1
4.4
5.4
Free cash flow
108.5
62.2
94.7
64.8
241.3
*	
The comparative numbers prior to 2023 are not re-presented for discontinued operations related to Toolstation Europe France.

183
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
2024
£m
2023
£m
2022
£m
2021
£m
2020
£m
Assets
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment
771.1
848.4
847.3
800.1
830.4
Goodwill and other intangible 
assets
908.2
947.8
974.9
978.7
1,670.5
Right-of-use assets
545.4
530.4
451.7
439.8
1,145.5
Other receivables
15.3
14.2
17.2
0.7
–
Retirement benefit asset
116.9
100.6
135.9
275.8
178.4
Other investments
–
–
–
–
9.2
Derivative financial instruments
3.3
2.9
4.3
–
–
Deferred tax asset
17.5
18.0
15.0
13.9
–
Current assets
Inventories
648.6
727.6
727.8
724.4
840.7
Trade and other receivables
760.5
689.6
725.9
706.7
892.7
Tax debtor
–
14.5
0.7
–
6.5
Derivative financial instruments
–
–
–
0.2
–
Cash and cash equivalents
244.4
131.5
235.7
459.8
505.6
Total assets
4,031.2
4,025.5
4,136.4
4,400.1
6,079.5
Capital and reserves
Issued capital
23.8
23.8
23.8
25.2
25.2
Share premium account
545.6
545.6
545.6
545.6
545.6
Merger reserve
326.5
326.5
326.5
326.5
326.5
Own shares
(7.2)
(14.1)
(34.3)
(61.4)
(39.5)
Other reserves
19.5
23.5
27.4
14.6
15.5
Accumulated profits
1,065.9
1,135.0
1,213.2
1,387.3
1,840.5
Total equity
1,974.1
2,040.3
2,102.2
2,237.8
2,713.8
2024
£m
2023
£m
2022
£m
2021
£m
2020
£m
Non-current liabilities
Interest-bearing loans and 
borrowings
421.8
445.1
349.1
575.2
575.7
Lease liability
560.1
518.8
438.3
414.7
1,168.3
Long-term provisions and other 
payables
21.6
3.8
4.9
6.8
21.9
Deferred tax liabilities
68.3
92.8
96.0
140.4
77.2
Current liabilities 
Interest-bearing loans and 
borrowings
–
192.5
–
–
Lease liability
94.5
89.6
74.3
74.5
158.8
Overdraft
13.2
–
–
–
–
Derivative financial instruments
–
0.4
0.2
–
1.6
Trade and other payables
838.2
795.4
852.4
921.1
1,304.2
Tax liabilities
–
–
–
0.4
–
Short-term provisions
39.4
39.3
26.5
29.2
58.0
Total liabilities
2,057.1
1,985.2
2,034.2
2,162.3
3,365.7
Total equity and liabilities
4,031.2
4,025.5
4,136.4
4,400.1
6,079.5

184
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
OTHER INFORMATION
OTHER INFORMATION
Contents
185	 ESG data report (including SASB data)
188	 Other shareholder information

185
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
ESG DATA REPORT (INCLUDING SASB DATA)
Unit of Measure
SASB reference
2024
2023
2022
2021
2020
Energy and fuel
Total energy consumed
kWh
N/A (SECR 
compliance)
276,611,054
311,809,636
322,116,912
364,826,976
339,716,233
Total UK energy consumed
kWh
267,508,323
306,260,839
313,744,004
358,494,358
334,383,277
Total Non-UK energy consumed
kWh
9,102,731
5,548,797
8,372,908
6,332,618
5,332,957
Total energy consumed
Gigajoules 
(GJ)
CG-MR-1.30a.1
995,792
1,122,515
1,080,095
1,313,377
1,222,978
Grid energy
%
CG-MR-1.30a.1
35.98
34.58
34.67
28.35
33.35
Renewable energy
%
CG-MR-1.30a.1
23.84
21.85
23.50
5.83
0
Fuel consumption
Litres
N/A
17,054,583
19,600,396
20,680,219
22,650,200
21,430,651
Waste
Non-hazardous waste
Tonnes
N/A
26,624
28,149
27,238
28,175
18,946
Hazardous waste
Tonnes
N/A
143
252
297
229.0
236
Landfilled waste
Tonnes
N/A
508
1,075
1,622
1,492
1,353
Recycled waste
Tonnes
N/A
10,290
10,837
8,656
10,084
9,614
Incinerated waste
Tonnes
N/A
15,969
16,237
16,960
16,829
8,216
Total waste
Tonnes
N/A
26,767
28,401
27,535
28,404
19,182
Data Security
Data breaches
#
CG-MR-230a.2
0
0
0
0
1
Involving Personally Identifiable Information (“PII”)
%
CG-MR-230a.2
0
0
0
0
100
Customers affected
#
CG-MR-230a.2
0
0
0
0
9
Description of approach to identifying and addressing data security risks
Text
CG-MR-230a.1
Labour practices
Average hourly wage
£
CG-MR-310a.1
13.81
13.21
13.54
12.8
12.4
In-branch colleagues earning minimum wage by region
%
CG-MR-310a.1
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.7%
7.4%
Voluntary turnover rate for in-branch colleagues
Rate
CG-MR-310a.2
15.60%
17.3%
20.6%
19.6%
10.7%
Involuntary turnover rate for in-branch colleagues
Rate
CG-MR-310a.2
6.10%
7.1%
5.7%
4.2%
9.9%
Total amount of monetary losses as a results of legal proceedings associated with labour law violations
£m
CG-MR-310a.3
0.0
0.0
0.0
0.0
0.0
“See text on page 187”

186
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
OTHER INFORMATION
ESG DATA REPORT (INCLUDING SASB DATA) CONTINUED
Unit of Measure
SASB reference
2024
2023
2022
2021
2020
Workforce diversity and inclusion
Gender
Management
Female
%
CG-MR-330a.1
22.6%
21.6%
23.6%
20.6%
18.3%
Male
%
CG-MR-330a.1
77.4%
78.4%
76.4%
79.4%
81.7%
Not available or Not disclosed
%
CG-MR-330a.1
–
0%
0%
0%
0%
All other employees
Female
%
CG-MR-330a.1
25.1%
25.0%
25.6%
25.7%
20.7%
Male
%
CG-MR-330a.1
74.9%
75.0%
74.4%
74.3%
79.3%
Not available or Not disclosed
%
CG-MR-330a.1
–
0%
0%
0%
0%
Ethnic group
Management
Asian
%
CG-MR-330a.1
2.3%
2.4%
2.5%
1.9%
2.0%
Black or African American
%
CG-MR-330a.1
0.5%
0.7%
0.7%
0.5%
0.3%
Hispanic or Latino
%
CG-MR-330a.1
0.9%
0.9%
0.8%
0.9%
0.7%
White
%
CG-MR-330a.1
76.2%
80.0%
80.1%
82.5%
85.9%
Other
%
CG-MR-330a.1
0.2%
0.3%
0.3%
0.4%
0.5%
Not available or Not disclosed
%
CG-MR-330a.1
19.9%
15.7%
15.7%
13.7%
10.7%
All other employees
Asian
%
CG-MR-330a.1
3.2%
2.7%
2.5%
2.6%
2.0%
Black or African American
%
CG-MR-330a.1
1.8%
1.3%
1.2%
1.0%
0.7%
Hispanic or Latino
%
CG-MR-330a.1
1.8%
1.5%
1.5%
1.6%
1.4%
White
%
CG-MR-330a.1
62.7%
64.0%
65.1%
64.3%
67.8%
Other
%
CG-MR-330a.1
5.8%
2.5%
0.5%
0.7%
0.7%
Not available or Not disclosed
%
CG-MR-330a.1
24.7%
28%
29.3%
29.8%
27.4%
Total amount of monetary losses as a result of legal proceedings associated with employee discrimination
£m
CG-MR-330a.2
0
0.01
0
0
–
Product sourcing, packaging and marketing
Revenue from products third-party certified to environmental and/or social sustainability standards
£m
CG-MR-410a.1
399
407
538
555
386
Description of processes to assess and manage risks and/or hazards associated with chemicals in product
Text
CG-MR-410a.2
Discussion of strategies to reduce the environmental impact of packaging
Text
CG-MR-410a.3
Water consumption
Water consumption
m3
N/A
270,146
277,610
258,321
316,852
281,050
See text on page 187
See text on page 187

187
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CG-MR-230a.1: Description of approach to identifying and addressing data security risks
Travis Perkins Group identifies vulnerabilities in its information systems using a combination of people, 
processes and technology while following the NIST Cybersecurity Framework to measure its maturity and 
alignment with ISO 27001.
The processes of building, procuring, deploying, operating, and managing IT systems some of which are 
ongoing are governed by established policies and standards, which are regularly reviewed to ensure they 
remain current. Any exceptions to these policies or standards undergo a rigorous risk assessment and 
management process, including approval from system and data owners. The Group allocates specific 
funding to undertake security-related projects aimed at enhancing security maturity and managing risks 
within acceptable limits.
Every colleague’s learning plan includes regular data protection training, and cyber awareness training 
throughout the Group. Additionally, colleagues are frequently targeted with phishing simulation campaigns 
using a leading industry approach.
Technology is implemented across the IT infrastructure to protect against and detect cyber threats and attacks. 
This includes tools such as firewalls, proxies, data loss prevention systems, extended detection and response 
(XDR), as well as continuous monitoring and logging into a Security Information and Event Management  
(SIEM) system. Security events were monitored 24/7/365 to ensure timely detection and response.
From a testing perspective, regular penetration tests and vulnerability scans are conducted on various 
components of the IT infrastructure and systems to identify exploitable vulnerabilities. When vulnerabilities 
are discovered, the Information Security Team evaluates, addresses, and tracks them.
The Group also regularly tests its incident response capabilities through tabletop exercises to assess the 
effectiveness of its incident response plans and playbooks.
This comprehensive approach is part of the Group’s internal control and assurance framework and will be 
reviewed as outlined in the Internal Audit Plan to ensure that risks are adequately mitigated.
CG-MR-410a.2: Description of processes to assess and manage risks and/or hazards 
associated with chemicals in product
The Group requires its suppliers to adhere to its published ‘Supplier Commitments’ (https://www.
travisperkinsplc.co.uk/sustainability/social-and-governance/sourcing-responsibly/). Suppliers are required 
to notify immediately where any product supplied contains substances of very high concern (SVHCs), 
explosives precursors or poisons or has other restrictions on sale and to take steps to replace any products 
that contain restricted substances or SVHCs with suitable alternatives. For such products, suppliers are 
required to provide a Safety Data Sheet (SDS). The business undertakes supplier assessments either 
via an Online Risk Assessment or via factory audits, based on risk, to assess adherence to the Supplier 
Commitments. The supplier assessment programme covers both private label and branded product 
suppliers. Restricted products are flagged within the business systems, triggering processes at point of sale  
to ensure they’re not sold to underage customers (i.e. solvents). This includes, for example:
•	 corrosive products, under the Offensive Weapons Act 2019, including acids and chemicals which may burn 
the skin but not normal strength household bleach and cleaners); and
•	 solvents, under the Psychoactive Substances Act 2016, including glues and adhesives, flammable products 
such as fire lighter fluid, solvent cement, paint stripper, thinners, essentially any substances which are 
capable of producing a psychoactive effect in a person who consumes it and it is not an exempted 
substance; and
•	 spray paint and aerosols; under the Anti-Social Behaviour Act 2003.
There is a requirement in the Group Supplier Manual (https://www.travisperkinsplc.co.uk/sustainability/
social-and-governance/sourcing-responsibly/) for suppliers delivering to the Group’s sites to provide a safety 
data sheet for all substances delivered which are harmful to health.
CG-MR-410a3: Description of strategies to reduce the environmental impact of packaging
The Group is committed to reducing its environmental impact relating to packaging. For more information 
on objectives and progress, please refer to page 34. Throughout 2024 the Group continued to work with 
the direct sourcing team to optimise the amount of material used, achieving packaging reductions and 
improvements. The Group continued to work with Ecosurety its packaging compliance partner, to ensure 
smooth transition to the Extend Producer Regulations, and obtain packaging data from its suppliers which 
is differentiated by packaging levels; primary, secondary and tertiary, and by material type. In late 2024, the 
Group began a competitive tendering process to consolidate the supply of packaging materials used across 
the business. This process is due to complete in Q1 2025.
With regards to influencing others, the Group will continue its work with the Supply Chain Sustainability 
School (SCSS) to raise awareness and share best practice on packaging reductions and transitioning to 
more sustainable packaging solutions. Travis Perkins and BSS branches continue to backhaul cardboard, 
plastic and wood packaging to their distribution centres where it is processed and sent for reprocessing.

188
STRATEGIC REPORT
GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INFORMATION
Travis Perkins plc  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
OTHER SHAREHOLDER INFORMATION
Financial diary
Ex-dividend date
17 April 2025
Record date
22 April 2025
Trading statement
29 April 2025
Annual General Meeting
14 May 2025
Payment of final dividend
29 May 2025
Annual General Meeting (“AGM”)
The AGM will be held on 14 May 2025 at 9.30am.
Registrars
For information about shareholdings and dividends and to report changes to your address, bank details or 
any other account information please contact the Company’s registrars (“MUFG”):
MUFG Corporate Markets  
Central Square  
29 Wellington Street  
Leeds  
LS1 4DL 
Shareholder portal provided by MUFG: www.travisperkins-shares.com  
Email: shareholderenquiries@cm.mpms.mufg.com 
Telephone: +44 (0) 371 664 0300*
Shareholder portal
You can view and manage your shareholder account online via the shareholder portal provided by MUFG 
(www.travisperkins-shares.com). You will need to register to use this service and to do so you will require 
your unique investor code which can be found on your share certificate or dividend confirmation (and which 
you may see abbreviated as “IVC”).
Dividends
It is more secure to have your dividends paid directly into your bank account than by cheque. If you do 
not already have your dividends paid directly into your account and would like to do so, you can do this on 
the MUFG shareholder portal or you can contact MUFG, who will send you the relevant form to complete. 
Shareholders outside the United Kingdom may be able to make use of MUFG’s International Payment Service 
facility to have dividends converted into your chosen currency. For further details please contact MUFG or  
visit https://www.mpms.mufg.com/en/for-individuals/uk/shareholders/international-payment-service/.
Shareholder communications
Travis Perkins plc Annual Reports and other information pertinent to investors, including results, other reports 
and presentations and regulatory news, are available on the Investors section of our Company website  
(www.travisperkinsplc.co.uk).
Annual Report
The Annual Report is published on our Company website and a hard copy will be posted to shareholders 
who have requested it. All other shareholders will be notified by letter or email when the Annual Report is 
available on our website. A hard copy of the Annual Report can be requested by writing to:
The Company Secretary 
Travis Perkins plc 
Ryehill House 
Rye Hill Close 
Lodge Farm Industrial Estate 
Northampton 
NN5 7UA
or by email to: cosec@travisperkins.co.uk
Electronic shareholder communications
The Company encourages you to consider if receiving your shareholder communications by email would work 
best for you. This is a faster, more environmentally friendly and more effective way to communicate with 
you. If you have received a paper copy of this report or notification of its availability by post and would like to 
receive fully electronic communication, please register your preference on the MUFG shareholder portal.
Other shareholder services provided by our registrars
MUFG provide a number of other services that, as a shareholder, might be useful to you:
Duplicate share register accounts
If you are receiving more than one copy of our report, or notification by post of its availability online, it may 
be that your shares are registered in two or more accounts on our register of members. If that is not your 
intention you may wish to consider merging the accounts into one single entry. Please contact MUFG who 
will be pleased to help you.
Dividend Re-Investment Plan (“DRIP”)
This is a facility provided by MUFG which allows shareholders resident in the United Kingdom, Channel Islands 
and Isle of Man to use their dividends to buy further shares in the Company. Full details are available by calling 
MUFG on +44 (0) 371 664 0381, or you can sign up for this service on the MUFG shareholder portal (by 
clicking on “Manage your account” followed by “Dividend payments” and following the on-screen instructions).
Share-dealing services
Share-dealing services are available to shareholders resident in the UK, Channel Islands and Isle of Man 
from MUFG:  
On-line dealing: https://sharedeal.cm.mpms.mufg.com/ 
Telephone dealing: +44 (0) 371 664 0445*
These services are only available to private shareholders resident in the UK.
*	
Calls will be charged at the standard geographic rate and will vary by provider. Calls from outside the United Kingdom will be charged at the applicable 
international rate; lines are open 9.00am to 5.30pm, Monday to Friday with the exception of share-dealing lines which are open from 8.00am to 4.30pm.

CBP00019082504183028
Printed by a CarbonNeutral® Company certified to ISO 14001 environmental management system. 
This product is made using recycled materials limiting the impact on our precious forest resources, helping reduce the need to harvest more trees. 
100% of the inks used are vegetable oil based, 95% of press chemicals are recycled for further use and, on average 99% of any waste associated 
with this production will be recycled and the remaining 1% used to generate energy. 
The paper is Carbon Balanced with World Land Trust, an international conservation charity, who offset carbon emissions through the purchase and 
preservation of high conservation value land. 
Through protecting standing forests under threat of clearance, carbon is locked-in that would otherwise be released.

Travis Perkins plc
Lodge Way House, Lodge Way,  
Harleston Road, Northampton, NN5 7UG
www.travisperkinsplc.co.uk